Quarterlytics / Specialty Retail / Dunelm Group

Dunelm Group

dnlm · LSE
Claim this profile
Ticker dnlm
Exchange LSE
Sector
Industry Specialty Retail
Employees 5001-10,000
← All annual reports
FY2024 Annual Report · Dunelm Group
Sign in to download
Loading PDF…
The Home of Homes: 
Unlocking our  
full potential
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024

The Home of Homes: 
Committed to being 
good & circular
Dunelm Group plc
Sustainability report 2024
corporate.dunelm.com
Strategic report
2	
At a glance
3	
About us
4	
Chair’s statement
6	
The home of Balancing  
Growth & Grip
8	
The home of Ambition 
& Innovation
10	
Our business model
12	
Our market
13	
Our strategy
14	
CEO’s review
20	
Stakeholder engagement
25	
Section 172 statement
26	
Key performance indicators
28	
CFO’s review
32	
Sustainability
34	
Non-financial and sustainability 
information
38	
Our approach to risk 
management
40	
Principal risks and uncertainties
46	
TCFD report
55	
Going concern and  
viability statement
How to use this Annual Report
Where you see QR codes, scan 
to watch videos online
Links to other content within 
this report
Link to content within  
the Sustainability Report 2024
Link to content online 
Governance report
57	
Chair’s introduction
59	
Compliance with the Code
60	
Directors and officers
63	
Governance dashboard
64	
Governance framework
68	
Culture and values
71	
Board activities
74	
Nomination Committee report
81	
Audit and Risk Committee report
88	
Remuneration at a glance
89 	
Remuneration Committee report
116	
Directors’ report
120	
Statement of Directors’ 
responsibilities
Financial statements
122	
Independent auditors’ report
128	
Consolidated financial 
statements
151	
Parent company financial 
statements
Other information
157	
Alternative performance 
measures (‘APMs’)
158	
Advisors and contacts
The Home of Homes
Contents
Our market
Learn more about our 
plans to further grow 
market share
Our people
Discover how we 
engage with our 
colleagues on page 22
Strong leadership team
Scan the QR code to watch our CEO, 
Nick, give a summary of our FY24 results 
and future plans
Read our Sustainability Report 2024 to 
understand how we are being good and 
circular as a business 
corporate.dunelm.com/sustainability
Visit our website for  
further information about 
our business
SR

Unlocking our full potential 
as The Home of Homes
We have delivered another good performance despite a challenging 
consumer environment, demonstrating the strength and resilience 
of our business model. Whilst remaining focused on delivery, we are 
constantly looking to learn and adapt, to take advantage of the 
exciting opportunities ahead of us. We are extremely confident in 
our plans to unlock our full potential and achieve our clear vision to 
be the most trusted and valuable brand in homewares and furniture 
for UK consumers. 
Read more about how we are the home of:
Balancing Growth & Grip
Find out more on page 6
Ambition & Innovation 
Find out more on page 8
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
1

We are The Home of Homes, always seeking to create 
beautiful products and getting to know our customers 
better, to help them create homes they love. 
We are a specialist retailer of homewares and 
furniture, with a broad offer for all tastes and budgets, 
with thousands of quality products at fantastic prices 
sold across our 184 stores and on dunelm.com.
c.85,000
SKUs to suit every style and budget 
across our broad range of homewares 
and furniture categories
11,500+
colleagues
No.1
market leader in 
UK homewares
184
stores
37%
digital sales
At a glance
40yrs
of Dunelm stores
	For reflections from some of 
our longest-serving colleagues, 
see pages 69 and 70
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
2

Our vision:
To build the UK’s most 
trusted and valuable 
brand for homewares 
and furniture
Our purpose: 
To help create the joy of truly 
feeling at home, now and for 
generations to come
Being Good & Circular:
We are committed to 
sustainable growth by being 
good and circular, as we seek 
to look after all of our homes
Our home the Planet
Our home in Communities 
A home for our People 
On this journey we are embracing 
change and recognise that we must 
learn, invest and be both creative 
and collaborative. 
Our shared values:
Our four key values remain at the heart 
of our business and will help unlock 
our full potential 
Our values evolved from the key business 
principles developed 20 years ago, and 
reflect the attitudes and behaviours we 
encourage at Dunelm.
Stronger together
Act like owners
Keep listening  
& learning
Long-term  
thinking
Read how we embed and monitor our culture and 
values in our Governance report from page 68
Learn more about our good and circular approach 
to sustainability on pages 32 and 33
About us
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
3

Performance 
Sales of £1,706m were up 4% on last year, driven 
by increased volumes. Strong operational grip 
has become a characteristic of Dunelm in recent 
years and it was demonstrated again this year to 
increase gross margin, and support a profit before 
tax increase of 7% to £205m. Diluted earnings 
per share fell 0.8% to 74.4p, as a result of an 
increase in the effective tax rate, largely due to 
the rise in corporation tax in April 2023.
Our cash conversion and returns are key 
strengths of the business, and during the year 
we paid a special dividend of 35p per share. 
Our ordinary dividend for the year was up 3.6% 
to 43.5p per share, continuing our track record 
of impressive cash returns to shareholders, as 
well as demonstrating our ongoing confidence 
in the business.
Being Good and Circular
Sustainable growth is ingrained in the day-to-
day operations of the Group. Being good and 
circular is how we characterise our approach, 
considering our impact on the planet, in our 
communities and in looking after our people. 
	Read more about our approach on pages 32 
and 33 and in our Sustainability Report 2024
Planet
Central to reducing our impact on the planet 
is giving close consideration to the design, 
materials and manufacturing processes involved 
in our products. In FY24 we have increased the 
During the last financial year, both the political 
and economic environment have been 
turbulent and consumer confidence has been 
subdued. Despite this backdrop, Dunelm has 
continued to attract new customers and 
increase its market share through its broad 
and attractive product range and focus on 
outstanding quality and value.
Over many years, our business has performed 
well in both stronger and weaker economic 
cycles. This is credit to the unique, specialist offer 
which has been developed for our customers, 
and the attractiveness of our business model. 
This success is also delivered by the thousands 
of amazing people who work in the business; 
in my second year as Chair, I’m seeing more and 
more of the magic and energy which Dunelm 
colleagues demonstrate every day, and which 
drives the Company forward. 
Over the past year, a focus on being The Home 
of Homes has led to a further broadening of our 
range of relevant homewares and furniture 
products, at outstanding value across all price 
points. At the same time, we have been opening 
more stores, improving the digital customer 
journey, developing our marketing activity, and 
using technology and data to improve both our 
offer and our infrastructure. 
This culture of continuous improvement, led by 
a strong and experienced team, has again seen 
us grow sales, volumes, customer numbers and 
market share.
I’m delighted to report 
another strong performance, 
with Dunelm again delivering 
growth and demonstrating 
resilience in what has been 
a challenging homewares 
market. 
number of products that qualify for our 
‘Conscious Choice’ range, predominantly by 
finding more responsibly sourced materials that 
have a proven, reduced environmental impact 
compared to their conventional alternatives.
We’re also learning more about the lifecycle of 
our products and have developed a circularity 
strategy and circular design principles to push 
ourselves forward. To increase awareness, during 
the year our commercial teams were tasked with 
a ‘Circular Product Design Competition’, the 
results of which have already led to a number of 
products being created, including our Full Circle 
sofas, which feature modular design and can be 
taken apart for recycling at end of life.
Communities 
I am hugely proud of the way in which Dunelm 
interacts with our local communities, from both 
our stores and support sites. 
This year our colleagues selected Age UK as our 
new national charity partner, and I’m delighted 
that we have committed to work with them for 
the next three years to raise at least £2m, with a 
mission of creating communities that feel like 
home for older people. We have also continued 
to build on the success of our ‘Delivering Joy’ 
campaign. This was first launched in 2019 and 
has strengthened each year. Last Christmas our 
customers and colleagues donated a remarkable 
125,000 gifts across our stores, distribution 
centres and offices, which were then distributed 
to local communities and causes.
Delivering for our planet, our 
communities and our people
Chair’s statement
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
4

People
During the year we celebrated the 40-year 
anniversary of our first store opening in Leicester 
Churchgate, as the Adderley family built on 
the success of their Leicester market stall. 
We celebrated the milestone throughout the 
summer, including an extra ‘double discount’ day 
for colleagues, a pop-up museum at our Head 
Office, and a video celebrating the recollections 
of some of our longest-serving colleagues.
We now have c.11,500 colleagues across 
distribution, manufacturing, customer contact, 
store support centres and 184 stores, and 
I thank them all for their ongoing enthusiasm, 
commitment and dedication to our success. 
We continue to strive to be an inclusive 
employer where all our team members can 
thrive. Whilst we still have much to do on 
diversity, I am pleased that we have increased 
the proportion of our ethnic minority ‘role-
model leaders’, which comprises c.300 senior 
leaders or those managing large teams, by 
2ppts to 5.8%.
During the year we also launched ‘Reach’, a 
programme aimed at helping colleagues within 
underrepresented ethnic groups achieve their 
full potential. The programme focuses on 
advancing skills, connections and ultimately 
careers, and the first cohort of more than 60 
participants graduated in August 2024. 
Board
We announced a number of Board changes 
during the year. We have welcomed two new 
Non-Executive Directors in Ajay Kavan and 
Dan Taylor, who bring a wealth of relevant and 
complementary experience to the Board. 
Both William Reeve and Peter Ruis reached their 
nine-year terms as Board directors. Peter left us 
earlier in the year and William will be with us 
until the AGM, but will not stand for re-election. 
I would like to thank both Peter and William for 
the very significant contributions that they have 
made over their many years of service to Dunelm.
After the year end Kelly Devine stepped down 
from the Board, having agreed to join Dunelm’s 
Executive Team as Customer Director. I am 
pleased to continue to work with Kelly in her 
new Executive capacity. 
I share further detail on these changes in my 
introduction to the Governance section of this 
report, and look forward to continue working 
with our strong and experienced Board, who 
collectively have a fantastic range of skills.
Unlocking our full potential
Looking forward, whilst some of the lead 
consumer indicators are beginning to look more 
favourable, the sector is yet to show signs of 
recovery. Notwithstanding this uncertainty, we 
are very confident in the business and our future 
plans. We have developed our strategic thinking 
to focus on three key pillars: elevating our product 
offer; connecting with more customers; and 
harnessing our operational capabilities. Further 
detail is shared in the Chief Executive’s review, 
and we are excited about the opportunities 
these bring. We will continue to invest in these 
priorities, and are confident in further delivering 
on our track record of driving profitable growth 
and strong cash returns.
Alison Brittain
Chair
11 September 2024
Performance highlights 2024
Financial
Non-financial
Total sales (£m)
1,706
1,639
1,581
1,336
1,058
FY24
FY23
FY22
1
FY20 FY21
£1,706m
FY23 £1,639m
Market share2
7.7%
7.1%
6.8%
5.1%
5.8%
FY24
FY23
FY22
FY20 FY21
7.7%
FY23 7.1%
Profit before tax
£205m
FY23 £193m
Free cash flow
£132m
FY23 £160m
Active customer growth3
+5.1%
FY23 +2.8%
Colleague retention4
89%
FY23 87%
Diluted earnings 
per share
74.4p
FY23 75.0p
Ordinary dividend 
per share
43.5p
FY23 42.0p
Ethnic diversity of our 
role-model leaders
5.8%
FY23 3.8%
Scope 1 carbon 
intensity vs FY19
–53%
FY23 -32%
1.	
FY22 included a 53rd week for statutory reporting purposes. On a comparable 52-week basis sales were £1,553.1m.
2.	
GlobalData UK combined homewares and furniture markets, excluding kitchen cabinetry and bathroom furniture, for the period 
July 2023 to June 2024. Prior year comparatives restated.
3.	
Growth in unique active customers who have transacted at least once in the 12 months to June 2024. Management estimates using 
Barclays data.
4.	
Retention is the percentage of colleagues from the start of the financial year (July 2023) who remained employed until the end of the 
financial year (June 2024), excluding any planned leavers.
Read more in the Alternative Performance 
Measures table on page 157
Chair’s statement continued
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
5

Balancing  
Growth & Grip
YoY volume growth
+6.2%
 
PBT margin
12.0%
FY23 11.8%
Read more on page 28
Read more on page 29
The home of
In the last year, we have continued to grow 
in what has remained a tough consumer 
environment, demonstrating the strength 
and resilience of our business model. 
We take a balanced approach, regardless 
of market conditions, continuing to plan 
and invest for long-term, sustainable growth, 
whilst maintaining our commitment to 
strong operational grip. 
Use the QR Code to 
see our Spring 2024 
TV campaign
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
6

The home of Balancing Growth & Grip continued
Throughout our history we have consistently 
delivered profitable growth alongside strong 
cash returns, driven by an enduring commitment 
to ‘act like owners’. In a challenging consumer 
environment, we continue to balance growth 
and grip: staying customer-focused and making 
every pound count. 
Staying customer-focused 
Growth is driven by our focus on offering 
outstanding value, relevance and choice for 
our customers across our proposition, which 
encompasses our broad range of homewares 
and furniture products and the convenience 
of our total retail system.
We continue to focus on product development 
to meet evolving customer tastes. We have 
carefully managed our curated range extension, 
increasing the number of available products 
for our customers, whilst maintaining a focus 
on outstanding product quality and value. 
Alongside this, we constantly seek to be better 
and bolder with our product, increasing 
differentiation and cross-category coordination 
across our collections, whilst growing the use 
of more sustainable materials.
Across our total retail system, we have increased 
the proportion of our online range available for 
Click & Collect to c.50%. Our goal is to have 
nearly all UK-held stock available for next-day 
collection, with a small number of specific 
exceptions. We have also further expanded 
our store footprint whilst making multiple 
incremental improvements to dunelm.com 
to reduce friction in the customer journey. 
Making every pound count 
Our strong performance over FY24 reflects the 
inherent resilience and strength of our business 
model against the backdrop of a subdued 
market. In a year where we grew pre-tax profit 
ahead of sales, our commitment to tight 
operational grip and control was fundamental.
We take a balanced approach to managing 
profitability throughout the business. We 
maintained pricing discipline across our value 
tiers to deliver outstanding value, whilst closely 
managing our input costs through good 
planning and optimising our product 
specifications and sourcing. 
Within our operating costs, whilst inflation 
continues to be a headwind, we manage this 
tightly and take a continuous improvement 
approach to productivity to drive savings, 
without compromising customer or colleague 
experience. Alongside this, we maintain a 
long-term view of our priorities and carefully 
invest for future growth across our stores and 
online offer. 
Staying agile
In FY24 we continued to grow sales in a tougher 
environment, demonstrating the relevance and 
choice on offer for our customers. At the same 
time, we expanded our gross margin without 
any significant impact from price increases or 
reductions, as we closely managed our input 
costs including freight, raw materials and 
foreign exchange. 
Achieving this required an agile approach. In 
particular, we faced disruption in the Red Sea, 
causing delays to our main shipping route and 
additional freight surcharges. This demanded 
strong operational management from our 
commercial team.
Whilst we saw some small challenges to the 
availability of furniture in particular, we carefully 
worked through these to minimise the impact 
on our customers and ensure that they were 
able to get the products they wanted, when 
they wanted them.
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
7

Use the QR Code to 
see our Spring 2024 
TV campaign
Ambition & 
Innovation
The home of
We are a restless business, always keen to 
grow by learning and adapting. This brings 
big ambitions and a recognition that to 
achieve them we cannot stand still. We 
continue to test and learn with new ideas 
and innovations to our offer so that we 
remain as relevant as possible for our broad 
customer base. As we look to the future, it is 
this approach that will help us unlock our 
full potential. 
FY24 capex 
£40m
FY23 £22m
Own-brand products 
now Conscious Choice
c.26%
FY23 c.15%
Read more on page 30
Read more on page 33
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
8

The home of Ambition & Innovation continued
As market leader, we currently have a 7.7% 
share of the combined c.£24bn homewares and 
furniture market. Through continued innovation 
in our customer proposition and outstanding 
execution, we now see a clear pathway to 10% 
market share in the medium term. Whilst this is a 
medium-term milestone, our ambition does not 
stop there, with significant growth opportunities 
across all our categories.
Unlocking our full potential
In order to fulfil our ambitions we have evolved 
our strategic approach, ensuring we are 
developing and investing in the right areas to 
unlock our full potential as The Home of Homes. 
This is reflected in three strategic pillars: 
1)	 Elevate our product offer 
2)	 Connect with more customers
3)	 Harness our operational capabilities
We are benefitting from the improvements 
we have made to our technology and data 
capabilities over recent years, and our growing 
confidence and ability to innovate using new 
technology across our operations. Our strategic 
pillars, in combination with our skilled 
colleagues, can transform the way we amplify 
our advantaged business model and best meet 
the needs of our customers. 
	Read more on the evolution of our strategy 
in the CEO’s review on page 14
Long-term thinking 
Ambition and innovation thrives at Dunelm 
because we take decisions for the long term, 
a principle which has been in the business 
since its beginnings and remains one of our 
core values. This means we take multi-year 
investment decisions, develop our future 
leaders and make meaningful choices as we 
strive to be good and circular.
Doing the right thing for the long term is key to 
driving sustainable growth and value for all of 
our stakeholders.
A clear pathway to further market share growth 
5.0%
7.7%
10.0%
Medium
term
FY241
FY191
1.	
GlobalData UK combined homewares and furniture markets, 
excluding kitchen cabinetry and bathroom furniture.
Innovation in product design
Product is at the heart of Dunelm and innovation 
is central to the way we design our own-brand 
ranges. This brings differentiation from the 
competition and wider choice for our customers.
We’re accelerating experimentation, exploration 
and development and have created ‘Dunelm 
Lab’, a dedicated innovation team, focused on 
new technologies, new materials, and new 
manufacturing techniques to keep us at the 
forefront of new ideas in homewares. 
We are also working hard to ensure our 
products have longevity. In our lighting 
category we’ve designed our new Aurora 
range to allow customers to replace the LED 
component once it reaches the end of its life, as 
simply as replacing a bulb, meaning less waste. 
And our ‘Full Circle’ Austin sofa range features 
modularity, can be fully disassembled and 
reassembled, and manufactured using materials 
that can be recycled and repurposed. 
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
9

Harness our 
operational 
capabilities
Connect with 
more 
customers
Elevate our 
product offer
Our home in  
Communities
A home for  
our People
Our home  
the Planet
Read about it on  
the next page
O
u
r
 
S
t
r
a
t
e
g
y
B
e
i
n
g
 
G
o
o
d
 
&
 
C
i
r
c
u
l
a
r
Our business model
Our competitive advantages
Our customer
proposition
Our purpose,  
vision and values
Our governance
Stakeholder value
Read more on our six competitive advantages on the next page
Read more on  
our strategy  
on page 13
Read more  
on page 3
See our Governance  
report on page 56
Read more on  
being good and  
circular in our  
Sustainability 
Report 2024
Read about how we deliver for our stakeholders on the next page
Ensuring we are  
The Home of Homes 
for the long term 
Our business model delivers competitive 
advantage and combines our strategy 
with our good and circular approach to 
sustainable growth. This creates stakeholder 
value, guided by our purpose, vision and 
values, and strong governance.
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
10

Our business model continued
By ensuring that customers stay at the very 
centre of our thinking, we are confident in 
our plans to continue growing our sales and 
gaining market share. 
Value & choice
Great product quality & style for every budget
We offer customers relevant products across 
a broad range of categories with outstanding 
value and choice. Our customers are savvy, 
so we present attractive price points for every 
style and budget and ensure our products are 
practical, beautiful, and increasingly, sustainable. 
Fast & convenient
Everything easy to find, buy & use
We aim to provide an easy and seamless 
browsing, shopping and delivery experience, 
whether that’s in our stores, online, or a 
combination of the two. We focus on being 
efficient throughout the customer journey.
Friendly & expert
Service that is non-judgemental 
& knowledgeable
Whether in store, at the end of a phone (or email) 
or making a delivery to your home, we train our 
colleagues to be friendly, knowledgeable and 
helpful. Our investment in technology and data 
gives them additional tools to advise on product 
choice and availability more effectively.
Good & circular
Positive choices for our planet, communities 
and people
We are making it easier for our customers to 
make thoughtful choices by using more 
sustainable design, materials and manufacturing 
techniques, whilst doing the right thing in our 
communities and for our people. 
Our customer proposition
Market-leading brand
We are the market leader in a large and 
fragmented homewares and furniture market, 
with a total share of 7.7%1 and significant scope 
to continue growing across our categories.
Specialist product proposition
Our wide assortment of products offer quality, 
choice and value, appealing to a broad range 
of customers across different regions, ages 
and incomes. We offer good, better and best 
options across our assortment and appeal to 
a variety of styles, needs and budgets.
Total retail system
Our total retail system combines friendly and 
knowledgeable service across our 184 stores, 
with the convenience of browsing and shopping 
online. This gives customers options to shop their 
way and also brings services including Made-to-
Measure, Home Delivery and Click & Collect.
Unique operating model
We are a homewares specialist with largely 
own-brand product ranges, giving us a high 
degree of control over specification and 
sourcing, through long-standing relationships 
with our committed supplier partners.
Well-established values
Our colleagues are the heart of our business 
and feel a strong sense of belonging. Driven 
by our shared values, we create an inclusive 
environment for all to thrive.
Financial strength 
We have a strong balance sheet and a capital-
light growth model, with a track record of 
delivering sustainable, profitable growth and 
strong shareholder returns, whilst continuing 
to invest for the future.
Our competitive advantages
Customers
We offer a comprehensive range of relevant 
homewares and furniture products, at 
outstanding value, with the aim of helping our 
customers create the joy of truly feeling at 
home, now and for generations to come. 
+5.1%
increase in active customers2
Colleagues
We strive to be a diverse and inclusive employer 
for our c.11,500 colleagues, with a strong focus 
on progression and a supportive environment.
>60
graduates of ‘Reach’ development programme
Communities
Our stores and sites are a key part of their local 
communities, providing friendly service and 
advice, a place to refuel and relax in our Pausa 
cafes, and contributing to local good causes. 
We are opening in new locations, creating 
employment and extending our positive impact 
on communities across the UK.
190+
local communities serviced by our stores
Stakeholder value creation
Suppliers
We work closely with our suppliers to create 
and grow long-term value through mutually 
beneficial partnerships, whilst maintaining the 
highest ethical standards.
99%
invoices paid on time
Planet
Through design and the selection of materials 
and manufacturing processes, we consider and 
influence the impact of our products on the 
planet. We are increasingly exploring circular 
business models whilst ensuring we minimise 
the impact of our operations. 
–53%
reduction in Scope 1 carbon intensity vs base year
Shareholders
We deliver long-term sustainable growth, 
strong cash generation, a progressive ordinary 
dividend and excess cash returns to 
shareholders in the form of special dividends.
£158m
total dividends paid in the year
	Read more on how we engage with our 
stakeholders on pages 20 to 24
1. 	 GlobalData UK combined homewares and furniture markets, 
excluding kitchen cabinetry and bathroom furniture. 
2. 	 Growth in unique active customers who have transacted at least 
once in the 12 months to June 2024. Management estimates 
using Barclays data.
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
11

10%
20%
2019 share
2023 share
Furniture
Homewares
Our market
The UK’s market leader 
in homewares 
We are the market leader in a large and fragmented market, totalling 
c.£24bn1 across a broad range of homewares and furniture categories.
The market
We feel we are unique in our market as a 
multi-channel specialist homewares retailer. 
The competitive landscape varies significantly 
by category, comprising department stores, 
supermarkets, retailers with a single online or 
physical channel, and many smaller 
independent operators.
This substantial market has contracted in the 
last two years amidst a generally challenging 
macroeconomic environment, but has typically 
shown modest annual growth over the 
medium term.
Our progress
Our market share is currently 7.7%1, offering 
significant headroom for further growth. Against 
this backdrop, we have a strong track record of 
share gains in our recent, medium and long-term 
history, and have increased our share by 
270bps1 over the last five years. Our highest 
category market shares are close to 20%, 
typically in heritage areas where we have been 
trading throughout our history such as curtains 
and bedding. We generally have lower shares in 
some of our relatively newer categories, 
although still around 10% in the likes of gallery 
and dining furniture. Importantly, we are making 
share gains regardless of our category maturity, 
demonstrating the strength and breadth of 
our offer and opportunities ahead. 
Our plans
Whilst it is hard to predict customer sentiment 
in our market, we are confident in our plans to 
continue gaining market share, with an ambition 
to reach 10% in the medium term. Our vision is 
for more, and we see no ceiling at 10%, particularly 
as we have many categories already above this 
level and still growing.
We have a significant opportunity to help our 
customers discover and shop a wider range of 
our categories, given more than half of our 
customers only shop across three or fewer. 
This opportunity aligns well to our evolved 
strategic priorities, both to elevate our product 
offer across these categories, and to connect 
with more customers through our total retail 
system and increasingly personalised marketing.
Each bar represents a Dunelm homewares or furniture category which in total represent c.80% of total sales, mapped to GlobalData UK 
market sizes for the calendar year 2023 against calendar year 2019. Excludes certain Dunelm categories which are not part of the GlobalData 
UK homewares and furniture markets e.g. rugs.
1. 	
Based on GlobalData UK combined homewares and furniture markets, excluding kitchen cabinetry and bathroom furniture, including VAT.
Our market share by category
£24bn
combined market size1
7.7%
FY24 market share1
+270bps
growth in share vs FY191
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
12

Our strategy
Unlocking our full potential 
as The Home of Homes 
Harness our 
operational 
capabilities
Using our product mastery to increase 
relevance and appeal, extending our 
choice, value, design and style
Developing and expanding our channels, 
offering an easier and more personalised 
experience
Leveraging our skills and systems to 
transform our proposition, processes  
and productivity
Led by brilliant colleagues, powered by our growing technology and data capabilities 
Connect  
with more 
customers
Elevate  
our product 
offer
	Read more about our strategy in the  
CEO’s review on page 14
Our three strategic pillars
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
13

Introduction 
I am pleased to report another strong 
performance, in what remained a tough 
consumer environment. The homewares and 
furniture market was still soft and during the 
year we faced both inflationary pressures and 
disruption to major shipping routes. Nevertheless, 
we have again demonstrated the resilience of 
our business model in achieving growth, stable 
operating margins and strong cash returns. 
At the same time, we continue to invest for the 
long-term as we identify growth and productivity 
opportunities for the future. 
As we assess the changing consumer 
landscape, we are evolving our focus areas to 
frame our strategic priorities and investment 
choices. Entering this next phase of growth, 
we are committed to our vision to become the 
UK’s most trusted and valuable homewares 
and furniture brand, and will achieve this by 
unlocking our full potential as The Home 
of Homes. 
With a focus on further elevating our product 
offer, developing and expanding our stores 
and digital channels to connect with more 
customers and harnessing our operational 
capabilities, we are confident in continued 
market share gains. Indeed, our plans now give 
us a clear pathway to 10% market share in the 
medium term.
We were particularly pleased with the quality 
of our sales growth, with volumes up 6.2% being 
a positive indicator of our overall appeal. With 
volume growth ahead of sales, we saw a small 
reduction in our average item value, reflecting 
a slightly different product mix to the prior year, 
with the impact of price changes broadly stable. 
The strong volume growth was supported by an 
increase in the number of active customers, up 
5.1%2. Pleasingly, this growth was seen across all 
age, income and geographical cohorts.
Gross margin was strong in FY24, expanding 
by 170bps to 51.8% (FY23: 50.1%), ahead of our 
expectations at the start of the year. There were 
various moving parts within our input costs, and 
we particularly benefited from a net tailwind 
from lower freight rates which has now largely 
annualised. We were also able to avoid any 
significant impact from the disruption in the Red 
Sea, working closely with our freight providers 
to manage the impact of surcharges, whilst 
using the capabilities within our commercial 
teams to minimise availability issues. Our strong 
margin was achieved without price increases, 
as we maintained our commitment to offering 
outstanding value to our customers. As expected, 
operating costs as a proportion of sales increased 
to 39.3%, driven by inflation and the investments 
we are making to drive future growth. 
1. 	 GlobalData UK combined homewares and furniture markets, 
excluding kitchen cabinetry and bathroom furniture, including 
VAT. Prior year comparative restated.
2. 	 Growth in unique active customers who have transacted at least 
once in the 12 months to June 2024. Management estimates 
using Barclays data.
A clear pathway to further 
market share gains
CEO’s review
As ever, our strong performance and 
excitement for the future is due to the support, 
adaptability and skills of our committed 
colleagues and supplier partners. I would like 
to thank them all for everything they continue 
to do to grow, adapt and develop. It is due to 
them that we achieve these results, and are 
well-placed to unlock our full potential.
FY24 Review
A strong performance balancing growth 
and grip 
In FY24 we successfully balanced delivering 
growth with maintaining our firm operational 
grip on the business amidst a challenging 
consumer environment. We made good 
progress against our objectives, expanding our 
store estate in different sizes and locations as 
planned, continuing to improve our digital 
proposition, and enhancing our multi-channel 
experience for customers who prefer to shop 
both online and in store, including through 
a better Click & Collect proposition.
We grew our sales by 4.1%, in a market which 
declined, reflecting our ongoing customer 
appeal and continuing our consistent track 
record of market share gains. We now have 
a 7.7%1 share of a total addressable market 
(combining homewares and furniture) valued at 
c.£24bn1, up 60bps year-on-year, and significantly 
higher than the 5% we held in FY19, and see 
significant scope to increase this further.
We have clear focus areas which 
are framing our plans, and are 
extremely confident in our 
ability to deliver long-term 
sustainable growth.
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
14

What this means for 
our investors
Growth
Compelling runway to grow share of a  
large, fragmented addressable market
Consistent track record of share gains  
over recent and long-term history
Cash returns
High cash conversion
Well-established framework for  
returning cash to shareholders 
Sustainable profits
Continued investment for sustainable  
growth, maintaining stable operating  
margins
Resilient track record of performing  
through all economic cycles
Cost increases were partly offset by productivity 
improvements across the Group. Overall, PBT 
grew ahead of sales, up 6.6% to £205m (FY23: 
£193m), representing a strong PBT margin of 
12.0% (FY23: 11.8%). Diluted EPS fell by 0.8% 
to 74.4p (FY23: 75.0p), with our pre-tax profit 
growth offset by a higher effective tax rate, 
largely the result of increased corporation tax.
Our financial strength, including a healthy 
balance sheet and a capital-light growth model, 
is one of our core business advantages. This 
was reflected in another good year of cash 
generation, with free cash flow of £132m 
(FY23: £160m) representing 62% of operating 
profit. This enabled us to increase our ordinary 
dividend once again, and we are proposing a 
final dividend of 27.5p per share, bringing the 
full year ordinary dividend to 43.5p per share, 
up 3.6% year-on-year. In total, we returned 
£158m to shareholders during the year, 
including a special dividend of 35p announced 
at the interim results. This reflects our confidence 
in the business and ongoing commitment to 
our capital allocation policy and wider principle 
of delivering strong cash returns for our 
shareholders. Since our IPO in 2006, we have 
now returned c£1.5bn1 to shareholders.
Delivering for all our stakeholders
As well as a strong financial performance, we 
have delivered positive outcomes across our 
broad group of key stakeholders. We strive to 
make good decisions and ensure what we do 
is increasingly sustainable. During the year we 
reiterated our good and circular approach to 
sustainable growth, and continue to ensure it 
is embedded into our strategy and ways of 
working so that we are delivering for all of our 
stakeholders and focussing on our planet, 
communities and people.
CEO’s review continued
Good & Circular approach to sustainable growth
A unique, specialist proposition driving strong returns
A winning and resilient business model:
Market  
leader  
Low share of a  
c.£24bn2 highly 
fragmented  
market
Specialist  
product proposition 
Broad appeal 
across income  
and age groups
Total retail  
system 
Thriving stores and 
digital channels
Unique  
operating model 
Own-brand 
product design and 
committed supplier 
partners
Well-established 
values 
Growth mindset, 
frontline focus  
and long-term 
decisions
Financial  
strength 
Strong balance 
sheet and capital-
light growth  
model
1. 	 Ordinary dividends plus special distributions.
2. 	
Based on GlobalData UK combined homewares and furniture markets, excluding kitchen cabinetry and bathroom furniture, including VAT.
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
15

In FY24 we were proud to become the first 
homewares specialist to have validated SBTi 
targets across Scope 1, 2 and 3 carbon 
emissions1, which sees us align to the latest 
climate science from the Intergovernmental 
Panel on Climate Change (IPCC). We have also 
made further progress in extending our good 
and circular approach into our customer 
proposition, increasing the proportion of 
own-brand products which have our more 
sustainable ‘Conscious Choice’ label, and 
introducing the ‘Too Good to Go’ initiative to 
our Pausa cafes to help reduce food waste.
Our committed supplier partners are also 
helping us to limit our impact on the planet. 
Having grown together over several decades, 
we see these enduring relationships as a key 
strength of our unique operating model. On 
sustainability matters, we work together with our 
suppliers and continue to learn. Where necessary, 
we have been encouraging suppliers to adopt 
a data monitoring standard and action planning 
tool (the Higg Index) to underpin their improved 
manufacturing programmes.
We continue to place importance on and build 
momentum in the work our stores and sites do 
in their local communities. Originating during 
the pandemic and expanding since, all our 
stores now support important local organisations 
including selected schools, care homes, women’s 
refuges and more. Our annual Delivering Joy 
campaign is an example of this work in practice. 
Last year, I am immensely proud to say that we 
delivered 125,000 gifts, to these local causes. 
Communities also form the backbone of some 
of our circularity initiatives, including our 
expanding takeback schemes and ‘Home to 
Home’, through which customers can donate 
pre-loved homewares items to those in need.
We place great importance on the 
development and engagement of our 
committed colleagues. Developing our talent 
improves retention, enables internal succession, 
and increases our productivity and business 
resilience. Encouragingly, we saw colleague 
retention increase to 89%2 during the year 
(FY23: 87%). Whilst our colleague engagement 
score fell in FY243, although high by industry 
standards, we are actively listening to our 
colleagues. We see very strong response 
rates to our colleague engagement surveys 
throughout the year, which give us detailed and 
extensive feedback, from which we are building 
positive action plans across the business. 
As technology changes the nature of all roles 
across our business, we are as committed to 
lifetime learning as we are to early careers 
recruitment and development. Our data 
academy and apprenticeships are good 
examples of this. We are also excited about 
our ‘Reach’ development programme which 
launched during the year and is focused 
on increasing the number of ethnically 
diverse colleagues in senior positions. 
CEO’s review continued
Elevate  
our product 
offer
Collaborations  
and labels
Inspiration
Value and choice
Product mastery
Sustainability
Increasing our relevance and appeal: 
a better and bolder lighting offer
The scope for product elevation is very exciting, and we 
know that only the strongest product offer and relevance 
hits the mark with our customers.
1. 	 Our targets approved by the SBTi are as follows. Overall Net-
Zero Target: Dunelm Group PLC commits to reach net-zero 
greenhouse gas emissions across the value chain by FY40 from 
a FY19 base year. Near-Term Targets: Dunelm Group PLC 
commits to reduce absolute Scopes 1 and 2 GHG emissions by 
50% by FY30 from a FY19 base year. Dunelm Group PLC also 
commits to reduce absolute Scope 3 GHG emissions by 50% 
within the same timeframe. Long-Term Targets: Dunelm 
commits to reduce absolute Scope 1, 2 and 3 GHG emissions 
by 90% by FY40 from a FY19 base year.
2. 	 Retention is the percentage of colleagues from the start of the 
financial year (July 2023) who remained employed until the end 
of the financial year (June 2024), excluding any planned leavers.
3. 	 Colleague engagement score (eNPS) is based on responses to 
the question ‘How likely are you to recommend Dunelm as a 
place to work’ from our May colleague survey. Our eNPS score 
fell 10%pts year-on-year.
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
16

CEO’s review continued
We have much more to do in this area but 
are encouraged that the proportion of our 
‘role model’ leaders1 from ethnically diverse 
backgrounds increased to 5.8% in FY24 
(FY23: 3.8%). 
Unlocking our full potential as The Home 
of Homes
Looking forward, we have three broad focus 
areas which frame our priorities and investments. 
These are an evolution of the strategy we have 
followed over many years, and in combination 
will allow us to achieve our full potential as the 
Home of Homes, and to be the UK’s most 
trusted and valuable brand for homewares 
and furniture.
Firstly, in the area of product: we see 
opportunity to redouble our focus on product 
development, increasing our curated ranges, 
bolder design differentiation, enhancing 
cross-category coordination in our collections 
and innovation in sustainable materials. In 
recent times we have been acutely aware of the 
importance in having the right product offer, at 
the right time, to ensure we remain relevant and 
appealing to customers. In the year we saw this 
demonstrated with stronger upholstered 
furniture collections, combined with 5-day 
delivery lead-times. 
Secondly, we are building further confidence 
in opening more stores and developing our 
digital channels to deliver an outstanding and 
connected multi-channel shopping experience 
for our customers. We know that multi-channel 
shopping is the preference for most when it 
comes to homewares and furniture, so joining 
up our channels as much as possible is a priority. 
Thirdly, after building up our skills and 
operational capabilities in recent years, we see 
significant opportunity to harness them to 
achieve both productivity improvements and 
further strengthen our customer offer. In light 
of elevated wage inflation, and with growing 
technology and data capabilities, where 
foundational investment has been made over 
recent years, there are increasing opportunities 
to introduce more automation and productivity 
tools throughout the business. These are 
already driving efficiencies in parts of our 
operations (such as reducing volumes in the 
Customer Contact Centre) and our capacity to 
successfully implement more of these initiatives 
will increase going forward. 
Our three focus areas are therefore as follows:
1.  Elevate our product offer
2.  Connect with more customers
3.  Harness our operational capabilities
These focus areas are an evolution of the 
strategy that we have followed over many years 
and, in combination, will allow us to unlock our 
full potential as The Home of Homes. They 
support broad-based and long-term sustainable 
market share growth which can be delivered 
alongside stable operating margins and strong 
cash generation. In the medium term they 
shape our clear pathway to reaching our next 
milestone of 10% market share.
There are various examples which bring to 
life the initiatives which sit under each of our 
focus areas: 
1.  Elevate our product offer
Product has always been at the heart of 
Dunelm, and we have well-established 
capabilities across a broad range of categories, 
particularly in textiles and soft furnishings 
where our specialism dates back 45 years. 
Connect  
with more 
customers
Developing and 
expanding  
our channels
We know that the combination 
of stores and digital is the 
winning formula for our existing 
and target customers.
More store openings
We are taking our 
existing product 
strengths and 
elevating them 
further through 
design and 
innovation across 
all price and 
quality tiers.
1. 	 Regional and store coaches plus all colleagues at ‘Head of’ 
level and above, of which we currently have around 300 across 
the organisation.
More digital 
optimisation
More personalised
cross-channel 
experiences
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
17

CEO’s review continued
The scope for product elevation is very exciting, 
not just through broadening our ranges, but 
also by increasing relevance with more 
coordination and style. We are taking our 
existing product strengths and elevating them 
further through design and innovation across 
all price and quality tiers.
Lighting is a good example of the level of 
further opportunity we see ahead. We have 
consistently grown market share in the last five 
years and see headroom for more growth and 
innovation. Our in-house design capability 
allows us to coordinate across the wider Dunelm 
range, including our core textiles collections 
and cross-category labels such as Elements and 
our National History Museum collaboration. 
We are also working to accelerate our product 
development cycles to allow us to respond 
faster to trends and increase the choice we 
offer at all price and quality tiers. Our growing 
knowledge of more sustainable materials will 
also allow us to offer better choice to customers, 
as well as introduce more circular product 
design that uses more sustainable materials 
and facilitates repair and recycling. 
The made-to-measure window treatments 
category is another example of our product 
elevation opportunity, where taking greater 
end-to-end control of the supply chain will 
enable accelerated growth and returns. 
Alongside our well-established manufacturing 
centre for made-to-measure curtains and 
Roman blinds, we have chosen to invest in 
more vertical integration. In FY24 we brought 
the manufacture of custom hard blinds in-house 
and started manufacturing roller blinds and 
Venetian blinds in the Sunflex business we 
acquired two years ago. Looking ahead, we are 
bringing shutters into our own manufacturing 
facility, with a plan to launch our new offer to 
customers in FY25. This will give us differentiated 
and advantaged product, the ability to specify 
materials and design, shorten UK lead 
times relative to competitors, and improve 
factory utilisation by aligning demand and 
supply capacity.
2.  Connect with more customers
As we elevate our product offer, we will further 
improve how we connect our products to more 
customers through our total retail system. We 
have known for many years that the combination 
of stores and digital is the winning formula for 
our existing and target customers, and we are 
continuing to optimise our cross-channel offer, 
making the customer experience both easier 
and more personalised.
We have continued to open new superstores, 
with six new openings (including one relocation) 
in FY24, split evenly between our traditional 
c.30,000 sq ft size and newer smaller stores of 
c.15,000 sq ft. We are pleased with the returns 
of our new stores, typically paying back within 
three years, giving us confidence to open more 
stores in a range of sizes and locations. 
We will continue to open 30,000 sq ft 
superstores in large catchments given their very 
strong returns, however supply of appropriate 
sites has become more limited, so we are being 
agile in our approach. In the early part of the 
new financial year, we completed the freehold 
purchase of a tenanted retail site, which we will 
look to convert to a Dunelm format in the future.
We are continuing to optimise 
our offer across stores and digital, 
making the customer experience 
both easier and more personalised.
Product master 
data management
Supplier
portal
Demand
forecasting
Automated
replenishment
Scaling our commercial operations
From a traditional product life cycle journey to an automated,  
efficient operation that powers product mastery.
Our goal
To scale and upgrade our commercial operations and ways 
of working while retaining our advantaged commercial model.
Harness our  
operational 
capabilities
Leveraging our skills and  
systems: scaling and optimising 
commercial operations
Increasing our focus on harnessing our scale, capabilities and 
technology to realise process improvements and productivity.
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
18

CEO’s review continued
We will also open more smaller superstores, 
in smaller catchments and in the white space 
between stores in densely populated areas. 
Although this footprint is less developed for us, 
we are excited by what we have seen in our new 
smaller stores and by the opportunity to optimise 
sales densities and productivity as we continue 
to learn. Overall, having previously guided on 
5—10 new openings in FY24 and FY25, we now 
see a runway for this rate of growth continuing 
into the medium term (expected to be evenly 
split between larger and smaller sizes).
In addition, and to better serve our target 
customers in inner London boroughs, we are 
testing some smaller stores in London. Our first 
inner London store, at c.5,000 sq ft, will open in 
the first half of FY25, and we are exploring other 
locations to unlock the opportunity with this 
significant segment of the UK population where 
we know we are under-represented.
Complementing our stores, we have made 
continued progress in our digital channels, 
building strong foundations in our front-end 
architecture and customer data platform. 
As we move forward, we are advancing through 
optimisation and experimentation, with 
meaningful opportunities for improving our 
proposition. Offering a more personalised 
experience to our customers takes many forms, 
and using our improved data and technology 
will be key to improving our proposition. 
One example of this is a change to product 
discovery on dunelm.com, where we are 
implementing new AI search functionality in the 
first half of this year, having carried out testing in 
FY24. This will improve the quality, relevance and 
presentation of results when searching on our 
website, with test results showing fewer ‘zero 
results’ searches and more personalised results. 
This change moves us from earlier generation 
functionality towards an advanced AI solution. 
This will increase the appeal of searching on our 
site — a significant opportunity given customers 
who use search are four times more likely to 
complete a purchase than those who do not.
3.  Harness our operational capabilities
Though operational grip has been a 
characteristic of the Dunelm business for some 
time, we recognise an increased opportunity 
to harness our operational skills and scale. An 
ongoing focus on continuous improvement will 
remain, driving annual productivity savings, 
and with elevated wage inflation, there is now 
more scope for attractive returns from 
productivity tools and automation. Here we will 
test and learn to ensure we adopt the most 
appropriate technologies for our products and 
business model. 
We are making good progress in scaling our 
commercial operations, improving demand 
forecasting and replenishment across our stores 
and own distribution centres. Having carried out 
testing in FY24, we are in the process of rolling 
out new technology and ways of working in the 
first half of this year, introducing machine 
learning, automating low value tasks and 
reducing our reliance on manual processes 
and spreadsheets. 
Going forward, there is more work to do in 
relation to our smaller store footprints, specifically 
developing our processes and tools for 
optimising space, grading and range planning. 
This level of commercial transformation will 
facilitate our expanding product ranges, the 
efficiency of stock management in our 
distribution centres and our different store 
locations and sizes, and the speed of product 
development. These are complicated 
developments, but we expect these new 
capabilities to help us grow our market share 
profitably, while serving more customers and 
increasing the advantages of our business model.
Downstream from demand forecasting, we 
have an ongoing programme of continuous 
improvement to maximise the utilisation of 
our network capacity and improve labour 
productivity in our supply chain. In FY24 we 
focused on a series of tactical initiatives, 
including the optimisation of shift patterns for 
our colleagues; reducing our rate of returned 
products; and diversifying our carrier network 
to improve variable costs. 
In the coming years we will be working across 
our own distribution centres and with our 
supplier partners to increasingly automate our 
processes. Automation investment is becoming 
more attractive and we will find ways to optimise 
this for the specific product characteristics of 
homewares and furniture. For example, we will 
introduce simple automation of parcel packing 
and dispatch in our small-parcel home delivery 
operation in conjunction with our supply 
chain partner. 
Technology is moving rapidly, but cannot 
provide the solution in isolation. It is the 
combination of technology and well-executed 
business change, that leads to improvement. 
As we continue to test and learn, we are 
increasingly confident in our capabilities and 
capacity to do this successfully, in ways that 
deliver both growth and returns, in balance.
Summary and outlook
We delivered another strong performance in 
FY24, successfully balancing growth and 
operational grip in a soft market. We achieved 
high-quality sales and volume growth, and 
increased our PBT ahead of sales, whilst 
continuing to make progress against our 
strategic objectives.
We are gradually seeing improvements to 
economic indicators, however we are yet to see 
a meaningful change in consumer spending 
habits in our markets. In this context, we have 
made a solid start to the new financial year, 
against a strong prior year comparator.
We have refined our thinking on the key 
opportunities ahead of us, with three clear focus 
areas framing our investments and strategic 
priorities for the coming years, and we are 
confident we can accelerate into a consumer 
environment which presents a significant 
opportunity for market share growth. 
We now have good line of sight to continued 
market share gains and expect to reach our next 
milestone of a 10% total share in the medium 
term. We are very confident in our business 
model and clear plans that will continue to 
deliver sustainable growth and unlock our full 
potential as The Home of Homes.
Nick Wilkinson
Chief Executive Officer
11 September 2024
We recognise an increased 
opportunity to harness our 
operational skills and scale, and 
will test and learn to adopt the 
most appropriate technologies for 
our products and business model.
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
19

Stakeholder engagement
Understanding our 
stakeholders
By understanding what our key stakeholders care about, and considering 
their views, we can build more meaningful relationships and take fully 
informed decisions that create value for the long term.
Key stakeholders
We engage with a wide range of stakeholders 
at a Board level and in the day-to-day running 
of our business, seeking to build long-term 
relationships based on mutual growth and 
respect, consistent with our Code of Business 
Conduct, and our shared values and culture. 
Our key stakeholders are those who we know 
are highly likely to be affected by our actions 
and decisions, and vice versa. 
Responsibility for engagement at an operational 
level sits with members of the Executive Team, 
and is described on the following pages 21 to 
24. We also set out how the Board is kept 
informed about the interests of our key 
stakeholders, as well as how our Board 
members engage with them directly. 
Pages 72 and 73 in the Governance report 
provide further detail and examples of how 
stakeholder feedback is presented to the Board 
for discussion, debate and consideration as part 
of its decision-making, alongside metrics such 
as those set out on this page.
In May 2023, we undertook a materiality 
assessment with a third party to understand 
stakeholder perceptions relating to our most 
material environmental, social and governance 
(‘ESG’) topics. More information about this 
research can be found on pages 28 to 29 of our 
2023 Annual Report. Stakeholder feedback 
from that exercise is included in the ‘what they 
care about’ entries on the following pages.
In addition to key stakeholders, we 
acknowledge the importance of other 
stakeholder groups on page 24.
	Read our s.172(1) Companies Act 2006 
statement on page 25
Examples of metrics used by the Board to measure the effectiveness 
of our engagement
Customers
•	Unique active customer 
growth
•	Total revenue
•	NPS/CSAT
•	Safety scores
Colleagues
•	eNPS
•	RIDDOR¹ incidents
•	Retention
•	Whistleblowing
•	Diversity
Communities
•	Monies raised for good 
causes
•	Take-back
•	Community social media 
followers
Suppliers
•	% Tier 1 factories audited
•	% Products with responsibly 
sourced raw materials
•	Whistleblowing
•	CO2 emissions
Shareholders
•	Share price movements
•	Profitability
•	AGM voting outcomes
1. 	 Reporting of Injuries, Diseases and 
Dangerous Occurrences Regulations.
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
20

Stakeholder engagement continued
What they care about
 Value, style, choice and quality
 Product safety
 A great shopping experience and 
responsive customer services
 Responsible use and protection of  
personal data
 Ethical and sustainable sourcing
Key management responsibility
Customer Director
Why we engage
Our business revolves around our customers. 
We remain customer-focused in everything 
we do, striving to improve our proposition. 
We seek to achieve this by delivering great 
products, services and experiences. 
Engagement improves our customer insight 
which, in turn, influences our strategic pillars 
and capital allocation. Ongoing investment 
in customer data and analysis allows us to 
respond more quickly and accurately to 
develop relevant product ranges and services, 
helps drive brand awareness and grow our 
customer base.
How we engage day-to-day
•	During the shopping experience and at 
point of sale in store, with feedback being 
shared as appropriate within the business. 
•	By means of our customer service team and 
the channels by which it communicates with 
our customers.
•	Social media channels.
•	Customer focus groups/panels.
•	Customer surveys.
How the Board engages
•	Conducts store visits and reviews online 
experience.
•	Receives customer insights report at every 
Board meeting.
•	Monitors customer KPIs (including CSAT) and 
challenges management to ensure the 
customer proposition remains at the forefront 
of all development activities.
•	Receives regular updates on health and safety, 
product quality and ethics, sustainability and 
data protection.
How we have listened and learned — 
highlights in FY24
•	Improved ease of shopping with an interest 
free credit offer and improved cross-channel 
gift cards. 
•	Grew our ‘Conscious Choice’ range to c.26% 
of own-brand products.
•	Continued to invest in data security.
•	Expanded our Click & Collect offer.
•	Launched new safety campaign messaging 
— ‘In Our Home We Put Safety First’ — and 
implemented improvements to reduce risk of 
incidents in stores. 
•	Opened new stores outside of our traditional 
size and locations and continued to explore 
further opportunities to do so.
•	Continued to develop our ethical audit 
programme, which covers suppliers of 
own-brand products.
•	Continued to optimise dunelm.com through 
faster website and ‘back in stock’ notifications.
5.1%
1
growth in unique active customers 
shopping with us online and in store
1.	
Growth in unique active customers who have transacted at 
least once in the 12 months to June 2024. Management 
estimate using Barclays data.
Customers
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
21

Stakeholder engagement continued
What they care about
 Fair pay and reward
 Opportunities for progression
 A safe, inclusive and diverse workplace
 Personal data protection
 Opportunities to be listened to and 
make a difference
Key management responsibility
Stores and People Director
Why we engage
Committed and ambitious colleagues are at 
the heart of our business. We engage with 
them to understand how best to recruit, retain, 
motivate and reward them, including helping 
with their mental and financial wellbeing. 
We also use this information to make better 
decisions for our customers and communities 
and to support our strategic growth.
How we engage day-to-day
•	Annual colleague engagement survey, 
alongside targeted pulse surveys.
•	Two-way ‘always on’ communication via our 
Home Comforts intranet.
•	Regular CEO updates — ‘Nick’s Note’.
•	Colleagues represented through our National 
Colleague Voice (see right) and our Local and 
Regional Colleague Voice networks (see our 
Sustainability Report 2024 for more detail).
•	Store colleague roadshow, seminar and 
monthly newsletters.
•	Regular colleague ‘huddles’. 
•	24/7 independent, confidential 
whistleblowing hotline.
•	End of year events to reflect on the past year 
and look ahead to the new financial year.
How the Board engages
•	Visits stores and other sites.
•	Designated NED for colleague matters and 
CEO attend NCV meetings and report to 
the Board.
•	Receives People update in each CEO report 
to the Board.
•	Receives overview of whistleblowing reports.
•	Reviews key outcomes and actions from 
colleague engagement survey.
•	Reviews detailed colleague dashboard and 
metrics presented by the Stores and People 
Director at least twice per year.
•	Discusses the gender pay gap disclosure.
How we have listened and learned — 
highlights in FY24
•	Continued to invest in learning and career 
development opportunities to strengthen our 
employer value proposition, ‘grow’ talent and 
improve succession planning. This included 
a new ‘role-model leader’ programme and 
a data literacy academy. 
•	Taken a carefully considered approach to 
colleague pay and reward decisions for FY24.
•	Launched ‘Reach’ development programme 
for colleagues from underrepresented 
ethnic groups.
•	Provided additional colleague discount to 
celebrate 40 years of Dunelm stores.
•	Introduced new policy and tools to support 
colleagues who are also carers.
•	Reviewed our approach to colleague 
recognition, to ensure that it continues to 
develop in a fair and consistent way.
•	Focused further on the cadence and content 
of our colleague communications.
National Colleague Voice (‘NCV’)
Our colleague representative body, NCV, 
has been running for five years. Members 
represent a range of ages, ethnicities, 
genders, locations, tenures and levels of 
seniority across Dunelm. During FY24, we 
held four meetings, led by Nick Wilkinson 
and/or members of the People team. Marion 
Sears, who is our designated Non-Executive 
Director (‘NED’) for colleague matters, 
attended and other NEDs often joined, 
alongside presenters (as appropriate).
Each meeting comprises three parts: 
a business performance update, a ‘What’s 
on your mind?’ item for members to raise 
concerns, and ‘Big Topics’ where we 
communicate and seek feedback on important 
matters. In FY24, these were health and 
wellbeing, sustainability, diversity and inclusion, 
community initiatives and reward. The aim is 
to stimulate discussion and debate, with 
representatives acting as strong advocates 
for their colleagues. This is achieved by 
encouraging reps to ask their colleagues for 
views both generally and on the chosen ‘Big 
Topics’ in advance of meetings. After each 
meeting, reps share feedback with colleagues 
and views and concerns raised are presented 
to the Board. 
The NCV is a valuable forum for colleagues 
to engage, be listened to and see action as 
a result. For example, the suggestion of an 
additional discount to celebrate 40 years of 
stores came from a NCV meeting, and 
feedback on the launch of our ‘Home of You’ 
campaign, aimed at better understanding the 
diverse backgrounds of our colleagues, led to 
a review of our communications to ensure that 
its purpose more clearly resonates going 
forwards. We have also reviewed our 
approach to colleague recognition as a result 
of NCV discussions.
The NCV continues to be an important part 
of the dialogue on colleague pay and reward, 
as detailed further on pages 115. 
11,500+
colleagues
Colleagues
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
22

Stakeholder engagement continued
What they care about
 Services that support their community and 
local area
 Re-use, repair and recycling services
 Local employment and volunteering 
opportunities
 A business they are proud to have in their 
neighbourhood
 Charitable initiatives
Key management responsibility
Customer Director
Why we engage
By understanding local community needs and 
concerns we build awareness and trust, help 
evolve our customer offer, strengthen our local 
reputation and provide another reason for 
people to shop with us. We have also learned 
how much our customers and colleagues 
benefit from being involved in meaningful 
local initiatives and by having direct means 
of communication with their local store.
How we engage day-to-day
•	Community champions for each region 
facilitate the sharing of internal and external 
feedback, learnings and ideas.
•	Daily interaction with local store 
communities via individual store Facebook 
groups (organised by locally appointed 
community champions).
•	Feedback from local businesses and 
community groups who use space in stores 
and Pausa cafes.
•	Regular meetings with our Group charity 
partner, Age UK.
How the Board engages
•	Receives updates on charity and community 
initiatives.
•	Reviews community-related KPIs, including 
level of take-back and monies raised for 
good causes.
How we have listened and learned — 
highlights in FY24
•	125,000 gifts donated to local good causes 
through ‘Delivering Joy’ campaign, doubling 
the number of donated gifts.
•	Schools summer ‘wish-list’ campaign.
•	Group and colleague fundraising and 
Group cash charity contributions of £1.1m 
(FY23: £820k).
•	Launched new partnership with Age UK, 
committing to raise £2m in three years and, 
amongst other things, held our inaugural 
company-wide fundraising day. 
•	Undertook further trials for take-back, which 
included rugs.
•	Hosted repair workshops, including live 
upcycling demonstrations.
•	Partnered with ‘Too Good to Go’ in our 
Pausa cafes to reduce food waste. 
Communities
What they care about
 Fair trading and prompt payment terms
 Collaborating to maintain high ethical 
standards and deliver on sustainability 
initiatives
 Long-term relationships
 A growth opportunity for their business
Key management responsibility
Director of Commercial and Supply Chain
Why we engage
We work closely with our suppliers and 
manufacturers worldwide to develop 
relationships and business growth 
opportunities through regular engagement, 
and to ensure that we are aligned on the 
importance of upholding our high quality, 
ethical and environmental standards.
How we engage day-to-day
•	Hold annual stock supplier conference and 
regular webinars.
•	Regular supplier meetings.
•	Regular contact for our committed stock 
suppliers with our design and commercial 
teams, as well as our product quality, 
compliance and sustainability teams.
•	Dedicated procurement function engages 
with non-stock suppliers.
How the Board engages
•	Receives updates on ethical trading, product 
quality, modern slavery, supplier payment 
terms and whistleblowing reports.
•	Receives updates on progress against 
sustainability metrics. 
•	Ad hoc supplier meetings.
How we have listened and learned — 
highlights in FY24
•	Board held in-person meeting and Q&A 
session with key suppliers.
•	Held webinars with our key suppliers on 
‘Better Manufacturing’, ethical standards 
and packaging.
•	Reviewed our protocols for non-compliance.
•	Provided greater access to shared resources.
•	Continued to collaborate on sustainability 
initiatives and supported suppliers in 
adopting a data monitoring standard and 
action planning tool to underpin better 
manufacturing.
•	Extended whistleblowing service to all 
supplier sites in seven different languages. 
•	Launched our gold supplier programme to 
recognise suppliers who demonstrate 
effective management of the supply chain 
and empower them to become self-managing.
•	Reviewed and updated our procurement 
processes.
•	99% of invoices paid on time.
Suppliers
190+
local community 
catchment areas served 
by our stores and sites
1,200+
stock and non-stock suppliers
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
23

Stakeholder engagement continued
What they care about
 Strategy, performance and outlook
 Returns
 Strong leadership
 Culture and shared values conducive to 
good governance and high standards of 
business ethics
 Executive remuneration
 ESG risks and opportunities
Key management responsibility
CEO and CFO
Why we engage
Meaningful engagement is key to building 
trust and driving long-term success. It enables 
us to better understand our investors’ priorities 
and concerns. We help our shareholders and 
their representatives to have a good 
understanding of our business model, 
strategy, investment opportunities and culture, 
and we aim to be transparent and comply with 
shareholder governance requirements.
How we engage day-to-day
•	Executive Directors meet with investors 
during the year.
•	Arrange store visits.
•	Discuss ESG-related matters on request.
•	Via our corporate website.
How the Board engages
•	Chair seeks regular engagement with major 
shareholders on governance and 
performance against strategy.
•	Consults as appropriate.
•	Attends results presentations and the AGM.
•	Non-Executive Directors are available 
to discuss any matter with shareholders 
on request.
•	Reviews AGM voting, shareholder comments 
and proxy reports. Reviews investor roadshow 
feedback.
•	Governance and other meetings arranged 
as appropriate.
How we have listened and learned — 
highlights in FY24
•	Held 69 meetings with shareholders 
(excluding our largest shareholder) during 
the year. In addition, our Chair met with 
institutional investors to discuss a broad 
range of topics including governance, strategy 
and management. 
•	Hosted ‘At Home with Dunelm’, an event for 
institutional investors and analysts to showcase 
our product mastery and technology 
development, which was held alongside our 
Spring/Summer product show. 
•	89.14% of issued share capital voted at FY23 
Annual General Meeting.
•	Continued strong cash returns, with £158m 
paid in dividends. 
•	Integrated our ‘Good & Circular’ ESG 
ambitions into our strategy and ways 
of working.
•	Continued to develop Board capabilities for 
next phase of growth. 
Shareholders
1,870+
shareholders including the 
Adderley family
‘At Home with Dunelm’ investor event:  
Spring/Summer 2024 product show.
Other stakeholders
We work with a number of other stakeholders 
whose relationships are important to the 
day-to-day running of our business. These 
stakeholders tend to impact our business more 
than we impact theirs and, in some cases, 
engagement may be one-way. We monitor and 
evaluate these relationships regularly and the 
Board is informed as required. In all cases, our 
approach is to seek to build long-term trusted 
relationships based on fairness and respect, 
consistent with our Code of Business Conduct 
and our values.
Other stakeholders with whom we engage 
include:
•	Local and national UK Government bodies, 
including HMRC.
•	Industry bodies and working groups, such as 
Textiles 2030, Better Cotton and the British 
Retail Consortium. 
•	Regulators, including Leicestershire 
County Council and Charnwood Borough 
Council with whom we have a Primary 
Authority relationship, and other bodies 
such as the Health and Safety Executive, 
Trading Standards and Environmental 
Health Officers.
•	Banks and other financial institutions.
•	A trusted team of professional advisors (for 
example, brokers, financial PR, accountancy 
and recruitment firms, environment and 
sustainability advisors).
•	Shareholder representative bodies, ESG 
investment and credit ratings agencies and 
potential investors.
•	Other business support providers e.g. 
logistics, landlords (as the majority of our 
stores are leased), technology and 
construction/store development companies.
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
24

Section 172
Section 172 statement
Board decisions must balance the occasional conflicting needs 
and priorities of our key stakeholders, whilst also considering 
the likely consequences of such decisions in the long term.
Section 172 of the Companies Act 2006 (‘s.172’) 
requires a director of a company to act in good 
faith and promote the success of the company 
for the benefit of its members as a whole. In 
doing so, they must also have regard (amongst 
other things) to a range of factors set out in 
section 172(1) of the Companies Act, including 
the interests of stakeholders.
Engagement with stakeholders plays a hugely 
important role in ensuring that our Directors 
fully understand their needs and make well-
informed decisions that consider different 
priorities. We recognise that not every decision 
will benefit all stakeholders, and we inevitably 
have to make trade-offs between stakeholder 
groups from time to time. 
By taking account of the Company’s purpose 
and values together with its strategic aims, and 
closely following our decision-making process, 
we aim to make sure that our decisions are fair 
and consistent.
The preceding pages on stakeholder 
engagement and pages 71 to 73 of the 
Governance report provide examples of how 
the Directors performed their s.172 duties 
during the year.
The Board confirms that during the year under 
review, it has acted to promote the long-term 
success of the Company for the benefit of its 
shareholders whilst having due regard to the 
factors set out in section 172(1) (a) to (f) of the 
Companies Act 2006.
Signed for and on behalf of the Board
Nick Wilkinson
CEO
The table below outlines other areas of this report that set out how the Board has had 
regard to s.172(1) factors when making decisions: 
s.172(1) factor
Where to find more information
(a) likely consequences of any decisions in the 
long term
 Chair’s statement
 Business model
 CEO’s review
 Stakeholder engagement
 Board activities
4
10
14
20
71
(b) interests of the company’s employees
 Stakeholder engagement
 Non-financial and sustainability 
information
 Board activities
 Remuneration Committee report
20
34
71
89
(c) need to foster the company’s business 
relationships with suppliers, customers 
and others
 Business model
 Stakeholder engagement
10
20
(d) impact of the company’s operations on the 
community and environment
 CEO‘s review
 Sustainability
 TCFD report
 Board activities
14
32
46
71
(e) desirability of the company maintaining 
a reputation for high standards of 
business conduct
 Sustainability
 TCFD report
 Our approach to risk management
 Governance report
32
46
38
57
(f) need to act fairly as between members of 
the company
 
 Business model
 Stakeholder engagement
 Directors’ report
10
20
116
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
25

Key performance indicators
Measuring our progress
The Board uses a range of financial and non-financial key performance 
indicators (‘KPIs’) to measure overall Group performance and the success 
of our strategic direction in relation to our priorities.
Employee net promoter score 
(‘eNPS’)
Year-on-year improvement ppts
–10ppts
Base
year
-9%
-5%
+1%
+1%
FY20
FY24
FY23
FY22
FY21
Basis of measurement
Score based on responses to the 
question ‘How likely are you to 
recommend Dunelm as a place to 
work’ from our colleague survey 
which we conduct bi-annually. 
The above results are from May 
each year, apart from for FY20, 
where November 2019 was used 
due to postponement of the May 
2020 survey.
Why this measure is important
Rates our colleagues’ experience 
with us and the survey helps us 
understand where we need 
to improve.
FY24 progress
Our eNPS is above sector average, 
and these scores reflect a high 
response rate. Noting the 
year-on-year decline, the feedback 
received gives us valuable insight 
which we are using to implement a 
number of actions business-wide.
Scope 1 intensity reduction
% reduction against the base year
–53% 
Base
year
-53%
-32%
-20%
FY24
FY23
FY22
FY19
Basis of measurement
The reduction in Scope 1 carbon 
emissions in tonnes per £m of 
revenue, compared to our baseline 
of FY19. For further details on all 
carbon emissions, see our TCFD 
report on pages 46 to 54.
Why this measure is important
Helps us understand how 
successful we are in reducing our 
impact on the environment and 
progressing towards our long-term 
carbon reduction targets.
FY24 progress
We have continued to make 
progress in reducing our 
Scope 1 emissions. Our store 
decarbonisation programme 
continues to make headway, and 
carbon intensity reduced as a result 
of using compressed natural gas 
in our trunking fleet throughout 
the year.
Market share
Absolute % market share
7.7%
5.1%
7.7%
7.1%
6.8%
5.8%
FY20
FY24
FY23
FY22
FY21
Basis of measurement
Dunelm sales as a proportion of 
the GlobalData UK combined 
homewares and furniture markets, 
excluding kitchen cabinetry and 
bathroom furniture. Certain 
Dunelm categories which are not 
part of the GlobalData UK 
homewares and furniture markets 
are also excluded, such as rugs 
and Pausa. 
Why this measure is important
Demonstrates our performance 
relative to the wider homewares 
and furniture markets.
FY24 progress
We grew market share by 60bps 
against a challenging backdrop, 
owing to the strength and resilience 
of our proposition. 
Unique active customer growth
Year-on-year % growth 
+5.1%
+3.8%
+5.1%
+2.8%
+8.5%
+12.2%
FY20
FY24
FY23
FY22
FY21
Basis of measurement
Growth in unique active customers 
who have shopped in the last 12 
months, based on management 
estimates using Barclays data. This 
measure combines our active store 
and online customers.
Why this measure is important
Measures the growth in our active 
customer base and therefore our 
ability to reach new customers.
FY24 progress
Unique active customers grew by 
5.1% in FY24 alongside our market 
share gains, demonstrating our 
continued and growing customer 
relevance and reach.
Net promoter score (‘NPS’)
Year-on-year improvement ppts
+1.9ppts
Base
year
+1.9%
-0.9%
-4.2%
+4.2%
FY20
FY24
FY23
FY22
FY21
Basis of measurement
Weighted average NPS across store 
and online channels. FY24 NPS 
covers the nine months until 
30 April 2024. In May 2024 we began 
measuring customer satisfaction 
(‘CSAT’), which instead shows the 
percentage of customers who rate 
their experience with us as 5/5. We 
will report against CSAT from FY25. 
Why this measure is important
NPS (and in future, CSAT) measures 
how customers rate their overall 
experience with us. Understanding 
this is fundamental to retaining and 
acquiring customers and informing 
how we develop our offer. 
FY24 progress
NPS improved slightly in the year 
and going forward, in measuring 
CSAT we anticipate driving new 
insight into, and understanding of, 
customer experience and driving 
further improvements.
Diversity of our role-model leaders
% of role-model leaders from an 
ethnic minority background
5.8%
5.8%
3.8%
FY24
FY23
Basis of measurement
Proportion of our role-model 
leaders that come from ethnic 
minority backgrounds. Role-model 
leaders are defined as ‘Heads of’ 
and above and includes our 
regional and store coaches, of 
which we currently have around 
300 across the organisation. 
Why this measure is important
Ensuring our leadership and 
colleague base is diverse and 
representative of wider society 
will lead to a better proposition for 
our customers. 
FY24 progress
The proportion of role-model 
leaders from ethnic minority 
backgrounds has increased by 
2ppts to 5.8% by the end of FY24, 
however we maintain a more 
ambitious medium-term target.
Non-financial
Exec Rem
Exec Rem
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
26

Diluted earnings per share
Pence and growth %
74.4p
42.9
74.4
75.0
83.6
62.9
-14.0%
-0.8%
-10.3%
+32.9%
+46.6%
FY20
FY24
FY23
FY22
FY21
Basis of measurement
Profit after tax attributable to 
shareholders divided by the 
average number of dilutive 
outstanding shares (as per note 8 
on page 140). Not that FY22 
includes a 53rd week for statutory 
reporting purposes.
Why this measure is important
Reflects overall profit after tax for 
each share in the Company. 
FY24 progress
FY24 dEPS was 74.4p, and -0.8% 
on FY23. The slight year-on-year 
reduction reflects the growth in 
profit before tax offset by an 
increase in the effective tax rate, 
largely driven by the higher rate 
of corporation tax introduced in 
April 2023.
Total revenue
£m and growth %
£1,706m
1,058
1,706
1,639
1,581
1,336
-3.9%
+4.1%
+3.6%
+18.4%
+26.3%
FY20
FY24
FY23
FY22
FY21
Basis of measurement
Total reported business revenue. 
Note that FY22 includes a 53rd 
week for statutory reporting 
purposes.
Why this measure is important
Demonstrates our customer 
appeal, showing how successful we 
are at offering relevant products 
through convenient and easy-to-
access channels. 
FY24 progress
FY24 sales growth was 4.1%, with 
full year revenue of £1.7bn. Both 
digital and store channels were in 
growth for the year.
Profit before tax
£m and % of sales 
£205m
109
205
193
213
158
10.3%
12.0%
11.8%
13.5%
11.8%
FY20
FY24
FY23
FY22
FY21
Basis of measurement
Profit before tax reported in £m and 
as a % of total sales. Note that FY22 
includes a 53rd week for statutory 
reporting purposes.
Why this measure is important
Reflects our underlying financial 
performance and the balance of 
growth and grip exercised 
throughout the year.
FY24 progress
FY24 PBT of £205m was 6.6% 
ahead of the prior year, with PBT 
margin improving to 12.0% 
from 11.8%. 
Free cash flow
£m
£132m
175
132
160
153
109
FY20
FY24
FY23
FY22
FY21
Basis of measurement
Free cash flow is net cash 
generated from operating activities 
less capex (net of disposals), net 
interest paid (including leases) and 
loan transaction costs, and 
repayment of lease liabilities. Note 
that FY22 includes a 53rd week for 
statutory reporting purposes.
Why this measure is important
Allows the Board to monitor cash 
flows to support investment 
decisions for long-term profitability, 
or to return surplus cash to 
shareholders.
FY24 progress
Free cash flow of £132m represents 
62% of operating profit. This is 
lower than in FY23 due to increased 
capex, higher interest and tax rates, 
and a working capital outflow, due 
to timing on payables and the 
impact on inventory of delayed 
shipping routes.
Key performance indicators continued
We have long-term remuneration targets for 
Executive Directors including a range of 
financial and non-financial targets. Where 
relevant, we have highlighted where Group 
KPIs are also remuneration metrics.
Annually, we review our Group KPIs to ensure 
that they remain the most relevant indicators of 
the overall effectiveness of the Company, whilst 
maintaining consistency. The following metrics 
which were previously reported as Group KPIs 
can be found in our Sustainability Report 2024:
•	Reduction in virgin plastic packaging of 
own-brand products.
•	Percentage of own-brand products where 
we offer a take-back service.
•	Percentage of own-brand products which 
meet our ‘More Responsibly Sourced 
Cotton’ standard.
	Measures used in FY24 executive remuneration can be 
found in the Annual Report on Remuneration from page 101. 
Further information on the performance criteria that apply 
to the FY25—27 LTIP award can be found on page 113. 
Exec Rem
Financial
Exec Rem
Exec Rem
Exec Rem
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
27

CFO’s review
Continued profitable 
growth and cash returns
In a challenging market which declined 
year-on-year, our combined homewares and 
furniture market share increased by 60bps to 
7.7%1. This continues our strong track record 
of share gains, and we remain confident in our 
ability to keep growing our share of this large 
and fragmented market.
Total active customers increased by 5.1%2, an 
acceleration on the previous year (FY23: +2.8%), 
with growth across all customer age, income 
and geographical cohorts. In a year where we 
invested in brand awareness, we saw particularly 
strong growth rates in London and in younger 
(16—24 years) demographics. We were also 
pleased to see expansion in both multi-channel 
shoppers and those who shop only in-store or 
online, demonstrating the strength of our total 
retail system. 
Gross margin
Gross margin was strong at 51.8%, 170bps 
ahead of FY23 (FY23: 50.1%). Throughout the 
year we benefitted from a freight tailwind (partly 
offset by a foreign exchange headwind), despite 
Red Sea volatility and resulting surcharges. We 
are pleased that sales volumes grew alongside 
this strengthened margin, as we worked with 
our suppliers and applied operational grip to 
maintain our outstanding value proposition 
for customers. 
Total sales for the period to 29 June 2024 grew 
by 4.1% to £1,706m (FY23: £1,639m), with 
growth in all quarters of the year, despite ongoing 
uncertainty in our market. We are pleased that our 
sales progression was again driven by volume, 
which was up 6.2% supported by the strength 
and relevance of our proposition. The impact 
of pricing was broadly stable, and we saw an 
overall reduction in average item values driven 
by the product mix of sales. Both store and 
digital channels grew year-on-year, and digital 
participation increased again, up 1ppt to 37%. 
Customers continue to respond well to the 
breadth of our ranges, which we expanded 
throughout the year, ensuring that it remained 
curated and relevant. Overall growth was broad-
based across categories, demonstrating our 
customer appeal and the resilience of our 
proposition. We continue to benefit from 
elevating our product offer, with our ‘Cook & 
Dine’ and upholstered furniture categories 
maintaining their strong performance from the 
first half of the year. We also saw significant 
growth in our made-to-measure window 
treatments, where we have continued to expand 
our capability, bringing more of the manufacturing 
in-house and introducing new ranges such as 
Venetian blinds. Towards the end of the year, 
whilst seasonal ranges saw softer sales during a 
cooler spring and summer period, the Summer 
Sale performed particularly well, with customers 
taking advantage of both the discounted offers 
available, and shopping for full-priced products 
and new ranges. 
FY 2024 
Total Group sales
£1,706.5m  
+4.1% YoY
Digital % total sales
37% 
+1ppt YoY
Market share1
£7.7%
+60bps YoY
Active customer growth2
+5.1% YoY
1. 	 GlobalData UK combined homewares and furniture markets, 
excluding kitchen cabinetry and bathroom furniture, for the 
period July 2023 to June 2024. Prior year comparative restated.
2.	
Growth in unique active customers who have transacted at least 
once in the 12 months to June 2024. Management estimates 
using Barclays data.
We remain confident and 
committed to investing in 
the business for the long term, 
to drive sustainable and 
profitable growth. 
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
28

CFO’s review continued
Despite the ongoing challenging consumer 
environment, we have continued to invest in 
the business for the long-term, investing £25m 
in the year on new store openings, continuing 
to improve our digital proposition, and 
strengthening brand awareness and customer 
reach with our ‘Home of Homes’ campaigns. 
Our new store opening programme accelerated 
to six new store openings (including one 
relocation) in the year, and we now plan for 5—10 
new stores per year over the medium term. 
We continue to apply tight operational grip to 
cost management, and in the year we generated 
productivities and efficiencies of £11m, 
including savings from the optimisation of 
performance marketing costs, distribution cost 
savings from exiting external storage facilities, 
and continued process improvements in stores. 
As we move forward, as well as focussing on 
further continuous improvement initiatives, we 
will be investing in programmatic activities to 
help mitigate the impact of a wage inflationary 
environment. Alongside this, we remain 
committed to investment for long-term 
profitable growth from our strategic priorities.
Profit and earnings per share
Operating profit of £213m was £14m higher 
than the prior year (FY23: £199m), reflecting 
sales growth and gross margin expansion 
coupled with tight operational cost control in an 
environment where wage inflation continues to 
be a headwind. 
In a year of higher base rates, net finance costs 
of £8m (FY23: £6m) included interest on IFRS 16 
lease liabilities of £6m (FY23: £5m). Our strong 
cash flows and low levels of debt meant other 
financing costs did not put pressure on 
the business. 
spend, and also included the impact of a 
non-recurring deferred tax adjustment, as 
previously reported. Going forward, we expect 
the effective tax rate to trend between 50bps 
and 100bps above the headline tax rate of 25%.
Basic earnings per share (EPS) for the period was 
74.7 pence (FY23: 75.2 pence). Diluted earnings 
per share was 74.4 pence (FY23: 75.0 pence).
Cash generation and net debt 
In the period, the Group generated £132m of 
free cash flow (FY23: £160m), with conversion 
of operating profit to free cash flow of 62% 
(FY23: 81%). The lower conversion year-on-year 
is driven by higher capex, increased tax paid 
and a working capital outflow. 
In FY25 we will continue to tightly manage our 
input costs to deliver a continued strong gross 
margin, alongside outstanding value to 
customers. With year-on-year freight benefits 
now largely annualised and Red Sea disruption 
ongoing, we currently expect FY25 gross 
margins to be within a range of 51%—52%.
Operating costs 
Total operating costs were £670m (FY23: £622m) 
representing an operating costs:sales ratio of 39.3% 
(FY23: 38.0%). The year-on-year increase in the 
costs:sales ratio reflects ongoing inflationary 
pressures, and although we have partially offset 
these with productivity gains across our operations, 
our commitment to long-term investment in the 
business and the volume-driven nature of our 
sales growth means that as expected, there has 
been an increase in operating costs relative to 
sales. We focus on managing operating costs 
whilst optimising our overall operating margin 
to deliver long-term profitable growth.
The volume-driven nature of our sales growth 
resulted in an incremental £14m of variable 
costs, primarily across performance marketing 
and in our supply chain. Looking ahead, we 
expect our sales growth to continue to be 
volume driven. 
We have seen another year of inflationary 
headwinds, which increased costs by £20m for 
the year, consistent with the impact we saw in 
FY23. The main driver of this was wages, with the 
largest element of our cost base being the cost 
of hourly-paid colleagues. This cost has been 
impacted by the National Living Wage increasing 
by close to 10% in each of the last two years. 
Whilst we do not have visibility of the National 
Living Wage increases going forward, we 
expect this inflationary headwind to persist for 
some time. Therefore, we expect inflation in our 
operating cost base to continue at 3—4% in FY25.
Profit before tax in the period was £205m (FY23: 
£193m) with PBT margin of 12.0% (FY23: 11.8%). 
In FY25, we expect PBT margin to remain 
broadly stable, reflecting the balance of volume-
driven sales growth, strong gross margin and 
grip on operating costs in an inflationary 
environment, alongside a commitment to 
continued investment. 
Profit after tax of £151m (FY23: £152m) reflected 
an effective tax rate of 26.4% (FY23: 21.2%), the 
5.2ppt increase largely due to the annualisation 
of the higher UK headline rate of corporation tax 
introduced in April 2023. The effective tax rate 
was 140bps higher than the 25% headline rate, 
as we had slightly more disallowable 
expenditures in FY24 due to higher new store 
Cash generation and net debt 
FY24
£m
FY23 
£m
Operating profit
213.3
198.8
Depreciation and amortisation1
82.0
79.4
Net movement in working capital
(17.7)
(4.2)
Share-based payments
4.3
4.8
Tax paid
(49.6)
(38.2)
Net cash generated from operating activities
232.3
240.6
Capex and business combinations
(39.9)
(21.8)
Net interest and loan transaction costs2
(3.3)
(1.1)
Interest paid on lease liabilities
(6.1)
(5.3)
Repayment of principal element of lease liabilities
(50.8)
(52.0)
Free cash flow 
132.2
160.4
1.	
Including impairment and loss on disposal
2.	
Excluding interest on lease liabilities 
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
29

CFO’s review continued
After total dividend payments in the period of 
£158m (FY23: £163m), the Group ended the 
year with net debt2 of £56m (FY23: £31m). 
Banking agreements 
At the year end, the Group had in place a 
£250m unsecured revolving credit facility 
(“RCF”). The terms of the RCF included 
covenants in respect of leverage (net debt3 to 
be no greater than 2.5× adjusted EBITDA4) and 
fixed charge cover (EBITDAR5 to be no less than 
1.75× fixed charges6), both of which were met 
comfortably as at 29 June 2024. A one-year 
extension to the facility was agreed in August 
2024, with a maturity date of September 2028. 
The terms are consistent with normal business 
practice and the covenants are unchanged. 
There is an option to extend by another year at 
Dunelm’s request, subject to lender consent. 
The Group also maintains £10m of 
uncommitted overdraft facilities.
Going concern 
At the time of approving the financial 
statements, the Board of Directors is required to 
formally assess that the business has adequate 
resources to continue in operation and as such 
can continue to adopt the ‘going concern’ basis 
of accounting. To support this assessment, the 
Board is required to consider the Group’s current 
financial position, its strategy, the market outlook 
and its principal risks.
The Directors continue to assess the risks that 
climate change poses to the business. Currently, 
climate change is not expected to have a 
significant impact on the Group’s going concern 
assessment or on the viability of the Group over 
the next three years.
Reverse stress modelling has demonstrated that 
a prolonged sales reduction of 26% in each year 
is required to breach covenants by the end of 
FY26 and a 42% sales reduction in each year is 
required to breach the RCF limit by the end of 
FY26, assuming reasonable mitigating actions 
have been implemented.
Even in such an event, management would 
follow a similar course of action to that initially 
undertaken during the COVID-19 pandemic. 
Such actions could include reductions in 
discretionary spend and delaying investments.
The working capital outflow in the period 
was £18m (FY23: £4m outflow). The main 
contributing factors driving the outflow were 
the timing of a VAT payment and the impact on 
inventory of delays in our main shipping route, 
which we continue to manage well operationally. 
We expect working capital to be broadly neutral 
for FY25.
Total capital investment was £40m (FY23: 
£22m), in line with our guidance. Capex of 
c.£25m related to stores, including the six new 
superstores opened in the year, 13 refits of 
existing stores and our ongoing decarbonisation 
programme. In June 2024 we purchased a 
tenanted non-retail freehold property for £8m, 
providing current rental income and future 
capacity for our support centre. 
In FY25 we expect our capital expenditure to 
increase to £50m—£60m. In line with previous 
guidance, we expect to open 5—10 new 
superstores (as in FY24, broadly evenly split 
between larger and smaller sites1), and we now 
expect new openings to continue at this rate for 
the medium term. In the early part of the new 
financial year, we secured a freehold tenanted 
retail property in an attractive location for £22m 
which we plan to convert to a Dunelm format in 
the future. Whilst we expect the majority of our 
new openings to be leasehold, we have the 
capacity to purchase freeholds where there 
are sufficiently attractive returns.
Cash tax paid was £50m (FY23: £38m), 
reflecting the higher effective tax rate. 
In the period, the Group did not purchase 
any shares to be held in treasury (FY23: £7m). 
The Group held 1.2m shares in treasury as at 
29 June 2024, sufficient to satisfy future 
obligations under its employee share schemes.
The key judgement that the Directors have 
considered in forming their conclusion is the 
potential impact on future revenue, profits and 
cashflows of a downturn in consumer spending 
away from homewares, due to the ongoing 
impact of sustained inflation, as well as the 
impact of broader economic uncertainty across 
a three-year review period. This scenario could 
result in no growth in Year 1 and lower sales and 
higher costs across all channels throughout the 
review period. The Directors have also 
considered a deeper downturn in consumer 
spending away from homewares, resulting in 
negative growth in Year 1 and lower sales and 
higher costs across all channels throughout the 
review period.
In both downside scenarios Dunelm has 
sufficient liquidity to continue trading, including 
maintaining the payment of dividends in line 
with the business’ dividend policy, and to 
comfortably meet financial covenants. 
1.	
Larger superstores c.30,000 sq ft, smaller superstores 
c.15,000 sq ft.
2.	
Excluding lease liabilities. Full definition provided in the table 
of alternative performance measures.
3.	
Excluding lease liabilities. Full definition provided in the table 
of alternative performance measures.
4.	
Adjusted EBITDA defined as EBITDA less depreciation on 
right-of-use assets.
5.	
EBITDAR defined as EBITDA plus rent.
6.	
Fixed charges are defined as net interest costs plus right-of-use 
asset depreciation plus rent.
Our tax strategy 
FY24
£m
FY23 
£m
Net VAT collected
173.0
164.7
Payroll taxes including National Insurance7
60.8
56.2
Corporation tax
49.5
38.2
Plastic packaging tax
0.0
0.1
Total tax contributions
283.3
259.2
7.	
All Dunelm colleagues are based in the United Kingdom, except for 50 colleagues who work in our store in Jersey. Payroll taxes for 
FY22 have been restated.
Dunelm is committed to full compliance with all statutory obligations and full disclosure to tax authorities. The 
Group’s tax affairs are managed in a way that is consistent with the Group’s commitment to high standards of 
governance. The Board has established a set of principles that form the basis of the management philosophy 
and the tax policy of the Group. These principles can be found in full in our Group Tax Strategy which is 
published on our corporate website and reviewed each year. Our Group Tax Strategy sets out one shared vision 
within the Group of tax compliance and one view of performance.
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
30

FY24
43.5
35.0
FY23
42.0
40.0
FY22
40.0
37.0
FY20
FY21
35.0
65.0
FY19
28.0
32.0
FY18
FY16
25.1
31.5
FY17
FY15
21.5
70.0
FY14
FY12
FY13
16.0
25.0
FY11
FY10
8.0
21.5
FY08
FY07
FY09
78.5
82.0
77.0
100.0
60.0
26.5
56.6
26.0
91.5
20.0
14.0
41.0
11.5
29.5
5.5
3.8
6.0
CFO’s review continued
Dividends
The Board has proposed a final ordinary 
dividend of 27.5 pence per share, recognising 
our performance in the year and ongoing 
confidence in the business. This takes the full 
year ordinary dividend to 43.5 pence per share, 
3.6% ahead of the 42.0 pence per share paid in 
FY23, with dividend cover2 of 1.71×. Whilst 
dividend cover is slightly below the range set 
out in the Group’s policy, the Board considers 
the level of cover appropriate in light of the 6.6% 
year-on-year increase in PBT, with earnings 
impacted by the increase in effective tax rate, 
including a non-recurring impact. The final 
dividend will be paid on 26 November 2024 
subject to approval by shareholders at the AGM 
on 21 November 2024. The ex-dividend date is 
31 October 2024 and the record date is 
1 November 2024. 
We paid total dividends of £158m in the year, 
including a special dividend of £71m.
Karen Witts
Chief Financial Officer
11 September 2024
As a result, the Board believes that the Group 
is well placed to manage its financing and other 
significant risks satisfactorily and that the Group 
will be able to operate within the level of its 
facilities and meet its liabilities as they fall due, 
for at least the next three years. For this reason, 
the Board considers it appropriate for the 
Group to adopt the going concern basis in 
preparing its financial statements.
Capital and dividend policies
The Board policy on capital structure targets 
an average net debt level (excluding lease 
obligations and short-term fluctuations in 
working capital) of between 0.2× and 0.6× the 
last 12 months’ EBITDA1. The Group expects 
to maintain or steadily increase the absolute 
amount of each dividend payment in line with 
the growth of the business. 
The Group’s dividend policy targets ordinary 
dividend cover of between 1.75× and 2.25× 
earnings per share during the financial year to 
which the dividend relates. The Board may allow 
a temporary fall in dividend cover requirements 
in order to maintain the dividend.
The Board will continue to consider returning 
surplus cash to shareholders if average net 
debt, excluding lease liabilities, over a period, 
consistently falls below the minimum target of 
0.2× EBITDA1, subject to known and anticipated 
investment and expenditure plans at the time. 
	The Group’s full capital and dividend 
policies are available on our website at 
corporate.dunelm.com
1.	
EBITDA defined as operating profit plus depreciation and amortisation of property, plant and equipment and intangible assets plus loss 
on disposal and impairment of property, plant and equipment and intangible assets plus depreciation on right-of-use assets.
2.	
Dividend cover is calculated as earnings per share divided by the total ordinary dividend relating to the financial year.
3.	
Ordinary dividends plus special distributions.
Capital and dividend policies
•	Target average net debt between 0.2× 
and 0.6× the last 12 months’ EBITDA.1
•	Ordinary dividend cover of between 1.75× 
and 2.25× earnings per share during the 
financial year to which the dividend relates.
•	Return surplus cash if net debt consistently 
falls below the minimum target of 
0.2×EBITDA.1
Dividend history (pence per share)
	Ordinary dividend
	Special distributions
Significant shareholder 
returns since IPO 
Ordinary dividend CAGR
15%  
Cash returned to shareholders3
C. £1.5bn
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
31

The Home of Homes: 
Committed to being 
good & circular
Dunelm Group plc
Sustainability report 2024
Sustainability
Our approach to sustainability:
Being Good & Circular
As the UK’s leading homewares retailer, we have both a passion and an 
obligation to do the right thing. This means remaining ambitious about being 
a company that focuses on growing sustainably. It means long-term thinking 
combined with shorter-term, achievable goals. It means being good and 
circular, a core part of our customer proposition. Our approach is outlined 
below, recognising that we want to look after all our homes:
A home for 
our People
We recognise the Planet provides the 
resources we use to create our products.
We have a role in the Communities where 
our stores and sites operate.
We create a home for People working in both 
our business and our wider supply chain.
Our home in 
Communities
Our home  
the Planet
Protecting all of our Homes
Our strong corporate and ESG governance frameworks, holistic approach to risk management and well-established codes of conduct and policies 
protect our stakeholders and preserve value in our business.
SR
Read more on our 
commitment to being 
good and circular in our 
Sustainability Report 2024
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
32

Sustainability continued
Being Good & Circular in FY24: key highlights
•	Reduced our overall Scope 1 carbon emissions by 27% 
from our FY19 baseline despite strong sales growth of 53% 
over the same period.
•	Increased the number of own-brand products in our 
Conscious Choice range to c.26% from c.15% last year. 
Conscious Choice products are made from at least 50% 
‘More Responsibly Sourced’ materials (by weight) when 
compared to conventional alternatives available 
from Dunelm. 
•	Developed our circularity strategy and worked with 
product teams to implement circular design principles into 
product development.
•	Launched the Higg Facility Environmental Module (‘FEM’) 
for our Tier 1 suppliers as part of our Better Manufacturing 
programme. At the end of FY24, over 80% of our Tier 1 
suppliers completed and disclosed data to the Higg FEM. 
•	Doubled the number of gifts donated to over 125,000 
during our ‘Delivering Joy’ campaign in December 2023, 
our biggest year yet. 
•	Raised £1.8m over three successful years of working with Mind. 
In January we launched our new charity partnership with Age 
UK, with a commitment to raise £2m over the next three years. 
•	Expanded our Home to Home scheme, where customers 
can donate pre-loved and good quality homewares such as 
crockery and glasses in our stores, to 39 stores, with 
support from Age UK. 
•	Continued to run in-store repair pilots with workshops, 
drop-in repair cafes and live demonstrations to engage local 
customers and communities on extending product lifetimes. 
•	Grew the popularity of our in-store textile takeback service, 
with customers now, on average, bringing c.98 tonnes of 
textiles to stores each month.
•	Colleague retention increased to 89% from 87% in FY23. 
•	Further developed our colleague benefits package by 
introducing a new £10,000 Life Assurance benefit. 
•	Built on our Role Model Leadership programme with 86 
enrolments to a year-long development scheme.
•	Continued to listen and respond to colleagues through an 
expanded programme of engagement surveys.
•	Launched our ‘Reach’ development programme for 
colleagues from underrepresented ethnic groups, 
providing skills training, connection and career 
advancement opportunities. 
•	Introduced a data literacy campaign for colleagues to build 
knowledge and capabilities within the business.
Our home the Planet
A home for our People
Our home in Communities
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
33

In the following pages, we present information 
relating to the non-financial reporting 
requirements as contained in sections 414CA 
and 414CB of the Companies Act 2006. These 
include our commitment to and management 
of environmental and social matters (as listed in 
the requirements) and how these impact our 
business and key stakeholders (including, for 
these purposes, the Planet). We include links to 
some of our relevant policies and references to 
where additional information can be found both 
within and outside this report. In addition, our 
business model can be found on pages 10 to 11 
and our principal risks, which are linked to each 
stakeholder group (as appropriate), are set out 
on pages 40 to 45.
Our approach 
Our vision is to build the UK’s most trusted and 
valuable brand for homewares and furniture. 
We have a legal and moral obligation to 
develop and sell products that are safe to use 
(and safe to eat from our Pausa cafes) and that 
are accurately and fairly labelled, marketed and 
sold to our customers. We must also provide a 
safe environment for our customers to shop — 
whether in store, online or receiving home 
deliveries. As we increase our customer 
engagement, we have a responsibility to look 
after and treat our customers’ personal data 
and information with respect and integrity. 
Increasingly, we are giving our customers the 
option to choose from a range of products that 
are sourced ‘more responsibly’ (with strict 
qualifying criteria set). 
Our outcomes 
Alongside measuring customer numbers and 
shopping frequency, we predominantly 
measure the outcomes relevant to our approach 
through our customer Net Promoter Score 
(‘NPS’). We will report using a Customer 
Satisfaction Score (‘CSAT’) from FY25.
Non-financial and sustainability 
information statement FY24
Non-financial and sustainability information
Customers 
Some of our relevant policies  
(see website: corporate.dunelm.com)
•	Data Security and Privacy Policy
•	Health and Safety Policy
Where to find more information 
and outcomes in this report
Page/s
 Customer proposition in the 
business model
11
 Stakeholder engagement 
and s.172 statement
20—25
 Net promoter score
26
 Principal risks and uncertainties
40—45
Additional information outside 
this report
•	Sustainability Report 2024
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
34

Gender breakdown, year-end FY24 versus year-end FY23
Female
Male
Total
FY24
FY24
FY23
Change
FY24
FY23
Change
Group Board
5
5
 0
7
6
+1
12
42%
45%
-3%
58%
55%
+3%
Senior leadership1
12
17
-5
18
17
+1
30
40%
50%
-10%
60%
50%
+10%
Store  
colleagues
 6,376 
 6,499 
-123
 2,433 
 2,351 
+82
8,809
72%
73%
-1%
28%
27%
+1%
All  
colleagues
 7,582 
 7,669 
-87
 3,990 
 3,828 
+162
11,572
66%
67%
-1%
34%
33%
+1%
1.	
Senior leadership for these purposes means our Executive Team (excluding Executive Directors who sit on the Group Board) and 
members of our Dunelm leadership team. 
Non-financial and sustainability information continued
Note: This data covers 92% of all colleagues.
Ethnicity data
	1. White — British 79%
	2. White — Other 6%
	3. Asian British 9%
	4. Black 3%
	5. Multi-ethnic 2%
	6. Other 1%
1.
3.
2.
4. 5.6.
Colleagues
Some of our relevant policies  
(see website: corporate.dunelm.com)
•	Data Security and Privacy Policy
•	Health and Safety Policy
•	Equality and Diversity Policy
•	Whistleblowing Policy
•	Anti-corruption and Anti-bribery Policy
•	Domestic Abuse Policy
•	Colleague Code of Conduct
•	Code of Business Conduct
Where to find more information 
and outcomes in this report
Page/s
 Chair’s statement 
4—5
 CEO’s review 
14—19
 Stakeholder engagement,  
s.172 statement and 
‘Our approach to s.172’ in the 
Governance report 
20—25,72
 Employee net promoter score 
26
 Sustainability
32—33
 Principal risks and uncertainties
40—45
 Culture and values 
68—70
 ‘Diversity and inclusion’ in 
Nomination Committee report
79
 Remuneration Committee 
report
89—115
Additional information outside 
this report
•	Sustainability Report 2024 
•	Gender Pay Report 2024
•	Slavery and Human Trafficking Statement
Our approach 
We are committed to treating our colleagues 
fairly, to reward them appropriately for the work 
they do and to give them opportunities to 
develop and learn. We want them to be heard 
and feel connected to our business and to feel 
‘at home’ in a safe and inclusive working 
environment. We continue to support their 
mental and financial wellbeing — particularly 
given the pressures on our colleagues in the 
current UK economic environment.
Our commitment to protecting colleagues can 
be found in our Code of Business Conduct and 
Colleague Code of Conduct. All colleagues are 
obliged to comply with our Anti-corruption and 
Anti-bribery Policy and are trained upon induction. 
We continue to focus on achieving diversity and 
gender balance across all levels of the business. 
Our median gender pay gap of 5.5% and our 
mean gender pay gap of 16.9% reflect that 70% 
of our colleagues are women, 90% of whom are 
in hourly-paid, predominantly store roles.
We work with our colleague network groups to 
understand possible barriers and challenges to 
progression and have adapted policies as a 
result. We have expanded our apprenticeship 
programme to improve social mobility.
Our outcomes 
Alongside a number of colleague and culture 
metrics (including colleague retention and 
promotion from within) we predominantly 
measure the outcomes of the above through 
our employee net promoter score (eNPS).
Colleague network groups
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
35

Non-financial and sustainability information continued
Our approach 
We are increasingly making more meaningful 
connections to support thriving, purpose-driven 
communities in and around our stores and other 
sites. We want to be known as the brand that 
puts community at the heart of its business to 
help people feel more at home by expanding 
community initiatives and services (including 
our take-back services which are highly popular 
and valued by our store communities). 
Alongside promoting Group-wide fundraising 
activities we encourage colleagues to support 
local charities, businesses and community 
groups. We are also committed to full compliance 
with all statutory tax obligations and full 
disclosure to tax authorities. 
Our outcomes 
At a Group level we track the amount of Group 
and colleague fundraising and Group cash 
charity contributions. Informally, we monitor the 
number of store Facebook group followers and 
the number of small businesses and community 
groups that we support at the store level.
Our approach 
We have a responsibility to protect and respect 
human rights and to uphold high ethical 
standards in our supply chains. We set out our 
minimum expectations in our Ethical Code of 
Conduct for Suppliers and Partners that applies 
to all businesses involved in the production of 
goods for Dunelm and we use a risk-based 
approach in our ethical auditing programme to 
monitor supply chain practices against our 
standards. We aim to work collaboratively with 
suppliers to achieve continuous improvement 
through increased engagement and education 
— including environmental and product quality 
standards, alongside ethical considerations. We 
are committed to treating our suppliers properly 
in accordance with agreed terms and conditions 
and to paying them promptly. 
Our outcomes 
We have set a Group target to increase the 
roll out of our Conscious Choice range which 
promotes more sustainable practices. We have 
also set sustainability metrics for other sourced 
materials such as timber and palm oil.
Suppliers
Some of our relevant policies  
(see website: corporate.dunelm.com)
•	Whistleblowing Policy
•	Anti-corruption and
•	Anti-bribery Policy
•	Ethical Code of Conduct for Suppliers and 
Partners
•	Responsible Animal Welfare Policy
•	Responsible Cotton Policy
•	Responsible Palm Oil Sourcing Policy
•	Responsible Timber Policy
•	Competition Law Policy
Where to find more information 
and outcomes in this report
Page/s
 Stakeholder engagement 
and s.172 statement 
20—25
 Sustainability 
32—33
 Principal risks and uncertainties
40—45
Additional information outside 
this report
•	Sustainability Report 2024
•	Slavery and Human Trafficking Statement
Communities
Some of our relevant policies  
(see website: corporate.dunelm.com)
•	Tax Strategy
•	Responsible Cotton Policy 
•	Responsible Timber Policy
Where to find more information 
and outcomes in this report
Page/s
 Chair’s statement 
4—5
 CEO’s review 
14—19
 Stakeholder engagement 
and s.172 statement
20—25
 Sustainability
32—33
 Principal risks and uncertainties
40—45
Additional information outside 
this report
•	Sustainability Report 2024
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
36

Non-financial and sustainability information continued
Planet
Some of our relevant policies  
(see website: corporate.dunelm.com)
•	Environmental Policy
•	Plastic and Packaging Policy
Where to find more information 
and outcomes in this report
Page/s
 s.172 statement 
25
 Scope 1 carbon intensity 
reduction
26
 Principal risks and uncertainties
40—45
 Task Force on Climate-related 
Financial Disclosures report 
46—54
 Streamlined Energy and 
Carbon Reporting
53
 Chair’s introduction in the 
Governance report
57—58
 ‘Our approach to s.172’ 
in the Governance report 
72
 ‘Sustainability reporting’ in 
Audit and Risk Committee
84
 ESG metrics within Executive 
remuneration 
105,106
Additional information outside 
this report
•	Sustainability Report 2024 
Our approach 
Our investment in resources to focus on being 
good and circular (a central part of our business 
model and overall approach to sustainability) 
has increased the level of awareness across the 
business for the need to take urgent action to 
reduce our impacts on the planet. Our goal is to 
reduce our absolute greenhouse gas (‘GHG’) 
emissions by 50% by FY30 against a FY19 
baseline. We have had our near-term and net 
zero targets validated by the SBTi, which sees 
us align to the latest climate science from the 
Intergovernmental Panel on Climate Change 
(IPCC). We support the British Retail Consortium’s 
Climate Action Roadmap to achieve net zero by 
2040, and we are a partner member of Textiles 
2030, with a commitment to meet their carbon 
and water footprint reduction targets. We 
remain focused on reducing operational waste, 
including plastics and other packaging, and 
exploring product circularity solutions. 
Our outcomes 
We have made considerable progress in better 
understanding the most significant sources of 
GHG emissions along our supply chains, using 
our “improve-innovate-advocate” approach. 
Metrics relating to Scope 1 carbon emissions 
intensity are set as Group KPIs to maintain our 
focus. Although we are still at an early stage, 
we are making headway in our product 
circularity plans. 
Greenhouse gas emissions and Streamlined 
Energy and Carbon Reporting information can 
be found on page 53.
Our approach 
We strive to provide our shareholders with as 
clear a picture as possible of our business and 
our prospects — both financial and non-financial 
— in order to enable them to make informed 
investment decisions. We give various 
opportunities for shareholders to meet our 
Board and management through scheduled 
meetings and on request. We provide regular 
overviews of our governance arrangements and 
our progress in non-financial reporting. 
Our outcomes
Our focus on sustainable returns has led to 
progressive ordinary and special dividends. We 
have returned c.£1.5bn since IPO to shareholders 
through dividends and special distributions.
Shareholders
Some of our relevant policies  
(see website: corporate.dunelm.com)
•	Capital and Dividend Policy
•	Employment of Former Employees of the 
External Auditor Policy
•	Tax Strategy
•	Anti-corruption and Anti-bribery Policy
Where to find more information 
and outcomes in this report
Page/s
 Stakeholder engagement 
and s.172 statement 
20—25
 Principal risks and uncertainties
40—45
 ‘Our approach to s.172’ in the 
Governance report
72
 ‘Sustainability reporting’ in 
Audit and Risk Committee 
and s.172 statement
84
 ESG metrics in Executive 
remuneration
105,106
Additional information outside 
this report
•	Sustainability Report 2024
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
37

Risks and risk management
Our approach to 
risk management
The Board as a whole is responsible for the management of risk throughout the 
Group and ensures that our strategic objectives are in line with our risk appetite.
Risk governance
The Board is supported by the Audit and Risk 
Committee, which monitors the ongoing 
effectiveness of our risk management 
framework and receives independent assurance 
on the effectiveness of our approach to risk 
management and internal control systems 
through the activities of internal audit.
	For more information on the management 
of our internal controls see page 86
There is a formal process for setting the risk 
appetite and for identifying, assessing, and 
reviewing risks, as described further on the 
following pages. Risks inevitably evolve and 
change over time and the Board acknowledges 
that the risk management framework, and our 
system of internal controls, are designed to 
manage such risks appropriately, rather than 
eliminate them.
Risk management
We have an established Risk and Resilience 
Committee (‘R&R Committee’) which is chaired 
by the CFO and meets monthly. It comprises 
risk owners from various business areas and 
senior representatives from our compliance 
functions. A representative from internal audit 
also attends the meetings to provide additional 
insight and challenge. 
R&R Committee meetings also consider regular 
reports from key compliance areas (such as data 
protection and information security, regulated 
credit, health and safety, ethical sourcing, store 
security and business conduct) as well as status 
updates on any outstanding internal audit 
actions. A summary of the R&R Committee’s 
activities and findings is reported on a regular 
basis to the Audit and Risk Committee.
A review of the structure and role of the R&R 
Committee during the year, and its attendees, 
provided assurance that there is a strong and 
sound foundation of risk management practices 
within the business, supported by a regular 
cadence of updates and reporting activity.
Risk identification and prioritisation
We adopt a top-down and bottom-up 
approach to ensure that there is an overarching 
view of Group risks. This is considered monthly 
by way of the KRIs presented to the R&R 
Committee, and also more formally by way of 
a biannual review of the key operational risks 
(presented by each respective operational risk 
register owner), and the Group’s principal risks 
(presented by each respective principal risk 
owner). As part of the assessment, the key 
operational risks are mapped to the principal 
risks to enable appropriate challenge to those 
previously identified as most material to 
the Group. 
The R&R Committee’s key purpose is to develop 
and review the risk management framework to 
ensure that it is effective and assist the Board 
and Audit and Risk Committee in their oversight 
of risk management. At each meeting there is 
a review of the leading and lagging key risk 
indicators (‘KRIs’) associated with Dunelm’s 
principal risks, enabling management to discuss 
and take proactive steps to further mitigate as 
may be appropriate. In addition, on an ad hoc 
basis, the R&R Committee conducts deep dives 
into specific risks that may be trending upwards 
or retaining a high residual risk impact. 
Individual members of the Executive Team 
and senior leadership have responsibility for 
managing the risks and mitigating controls 
for their respective business areas, as well as 
considering any new and emerging risks 
specific to their own areas of the business and 
on a wider enterprise basis. They do this by 
maintaining their own operational risk registers 
and having responsibility for ensuring that any 
material issues, trends or emerging risks are 
escalated to the R&R Committee as appropriate. 
They are also responsible for ensuring that there 
has been appropriate consideration of all 
relevant risks when defining strategy, proposing 
business cases and implementing decisions.
The assessment considers both the inherent risk 
(before mitigation) and residual risk (after mitigation 
is applied). The output of the assessment is 
reported to the Audit and Risk Committee for 
challenge and consideration ahead of being 
presented to the Board for review and approval.
Risk appetite
The Board sets the risk appetite for the Group, 
taking into consideration the expectations of 
our shareholders and other stakeholders and 
our internal culture. The clear articulation of our 
risk appetite provides an effective mechanism 
to inform investment decisions, facilitate the 
discussion of risk, set parameters within which 
objectives must be delivered, and support 
the awareness of risk by our colleagues and 
partners. The Board reviewed the Group risk 
appetite in the year and confirmed that it 
remains appropriate.
Key operational risks are 
mapped to the principal 
risks to enable appropriate 
challenge to those 
previously identified as 
most material to the Group.
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
38

Risk management framework
Risk governance
Group Board
•	Overall responsibility for the risk 
management framework.
•	Sets the risk appetite for the Group.
•	Responsible for ensuring that effective 
internal control and risk management 
systems are embedded within 
the business.
•	Conducts assessment of 
principal risks.
Audit and Risk Committee
•	Responsible for assessing the ongoing 
effectiveness of the Group’s risk 
management framework, controls 
and processes.
•	Approves the internal audit programme 
and undertakes an independent 
review of action plans to mitigate 
and manage material risks.
•	Reviews principal risks for 
presentation to the Board.
Independent assurance
Internal audit
•	Provides independent assurance to 
the Board, Audit and Risk Committee 
and management on the effectiveness 
of risk management and internal 
control systems.
•	Conducts independent audits of risks 
to the business in accordance with 
risk-based internal audit programme.
Risk-based reviews
•	Conducts specialist third-party reviews 
as required.
Risk and Resilience Committee
•	Responsible for developing and 
reviewing the risk management 
framework and processes.
•	Supports the Board and Audit and 
Risk Committee in their oversight of 
risk management.
•	Conducts reviews of the principal risks.
•	Identifies and manages risks as 
they arise.
•	Monitors Key Risk Indicators.
•	Provides a forum to assess progress 
under action plans to mitigate and 
manage risks.
•	Conducts deep dives into areas of 
operational risk.
•	Reviews reports on key compliance 
areas: health and safety; data 
protection and information security; 
regulated credit; ethical sourcing; 
store security and business conduct.
Risk and control owners
Individual members of Executive Team or senior leadership
•	Primary responsibility for identifying, 
assessing and managing risk in area of 
responsibility within risk appetite.
•	Maintains operational risk register 
in area of responsibility.
•	Escalates key risks and concerns 
as appropriate.
Bottom-up
review of risks
Top-down
review of risks
Risks and risk management continued
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
39

Principal risks and uncertainties
Principal risks and uncertainties
The Board confirms that a robust assessment 
of the principal risks facing the Group has been 
carried out, including emerging risks and those 
that would threaten its business model, future 
performance, solvency, or liquidity. In 
conducting such a review, we identified two 
principal risks where the potential impact is 
deemed to be increasing. 
’Business change’ risk reflects our ongoing 
investment in change programmes that are key 
to our strategy and the delivery of further 
growth and efficiencies. We consider this an 
increasing risk in the short term as we continue 
to take on larger and more complex projects. 
However, it is anticipated that the risk will 
stabilise as we continue to deliver. 
‘Supply chain resilience’ risk is considered to be 
increasing due to ongoing geopolitical pressure 
and tensions around key trade routes. Whilst we 
adopt a proactive approach to supply chain 
management, the situation remains volatile and 
events continue to be challenging to predict 
and plan for.
The Board’s assessment of the principal risks 
and uncertainties facing the Group as at the 
date of this report and how we mitigate them is 
set out on pages 41 to 45. The principal risks are 
not set out in any order of priority and do not 
represent all risks associated with the Group’s 
activities. Additional risks that are not currently 
deemed principal risks are nevertheless 
monitored for their impact on the Group.
Emerging risks and opportunities
Risks continue to evolve and change, and an 
awareness of emerging risks is important in 
driving effective strategic planning. 
Understanding the potential implications of 
emerging risks and monitoring them enables 
us to consider them appropriately within our 
decision-making processes. 
We identify emerging risks by reviewing 
customer and market metrics and insights, 
relevant publications and consultation papers, 
with the assistance of both internal and external 
subject matter experts.
While no significant emerging principal risks 
were identified in the year, we recognise that 
there continues to be a heightened level of 
socio-economic risk and geopolitical uncertainty 
beyond our control, in relation to which we 
continue to closely monitor the potential impact 
so far as it relates to Dunelm. We also continue 
to consider the impact of technological change 
and monitor the pace of regulatory change and 
stakeholder sentiment in relation to environmental 
and other sustainability-related matters.
Task Force on Climate-related Financial 
Disclosures (‘TCFD’)
Climate change has been considered a principal 
risk for the Group since FY19, and continues to 
be so. The process of reviewing this risk and 
how we mitigate, alongside preparation of this 
year’s TCFD report, has enabled us to take stock 
of our approach to data collection and reporting, 
our achievements so far and where further work 
is required. 
We are proud of our progress during the year, 
notably strengthening our governance 
framework, improving the effectiveness of our 
controls and the ongoing integration of climate 
change considerations into day-to-day business 
activities. However, in reflecting on what we 
have achieved, we are also reminded of the 
challenges in this area and the need to maintain 
focus in order to achieve our sustainability goals.
	For more information on how we manage our 
climate-related risks see our TCFD report on 
pages 46 to 54
Principal risks at a glance
Principal risks
Risk trend
Customer offer
Product reputation and trust
Business change
People and culture
IT systems, data and cyber security
Regulatory and compliance 
Supply chain resilience 
Finance and treasury 
Climate change and environment 
Risk trend
Stable
Increasing
Decreasing
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
40

Principal risks and uncertainties continued
Customer offer
Description of risk 
Ongoing external uncertainty and inflationary 
pressure on consumers has led to significant change 
in consumer behaviour. Failure to respond to 
changing consumer needs and to maintain a 
competitive offer (value & choice, friendly & expert, 
fast & convenient and good & circular) will undermine 
our ambition to increase market share and drive 
profitable and sustainable growth.
Stakeholder groups
Risk trend
 
 
 
 
Link to strategy
Risk owner
 
 
 
Customer Director
How we mitigate 
•	 Increased utilisation of customer and market 
insights enabling us to understand more about our 
existing and potential new customers and adapt as 
appropriate to their changing needs. 
•	 Continued review and development of our strategy 
to become a more trusted and valuable brand (see 
pages 10 and 11 for business model).
•	 Continued investment in digitalising our business 
to improve our customer offer.
•	 Focus on new product development, particularly 
own brand, in both existing and new categories, 
as well as continued product innovation in existing 
categories with ‘sustainability’ being a key element 
to strengthen our customer offer. 
•	 Ongoing review of supply chain capacity and 
capability, investing as needed.
•	 Continued expansion of our range of products to 
appeal to every budget and style and regular 
review of price points.
•	 Strong focus on engagement through social media 
and community involvement.
Strategic pillars
Elevate  
our product 
offer
Connect  
with more 
customers
Harness our 
operational 
capabilities
Stakeholder groups
Customers
Colleagues
Communities 
Suppliers 
Planet 
Shareholders 
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
41

Principal risks and uncertainties continued
Business change 
Description of risk 
Dunelm recognises that there is significant 
opportunity in digitalising the business and has 
invested and will continue to invest in system 
improvements to drive growth and efficiency.
Failing to successfully introduce, deliver and leverage 
new technology and systems, along with the 
associated process and organisational changes 
across the business to further improve our 
proposition and operations could result in reduced 
operational efficiency, competitiveness, relevance 
and growth. Furthermore, failure to deliver the 
expected objectives on time and on budget could 
impact delivery of the planned business benefits.
Stakeholder groups
Risk trend
 
 
 
 
Link to strategy
Risk owner
 
 
 
Chief Technology and Information Officer
How we mitigate 
•	 Continued investment in digitalisation aligned to 
strategic priorities.
•	 Structured and disciplined delivery methodology 
applied to business change programmes, led by 
experienced project managers.
•	 Executive Team transformation forum to ensure that 
we deliver on strategic business priorities (both 
customer and efficiency driven) that will drive 
longer-term growth. 
•	 Refreshed ways of working and allocation of 
resource to key change programmes (supported by 
external expertise as needed) to ensure clear 
ownership of projects and enable ongoing 
knowledge-build, supporting rapid and agile 
system development.
•	 Regular review of roadmaps and workstream 
prioritisation by cross-functional leaders to ensure 
ongoing alignment with delivery of strategy.
•	 Focus on building and developing strong 
third-party relationships to enable effective 
collaboration, communication and 
ongoing delivery.
•	 Ongoing simplification and rationalisation of 
processes and systems.
•	 Regular reviews of progress using appropriate KPIs 
with all stakeholders, including identification and 
management of risks to delivery.
Product reputation and trust
Description of risk 
Our stakeholders expect us to deliver products 
that are safe, compliant with legal and regulatory 
requirements, and fit for purpose. Our customers are 
increasingly aware of the environmental and social 
impact of their purchases and want to know that our 
products have been responsibly sourced and that 
their environmental impact is minimised.
Failure by our suppliers to uphold our approach 
to business ethics, regulatory compliance, human 
rights (including safety and modern slavery) and the 
environment may undermine or damage our reputation 
as a responsible retailer, and result in a loss of 
confidence in Dunelm.
Stakeholder groups
Risk trend
 
 
 
Link to strategy
Risk owner
 
   
Director of Commercial and Supply Chain
How we mitigate 
•	 Mandatory training, a range of policies and our 
Ethical Code of Conduct for Suppliers and Partners 
govern, amongst other things, the quality of 
products and production processes, and our 
expectations in relation to responsible sourcing, 
anti-corruption and anti-bribery and modern slavery.
•	 A dedicated and experienced team, supported by 
third-party specialists, monitors compliance with 
our policies, codes and applicable regulations.
•	 Ongoing expansion of our ethical audit 
programme.
•	 Provision of enhanced training to commercial teams 
and suppliers on identifying and utilising sustainable 
materials in our products and packaging.
•	 Annual supplier webinar and awareness training at 
which compliance with policies and the Ethical 
Code of Conduct for Suppliers and Partners are 
a key topic.
•	 Focus on collation of data from suppliers in 
connection with sustainability targets for products 
and packaging.
•	 Regular review by senior colleagues of product 
recalls and product safety-related issues, with clear 
procedures in place to enable swift action to be 
taken as appropriate. 
•	 Whistleblowing procedure and independently 
administered hotline enables concerns to be raised 
in confidence.
•	 Third-party mapping and risk assessment of our 
cotton and timber supply chains. 
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
42

Principal risks and uncertainties continued
IT systems, data and cyber security 
Description of risk 
Our IT systems and infrastructure are critical to 
managing our operations, interacting with customers, 
and trading successfully. A key system being 
unavailable or suffering a security breach could lead 
to operational difficulties, loss of sales and 
productivity, legal and regulatory penalties due to 
loss of personal data, reputational damage, and loss 
of stakeholder trust.
Stakeholder groups
Risk trend
 
 
 
 
Link to strategy
Risk owner
 
Chief Technology and Information Officer
How we mitigate 
•	 Continued investment and roadmap for further 
investment in systems development and security.
•	 Ongoing programme of works to decommission 
outdated applications, platforms, and 
infrastructure.
•	 Assessment of the robustness of security and data 
protection controls required when onboarding new 
suppliers or undertaking contract renewal. 
•	 Data protection and information security policies 
and procedures in place and governed by subject 
matter experts, including a dedicated specialist 
information security team, data protection officer 
and head of data management. 
•	 Mandatory training and ongoing awareness 
programmes keep colleagues informed and aware 
of data protection and information security risks.
•	 Restricted access to sensitive data.
•	 Security Operations Centre and vulnerability 
management service tools provide increased 
visibility of security events and enable 
vulnerabilities to be monitored and quickly 
addressed. In addition, periodic systems 
vulnerability and penetration testing carried out 
along with internal audit reviews of security related 
policies and processes.
•	 Regular review and testing of incident and crisis 
management plans, and business continuity plans, 
which includes reviewing the resilience of and 
disaster recovery for IT systems.
•	 Data and reporting used to track system 
performance, utilisation, and vulnerability across 
our IT estate, with regular reviews undertaken and 
delivery of resulting actions monitored.
People and culture
Description of risk 
Our business could be adversely impacted if we fail 
to attract, retain, and develop colleagues with the 
appropriate skills, capabilities, and diverse backgrounds. 
Failing to embed and live our values could impact 
business performance, the delivery of our purpose 
and the long-term sustainability of our business.
Stakeholder groups
Risk trend
 
 
 
Link to strategy
Risk owner
 
Stores and People Director
How we mitigate 
•	 Regular review by the Executive Team and the 
Group Board of colleague ‘dashboard’ and KPIs, 
including attrition and recruitment rates. Such 
reviews also include an assessment of capabilities 
to ensure that we continue to have the right skillsets 
in the business to deliver our strategy. 
•	 Continued focus on training, development 
and mentoring opportunities, with emphasis 
on ‘growing our own’ talent, driven by the 
Talent Committee.
•	 Ongoing review of succession planning for 
Executive Team and senior leadership roles.
•	 Ongoing review and development of our employee 
value and reward proposition, assisted by 
benchmarking exercises as appropriate. 
•	 Commitment to increasing diversity across the 
Group by way of focused initiatives and training.
•	 Enhanced mental and financial wellbeing 
programmes and initiatives to support colleagues, 
including targeted support relating to parenthood, 
pregnancy loss, and menopause. 
•	 Regular communication with colleagues through 
engagement surveys, National, Regional and Local 
Colleague Voice meetings, D&I networks and 
huddles. Utilising feedback to understand 
colleague perception of culture and implementing 
actions based on the output.
•	 Continuing to ‘bring our shared values to life’ under 
our behavioural framework project.
•	 Dedicated Group Board and Executive Team 
discussions on culture and the vision for the 
business in the short, medium and longer-term. 
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
43

Principal risks and uncertainties continued
Supply chain resilience
Description of risk 
We are dependent on complex global supply chains 
and fulfilment solutions to deliver products to our 
customers. Instability in the global supply chain or failure 
of a key supplier may impact our ability to effectively 
manage stock and satisfy customer demand.
Stakeholder groups
Risk trend
 
 
 
Link to strategy
Risk owner
 
Director of Commercial and Supply Chain
How we mitigate 
•	 Ongoing review of supply chain strategy to ensure 
capacity is in line with longer-term financial plans.
•	 Continuous monitoring of the macroeconomic 
environment for emerging risks that may lead to 
disruption in our supply chain. Scenario planning 
conducted, so as to enable a swift response and 
adjustment to strategic and operational plans 
as appropriate.
•	 Detailed budgeting and forecasting processes 
match capacity to demand, and are reviewed 
weekly by a cross-functional team.
•	 Continuous monitoring of demand and stock visibility.
•	 Active management and monitoring of key supplier 
relationships to enable early warnings of disruption 
and agree mitigating actions. 
•	 Dedicated procurement team oversees process 
for tendering and negotiating with supply chain 
suppliers and ensures that appropriate due 
diligence is carried out on existing and prospective 
third-party partners.
•	 Active engagement with suppliers and partners on 
the collation of data required to assess delivery 
against carbon reduction targets.
•	 Active engagement with suppliers and partners on 
our ethical and compliance requirements.
•	 Ongoing focus on initiatives to improve efficiencies 
in our customer delivery processes.
•	 Regular review and testing of incident and crisis 
management plans, and business continuity plans.
Regulatory and compliance
Description of risk 
We operate in an increasingly regulated environment 
and must comply with a wide range of laws, 
regulations, and standards. Failure to comply with or 
to take appropriate steps to prevent a breach of these 
requirements could result in formal investigations, 
legal and financial penalties, reputational damage 
and loss of business.
Stakeholder groups
Risk trend
 
 
 
 
 
 
Link to strategy
Risk owner
 
  
Group General Counsel and Company Secretary
How we mitigate 
•	 Suite of compliance policies in place which are 
reviewed regularly and governed by subject 
matter experts. 
•	 Group-wide mandatory training provided for 
high-risk compliance areas such as health and 
safety, regulated credit, anti-corruption and 
anti-bribery, data protection and cyber security, 
with additional training undertaken as required or 
as may be appropriate to a specific role. 
•	 Data trends for high-risk compliance areas and KPIs 
monitored and reviewed by the Risk and Resilience 
Committee, as well as cross-functional steering 
groups (such as Good and Circular).
•	 Dedicated teams for product quality and ethics, 
sustainability and health and safety, supported by 
in-house legal team.
•	 Whistleblowing procedure and independently 
administered hotline enables concerns to be raised 
in confidence.
•	 Compliance with policies and Ethical Code of 
Conduct for Suppliers and Partners monitored via 
our ethical audit programme. 
•	 Regular health and safety meetings for each of the 
retail and distribution centres. Health and safety 
reports, including audit outcomes, reviewed by the 
Risk and Resilience Committee and the Board on 
a regular basis, with in-depth presentation made 
by the Head of Health and Safety to the Board at 
least annually.
•	 Continued focus on food hygiene and allergen 
awareness in our Pausa cafes by way of regularly 
reviewed operating guidelines, compulsory 
colleague training and regular audits.
•	 Active monitoring of the financial reporting and 
legislative landscape for new regulations and 
reporting requirements. Appropriate plans and 
roadmaps developed to ensure timely compliance.
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
44

Principal risks and uncertainties continued
Climate change and environment
Description of risk 
Failure to positively change our impact on the 
environment would fall short of the expectations of 
our customers, colleagues, shareholders, and other 
stakeholders which could lead to reputational 
damage and financial loss.
In addition, an inability to anticipate and mitigate 
climate change and other environmental risks could 
cause disruption in the availability and quality of 
raw materials such as cotton and timber, affecting 
production capacity, product quality, and overall 
supply chain resilience. This, and potential transition 
risks related to environmental taxation, could result in 
higher costs, delays, and potential loss of customers.
Stakeholder groups
Risk trend
 
 
 
 
 
Link to strategy
Risk owner
 
 
Chief Executive Officer
How we mitigate 
•	 Annualised targets (for Scope 1 and 2) in place to 
reduce emissions, energy usage and waste to 
landfill, and increase recycling in our operations. 
Longer-term targets in place for Scope 3 carbon 
emissions.
•	 Good and Circular Steering Group oversees 
progress against environmental targets and climate 
change work.
•	 Updates on progress towards targets, including 
emerging risks, challenges and opportunities 
under our climate change roadmap, which is shared 
with the Board for discussion and challenge. 
•	 Active engagement with suppliers and partners to 
support the reduction of their carbon emissions 
through setting aligned carbon reduction targets 
and sourcing better quality data.
•	 Regular review of standards and policies that 
govern our approach to high-risk raw material types 
and routes. 
•	 Increased use of lower-impact raw materials in 
products and ongoing work with our suppliers 
to move towards a more circular design and 
business model. 
•	 Sustainability targets built into Executive Director 
variable pay. 
•	 Dedicated internal resource to support delivery 
and measure progress against our targets.
•	 Regular horizon scanning conducted to keep 
abreast of regulatory change and stakeholder 
sentiment.
•	 Membership and involvement with industry 
working groups.
The following pages 46 to 54 present the full TCFD report for FY24.
Finance and treasury
Description of risk 
Progress against business objectives may be 
constrained by a lack of short-term funding or access 
to long-term capital.
Stakeholder groups
Risk trend
 
 
 
Link to strategy
Risk owner
 
 
Chief Financial Officer 
How we mitigate 
•	 Maintain relationships with a syndicate of 
committed partner banks to ensure appropriate 
funding is available.
•	 Revolving credit facility of £250m in place, 
extended until September 2027. 
•	 Group treasury policy governs levels of debt, 
cash management strategies and foreign 
exchange exposures.
•	 Hedging for foreign exchange and freight and 
energy prices agreed in advance, to help mitigate 
volatility and aid margin management.
•	 Continued focus on cost discipline through capital 
investment approval process and ongoing scrutiny 
of discretionary expenditure.
•	 Treasury and Capital Committee ensures 
appropriate governance around matters such 
as funding, dividends, foreign exchange, and 
energy hedging.
•	 Ongoing focus on actions to improve controls 
around stock and cash management, stock 
purchasing and forecasting. 
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
45

Group Board
Audit and Risk Committee
Nomination Committee
Remuneration Committee
Good and Circular  
Steering Group
Talent Committee
Risk and Resilience  
Committee
Chief Executive Officer
Executive Team
Board Committees
Operational Committees
Introduction
Climate change has been managed as a 
principal risk for the Group since FY19; the 
current view of this risk is described in detail on 
page 45. Following release of our first full TCFD 
report in FY22 and progress made in FY23, we 
have developed our approach to assessing risks 
and opportunities and remain committed to 
improving disclosures in line with evolving 
requirements and practice. This year, we 
brought in-house the assessment of financial 
impact for climate related risks and opportunities 
enabling more tailored data and assumptions to 
be used. Additionally, new internal processes 
have helped improve focus on potential impacts 
across the business.
Our report continues to be compliant with 
TCFD disclosures and UK Listing Rules. We 
continue to consider the potential financial 
impacts of climate change in the cash flow 
scenario modelling within our viability statement 
on page 55 and in our accounting policies note 
on page 137 of the financial statements.
Governance
Governance a) Board’s oversight of climate-
related risks and opportunities
The Board takes overall responsibility for our 
climate change roadmap. It considers our 
approach, strategy, risk management and 
performance, receiving regular updates on 
progress against our climate-related KPIs, as well 
as other related topics such as water reduction 
and product circularity. It continues to listen and 
learn about the implications of climate change 
on the Group’s business model. 
This year the Board received an update on our 
emerging Scope 3 emissions reduction roadmap, 
as well as our broader ‘Good & Circular’ strategy, 
looking at circularity, carbon and responsible 
sourcing, as well as our overall approach to 
governance and reporting (which is explained 
in more detail on the following page).
The Board is supported by the Audit and Risk 
Committee, Remuneration Committee and 
Nomination Committee. 
Task Force on Climate-related 
Financial Disclosures (‘TCFD’)
The Board recognises the risks and opportunities posed by 
climate change to the Group’s business model and strategy.
TCFD report
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
46

TCFD report continued
The Audit and Risk Committee formally reviews 
principal risks twice a year, and ESG processes 
and reporting (including TCFD), to verify 
non-financial KPIs, annually. It receives updates 
on upcoming sustainability reporting 
requirements and Dunelm’s planned approach. 
In FY24, it also received an internal audit report 
on the assessment of Dunelm’s processes, 
controls, and governance arrangements over 
methodology, data collection, and reporting in 
relation to Scope 3 emissions. The report did not 
identify any significant gaps or high-risk findings; 
it highlighted several areas of good practice and 
confirmed the effective design and operation 
of key controls. The Committee noted the need 
to continue to focus on this area to remain 
adequately equipped to operate controls over 
Scope 3 emissions and reporting readiness.
The Remuneration Committee reviews and 
approves Executive Director and Executive Team 
remuneration, including climate-related targets 
in performance-related pay. 
The Nomination Committee sets specifications 
for new Board roles and has oversight of the 
Talent Committee to ensure necessary talent 
and skills are available to deliver our 
sustainability strategy.
Governance b) Management’s role in 
assessing and managing climate related risks 
and opportunities
Our CEO leads on the Group’s climate-related 
activities and chairs the Good and Circular 
Steering Group. This was re-named (from 
Pathway to Zero Steering Group) and re-
constituted in FY24 following completion of our 
FY23 materiality assessment, to reflect a wider 
remit across sustainability, community and 
customer initiatives. Meetings are held six times 
a year and include the CFO, Commercial and 
Supply Chain Director, Customer Director, 
Group General Counsel and Company 
Secretary and the Head of Sustainability and 
Climate Change.
The Executive Team receives regular updates 
on our climate-related KPIs and reviews the 
principal risks prior to the Group Board review. 
The Risk and Resilience Committee is chaired 
by our CFO, Karen Witts. It is responsible for 
reviewing our risk management framework and 
processes and monitors existing and emerging 
risks, including climate change and environment 
risk. The Talent Committee is chaired by our 
Stores and People Director and ensures that we 
have the correct capability in place to meet our 
ambitions in this area.
Climate change considerations are increasingly 
integrated into day-to-day business activities: 
an assessment of energy efficiency and carbon 
impact is included in all new store and store 
refit proposals; our product design team is 
focused on increasing the use of less carbon 
intensive materials such as recycled cotton 
and polyester; and we continue to reduce 
packaging or use more sustainable packaging. 
In FY24, we increased our use of Better Cotton 
and FSC timber.
We are proud of our continued progress this 
year towards embedding our sustainability 
strategy, including climate-related considerations, 
within the business. Examples of how we have 
done so include (i) ensuring that our Executive 
Team business performance meetings regularly 
discuss our sustainability KPIs, including climate 
change, (ii) refreshing how we communicate our 
strategy and initiatives to colleagues and 
externally and (iii) continuing work with our 
suppliers to ensure that everyone with whom we 
partner is clear on the importance to Dunelm of 
delivering on our sustainability goals.
Strategy
Strategy a) Climate-related risks and 
opportunities identified over the short, 
medium and long term
Our purpose — To help create the joy of truly 
feeling at home, now and for generations to 
come — is deliberately forward-looking, and 
when combined with our business model (see 
pages 10 and 11), is designed to encapsulate 
our desire to have a positive impact on the 
planet, now and in the future. It is underpinned 
by our commitment to building sustainability 
into all that we do. A key component of our 
business model and customer proposition is 
‘being good and circular’ which we describe 
as being ‘positive choices for our planet, 
communities and people’.
During FY24 we have reviewed our identified 
climate-related risks and opportunities, and 
considered any further risks and opportunities 
presented in our risk registers or based on 
systematic peer comparison and sector review. 
Each risk and opportunity was assessed based 
on potential impact, likelihood and velocity to 
determine its relative materiality. The top-ranked 
risks and opportunities were selected for 
climate scenario analysis and financial impact 
modelling. Climate-related risks and 
opportunities were assessed using internal 
and external data.
To further understand and explore how specific 
climate-related risks and opportunities could 
evolve and impact our business over the short, 
medium and long term, we have carried out 
climate scenario analysis and financial impact 
modelling on six risks and opportunities. 
We worked closely with internal stakeholders to 
update baseline data, in addition to leveraging 
external data sources, including the Network for 
Greening the Financial System (NGFS) v3.2 and 
the International Energy Agency (IEA) World 
Economic Outlook 2023. By exploring the latest 
developments and insights, several assumptions 
were improved and applied, improving 
specificity of predicted financial impact. For 
example, we utilised the latest report from the 
Waste and Resources Action Programme 
(WRAP) to appropriately calculate the financial 
impact of introducing packaging-style 
Extended Producer Responsibility obligations to 
textile products. This approach has ensured that 
our assessments are based on the most current 
and relevant data available. Although such 
modelling still generates a high level of 
uncertainty, improvements have and will 
continue to be made. This modelling uses 
medium and long-term internal forecasts, market 
research and climate forecasts to explore the 
potential impacts of climate change on the 
Group’s financial position and performance. 
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
47

TCFD report continued
Financial impact ranges
We have used financial impact ranges, which are the same as we use for our corporate risk 
management process. 
Impact
Financial range (Annual Profit before tax)
Low
Less than £5m
Medium
Between £5m and £50m
High
Greater than £50m
Time horizons 
We have used the three time horizons described below:
Time period
Years
Reason
Short
2024—2030
Aligned to our 50% carbon 
reduction target and strategic plan
Medium
2030—2040
Aligned to our net zero target and to capture 
transition risks and opportunities
Long
2040—2050
Longer term to capture physical risks 
and opportunities
Climate Scenarios: We undertook climate risk and opportunity analysis under three climate 
scenarios outlined below:
Global Net Zero 2050
Delayed Transition
Business as usual (BAU)
Scenario
Limits global warming 
to 1.5°C by 2100, with 
stringent and immediately 
introduced climate policies 
and emissions reductions 
to achieve net zero 
emissions by 2050.
Scenario 
Action taken to limit 
emissions growth, but 
2015 Paris Agreement 
targets missed resulting in 
greater than 2°C warming 
by 2050.
Scenario
World takes no/limited action, 
equivalent to a 3.5—4.5°C 
warming.
Transition Risk 
Transition risks are extreme 
under this scenario in the 
short to medium terms, 
unless mitigated.
Transition Risk 
This scenario presents a 
significant transition risk in 
the medium to long term, 
given the speed and 
severity of the response 
required when 
implemented.
Transition Risk
Limited transition risks 
expected due to lack of policy 
changes and regulation.
Physical Risk 
Physical risks will be the 
least extreme under this 
scenario.
Physical Risk 
Physical risks will be higher 
than the Global Net Zero 
2050 scenario due to 
warming greater than 2°C 
instead of well below.
Physical Risk
The most extreme physical 
risk impacts in this scenario.
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
48

TCFD report continued
Strategy b) Impact of climate-related risks and 
opportunities on business, strategy and 
financial planning
In preparing the financial statements, the 
Directors have considered the cash flow 
impacts of climate change. This includes:
•	The impact of climate change on the going 
concern basis of preparation and the viability 
of the Group over the next three years.
•	The impact on potential impairment triggers, 
and where a trigger is identified, the impact 
on the value-in-use of the related non-
current assets.
Given the majority of our long-term assets are 
based in the UK, there is not likely to be any 
material impact as a result of climate change on 
financial reporting judgements or estimates 
applied in the preparation of the FY24 financial 
statements.
We are committed to transitioning to a net zero 
future, and this is reflected within our strategic 
pillars and planning both in our direct 
operations and in our value chain, which 
accounts for c.99% of our carbon emissions (see 
the table on page 53 for the breakdown of our 
emissions). Our product categories have plans 
in place to reduce the impact and carbon 
intensity of the products we sell, in support of 
our carbon reduction goals. We work in 
partnership with our suppliers to support them 
in various ways to help reduce supply chain 
emissions. We have developed and launched 
our Better Manufacturing programme which 
focuses on lowering carbon emissions during 
the product manufacturing stage, and in FY23 
we held our first ‘Introduction to Net Zero’ 
workshops which was attended by key suppliers. 
In FY24 we invested in a supplier data capture 
platform. Over 80% of our Tier 1 stock suppliers 
have completed the environmental 
questionnaire on the platform in FY24 and we 
have started to analyse the data. These insights 
will inform the type of support and work we do 
with our suppliers to help them achieve the 
carbon reduction required to hit our targets. 
We have sustainability action plan meetings 
with our key stock suppliers at least every six 
months and we continue to advocate at an 
industry level through organisations such as the 
British Retail Consortium, Better Cotton and 
WRAP Textiles 2030 and the Sustainable 
Logistics Forum to accelerate the reduction 
of carbon emissions in our supply chains. 
Additionally, we have invested in a tool to assess 
scalable options for product carbon footprinting 
via product life-cycle assessments, which will 
help focus our attention on reducing carbon 
in the most impactful areas and improve the 
robustness of data to enhance the accuracy of 
our emissions reporting. 
Strategy c) Resilience of strategy, taking into 
consideration different climate-related 
scenarios, including a 2°C or lower scenario
Our commitment to building sustainability into 
all that we do ensures that climate change 
considerations are integrated into our business 
activities. As we better understand the impact 
of climate change on the Group, we commit to 
continuing to assess and prioritise material risks 
and explore opportunities.
The analysis carried out has considered 3 
climate scenarios, including a ‘2°C or lower 
scenario’, aligned with the 2015 Paris 
Agreement. This has been examined across 
various timeframes, bringing confidence in the 
long-term resilience of the business.
The table on the following page summarises the 
material climate change risks and opportunities 
that we have considered and the actions we are 
taking to mitigate or manage risks and enhance 
opportunities. It confirms that we should 
continue to identify and explore mitigating 
actions in alignment with each risk identified. 
We will continue to work with relevant internal 
and external stakeholders to address these risks, 
and identify any new risks or opportunities upon 
horizon scanning.
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
49

TCFD report continued
Transition risks and opportunities — FY24
Risks and opportunities summary description
Potential impact (pre-mitigation)
Potential impact (post-mitigation)
Specific mitigants in place
Related metrics and targets
Policy & Legal 
Global Net Zero scenario — most significant impact in long term
Impact of carbon taxes on Dunelm suppliers
Introduction of a carbon price could lead 
to an increase in the cost of products with 
high greenhouse gas emissions; this could 
negatively impact profits due to taxation 
on Dunelm or taxation on suppliers 
passed on to Dunelm in product cost.
High in Global Net Zero scenario 
across all timeframes, low in BAU 
scenario across all timeframes.
Low in all timeframes.
•	 Actively engaging with our suppliers to support the reduction of their 
carbon emissions through setting aligned carbon reduction targets and 
sourcing better quality data. 
•	 Designing products to use lower carbon materials, such as recycled 
polyester. 
•	 In FY24 we launched the Higg Facility Environmental Module and started 
collecting data from Tier 1 stock suppliers. We will use this to inform the 
support we will give Tier 1 suppliers to move to lower carbon production.
•	 Actively monitoring the development of the UK Carbon Border Adjustment 
Mechanism in preparation to assess and mitigate potential impact on both 
direct and pass-through cost.
Carbon emissions metrics 
and targets
Extension of producer responsibility: increased cost of existing packaging regime and extension to additional product categories such as textiles
Extended Producer Responsibility ‘EPR’ 
fees are being implemented in the UK 
from October 2025. It is also predicted 
that an EPR type scheme for textiles will be 
introduced before 2030.
Medium across all timeframes.
Not yet fully modelled for textiles 
as scheme not currently proposed 
(but no exemptions assumed).
•	 Engaging with industry groups and specialists and closely monitoring 
development of the Packaging EPR charging mechanism and rates. 
Well-informed estimated costs are included in our financial plans. 
•	 Increasing recycled content in packaging (both plastic and cardboard). 
•	 Working collaboratively with BRC and WRAP Textiles 2030 to be prepared 
for EPR extension to textiles. 
•	 Through designing our textile products to become more circular we are 
aiming to reduce the impact that an EPR extension would have.
•	 Monitoring extension to other categories beyond textiles.
Nature and packaging 
metrics and targets
Market 
BAU scenario is most impactful for this risk as fuel prices increase the most in the outer year
Changes to fuel prices caused by climate-related market disruption or increased taxation
Changing market dynamics and 
decarbonisation trends impact both fuel 
prices and the transition to non-fossil fuel 
alternatives, leading to increased fuel 
costs across the delivery network.
Medium or low across all 
timeframes.
Low across all timeframes as we 
assume a degree of offset through 
a range of operational actions.
•	 Movement of trunking vehicles from diesel to CNG, which produce 
significantly fewer emissions than the diesel equivalent 
•	 Further assess the viability of electric vehicles in our fitter van fleet and 
implementing a low-carbon transition strategy in our stores and Home 
Delivery Network ‘HDN’ fleet for 2030. 
•	 Increasing the share of electric and hybrid vehicles within our company car 
fleet. Currently 40% of the cars in-use are electric within our car fleet. 
•	 Working with our key logistics suppliers to support their transition from 
diesel to non-fossil fuel alternatives.
Carbon emissions metrics 
and targets
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
50

TCFD report continued
Transition risks and opportunities — FY24 continued
Risk and opportunities summary description
Potential impact (pre-mitigation)
Potential impact (post-mitigation)
Specific mitigants in place
Related metrics and targets
Reputation 
Global Net Zero scenario most significant impact in medium to long term 
Reputational damage due to failure to act on sustainability trends
If Dunelm fails to continue to move 
towards using more sustainable raw 
materials and reduce carbon emissions 
then we might lose customers who switch 
to retailers who they consider to be more 
sustainable; we could also struggle to 
retain and attract colleagues and to 
secure funding.
No impact in the short term in all 
scenarios, reflecting Dunelm’s 
current position versus the market. 
High in the medium to long term 
in both the Global Net Zero and 
Delayed Transition scenarios if 
other retailers outpace Dunelm in 
sustainability.
See opportunity below in relation 
to increasing market share by 
demonstrating leadership in 
addressing climate change and 
sustainability.
•	 We have set ambitious climate change reduction targets.
•	 Our ‘Conscious Choice’ product label helps customers to identify products 
made from more sustainable materials. 
•	 We follow the CMA’s Green Claims Code, seeking to ensure that our green 
claims are genuine and not misleading. 
Carbon, nature, water 
stress, packaging and 
circular metrics and targets
Increased market share by demonstrating leadership in addressing climate change and sustainability
If Dunelm demonstrates leadership in 
addressing climate change and delivering 
its climate change reduction targets, 
whilst other retailers do not, we might gain 
market share from customers actively 
moving towards shopping at Dunelm.
Medium in the short term in all 
scenarios. Medium in the medium 
and long term in the BAU 
scenario, but not a differentiator 
in the medium or long term in 
the Global Net Zero or Delayed 
Transition scenarios as it is 
assumed that other retailers also 
take similar action.
n/a
•	 Working in collaboration with our suppliers to reduce their carbon emissions 
and create a more circular sourcing model. 
•	 Followed the LEAP process to review and set internal nature-based targets 
related to our cotton and timber sourcing. These targets are aligned to our 
internal net zero roadmap actions. 
•	 Starting to use lower-impact materials in our products and moving towards 
a more circular sourcing model to enhance our competitive advantage.
Carbon, nature, water 
stress, packaging and 
circular metrics and targets
Physical risk — FY24
Risk and opportunities summary description
Potential impact (pre-mitigation)
Potential impact (post-mitigation)
Specific mitigants in place
Related metrics and targets
Physical Risks 
BAU scenario most impactful 
Physical risks (drought, flooding, wildfires, etc.) impact the availability of raw materials such as cotton or timber, or impact manufacturing sites and logistics in countries from which we source our products
Physical risks mainly manifest themselves 
in our supply chain as none of our UK 
store or depot footprints are in areas at 
high risk of flooding.
Medium across all timeframes 
(dependent on extreme weather).
Not modelled as changes in 
sourcing strategy are not currently 
defined.
•	 We have followed the LEAP process to review and set internal nature-based 
targets related to our cotton and timber sourcing. These targets are aligned 
to our internal net zero roadmap actions. 
•	 Working with the Textiles 2030 group of retailers to support actions to 
mitigate these risks and to move towards a more circular sourcing model, 
which is being built into our product design process.
•	 Overall our sourcing strategy is across multiple locations, to reduce the risk 
any in-country disruption may cause. 
Nature and water stress 
metrics and targets
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
51

TCFD report continued
Risk management
Risk management a) Processes for identifying 
and assessing climate-related risks
Climate-change and environment is considered 
a principal risk within our risk register. In FY21, 
we implemented a comprehensive climate 
change risk register with the support of the 
Carbon Trust. During FY22 and FY23, we 
refined this risk register with external TCFD 
consultants, and quantified the most significant 
risks by likelihood and potential impact on our 
business. We also conducted an external 
materiality assessment in FY23 using both 
quantitative and qualitative information via 
surveys and interviews. It was concluded that 
there were no material risks or opportunities 
omitted. Throughout FY24, we reviewed and 
updated these previously identified risks to 
ensure that we continue to understand the 
potential financial impacts and have effective 
mitigations in place now and for the future.
Risk management b) Processes for managing 
climate-related risks
Climate-change and environmental risk is a 
principal risk owned by our CEO. The detailed 
climate-related risks identified fall under this 
principal risk. Senior leadership within our Good 
and Circular Steering Group assess and 
recognise these risks, enabling performance 
management and planning of mitigating 
actions. Our CEO, Head of Sustainability and 
Climate Change and other senior colleagues 
within the Group continue to engage with 
external advisors such as British Retail 
Consortium (BRC), WRAP, Textiles 2030, the 
Aldersgate Group and others, improving 
business resilience through best practice.
Risk management c) Processes for identifying, 
assessing and managing climate-related risks 
are integrated into the organisation’s overall 
risk management
As an identified principal risk, climate change 
and the environment is formally assessed twice 
a year with the Risk and Resilience Committee. 
This approach supports both the Audit and Risk 
Committee and Group Board in assessing and 
reviewing climate change and environmental 
risk bi-annually. Our overall risk management 
framework and supporting processes can be 
found on pages 38 and 39.
The principal risks are considered by 
management in connection with the assessment 
of the viability of the business over the longer 
term, with these considerations informing the 
viability statement on page 55 of this Annual 
Report. Further details on the assessment of our 
climate change and environment risk can be 
found on page 45.
Metrics and targets
Metrics and targets a) Metrics used to assess 
climate-related risks and opportunities in line 
with strategy and risk management process
The metrics we use as part of managing 
climate-related risks and opportunities are set 
out in the table on page 54. We have chosen 
these metrics because they relate directly to our 
material climate risks and opportunities, and 
because they are where we can make the biggest 
potential impact. In setting our GHG metrics and 
targets, we have ensured that they are in line 
with the 2015 Paris Agreement and aligned to 
a 1.5°C pathway, the UK’s commitment in the 
Climate Change Act 2008 (2050 Target 
Amendment) Order 2019 and other relevant 
legislation, as well as the British Retail Consortium’s 
Climate Action Roadmap, which we support. 
The carbon, cotton and water metrics are 
aligned to the Textiles 2030 voluntary agreement, 
which we have signed up to as a partner. These 
topics are also important to our colleagues, 
customers and society more broadly.
Metrics and targets b) Scope 1, Scope 2 and 
Scope 3 greenhouse gas ‘GHG’ emissions and 
the related risks
In FY24, we reduced our overall Scope 1 carbon 
emissions by 27% from our FY19 baseline 
despite strong sales growth of 53% over the 
same period. We achieved this through our gas 
boiler replacement programme in stores (which 
is on track to be completed by FY30), the 
ongoing transition of our company car fleet to 
lower carbon, and moving our trunking vehicles 
from diesel to compressed natural gas. We 
actively look for more opportunities to reduce 
emissions within our vehicle fleet in line with the 
innovation of the fleet industry.
We continue to purchase 100% renewable 
electricity and to install solar PVs across our sites 
where viable. This means that we report zero 
Scope 2 emissions using the market-based 
approach, and that on a location-based basis, 
our FY24 Scope 2 emissions were 21% lower 
than in FY19.
We report the majority of our Scope 3 emissions 
using a spend-based methodology as set out in 
the GHG Protocol Scope 3 Standard. Consistent 
with this approach, the Scope 3 emissions within 
our target boundary have increased by 59% 
since FY19, driven mostly by the 53% increase 
in sales over the same period. 
In FY24, as part of our ongoing data 
management plans for Scope 3, we again 
reviewed and improved our data and methods 
for reporting. This will continue in FY25 as 
explained below.
In line with our Base Year Emissions 
Recalculation and Prior Year Restatement Policy 
we are now reporting updated emissions for 
both FY19 and FY23. The changes to emissions 
are most materially affected by improvements in 
our approaches to measurement for Purchased 
Goods & Services, and Use of Sold Products.
In FY24 we used a hybrid of activity and 
spend-based calculation methodologies and 
applying a continuous improvement approach 
to develop the accuracy and specificity of 
reporting methodologies. For example, for our 
most material category of purchased goods 
and services, we have improved the granularity 
of our spend-based methodology to a product-
level, enabling more accurate emissions 
calculations through better country of origin 
and emissions factor matching. 
We will continue to transition away from 
a spend-based approach in FY25. This will 
include increasing the amount of supplier-
specific data that we are gathering and 
completing life-cycle assessments across a 
broad range of our products. We intend to 
incorporate this more accurate data into our 
reporting from FY25 onwards. 
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
52

TCFD report continued
Greenhouse Gas Emissions and energy use data for Streamlined Energy and Carbon Reporting
Greenhouse Gas Emissions (tCO2e)
FY19
FY20
FY21 
FY22 
FY23
FY24 
Scope 1
7,059 
7,108 
8,633 
7,902 
7,044 
5,139 
Scope 2 (location-based)
10,861 
8,757 
7,854 
8,015 
8,782 
8,568 
Scope 2 (market-based)
10,861 
8,757 
268 
21 
27 
— 
Scope 31
Purchased goods and services
536,177 
 n/a 
 n/a 
 n/a 
776,292 
850,919 
Use of sold products (direct use phase only)
236,920 
 n/a 
n/a 
 n/a 
366,195 
408,681 
Upstream transportation and distribution
29,439 
n/a 
 n/a 
 n/a 
47,255 
32,019 
End-of-life treatment of sold products
26,873 
n/a 
 n/a 
 n/a
33,986 
32,016 
All other categories combined2
14,339 
n/a 
 n/a 
 n/a 
18,836 
20,998 
Total Scope 3 within target boundary3
843,748 
 n/a 
 n/a 
n/a 
1,242,564 
1,344,633 
Streamlined Energy and Carbon Reporting (energy by source)
 FY19 MWh 
 FY20 MWh 
 FY21 MWh 
 FY22 MWh 
 FY23 MWh 
FY24 MWh
Purchase of energy (electricity)
 42,491 
 37,560 
 36,988 
 41,446 
 42,410 
 41,383 
Purchase of energy (stationary combustion)
 14,676 
 12,987 
 16,170 
 10,534 
 9,004 
 6,018 
Use of fuel for vehicles (mobile combustion)
 13,528 
 15,918 
 20,341 
 19,752 
 19,123 
 19,325 
1. 	 Includes updated numbers due to continuous improvements made throughout FY24 in line with our Base Year Emissions Recalculation & Prior Year Restatement Policy.
2. 	 All other categories includes capital goods, fuel and energy-related activities, employee commuting, and downstream transportation & distribution.
3. 	 Target boundary for Scope 3 excludes indirect use of sold products, waste generated in operations and business travel (both previously measured but removed based on de minimis materiality), upstream leased assets, processing of sold products, downstream leased assets, 
franchises and investments (assessed and deemed as not relevant).
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
53

TCFD report continued
Metrics and Targets c) Targets used to manage 
climate-related risks and opportunities and 
performance against targets
In response to the Net-Zero Standard set by 
SBTi, we submitted our net zero 1.5°C aligned 
targets across all Scopes to be validated by 
SBTi, and received confirmation of approval in 
October 2023. As members of the BRC and 
Textiles 2030, our Net Zero carbon target is 
aligned to the BRC’s Climate Action Roadmap 
and our cotton and water usage targets are 
aligned to the Textiles 2030 voluntary 
agreement. Executive Director variable pay 
includes sustainability metrics which vary from 
year to year. Further information can be found 
in this year’s Remuneration Committee report 
found on page 89.
UK Listing Rule 6.6.6R(8) Compliance 
Statement 
Dunelm Group plc has complied with all 
of the requirements of UK LR 6.6.6R(8) by 
including climate-related financial disclosures 
in this section (and in the information 
available at the locations referenced in it) 
consistent with the TCFD Recommendations 
and Recommended Disclosures.
Climate-related risk
Metric and target
Baseline
Progress
Carbon 
emissions
Reduce absolute Scope 1 carbon 
emissions by 50% against an FY19 
baseline by FY30
7,059 tCO2e in FY19 
5,139 tCO2e in FY24, which is a 27% reduction on the FY19 
baseline reflecting the progress made (see Scope 1 commentary 
on page 52).
Reduce Scope 1 carbon emission 
intensity against FY19 baseline
6.4 tCO2e/£1m Group 
revenue in FY19
53% reduction in FY24 to 3 tCO2e/£1m Group revenue 
(32% reduction on the FY19 baseline in FY23).
Purchase 100% renewable electricity 
every year
n/a
We continue to purchase 100% renewable electricity.
Reduce absolute Scope 3 carbon 
emissions in our target boundary 
by 50% against an FY19 baseline 
by FY30
843,748 tCO2e 
in FY19
1,344,633 tCO2e in FY24. Increased by 59% due to increased 
sales and spend. We continue to invest in data, measurement 
and reporting capabilities and have re-baselined and restated 
emissions in line with our base-year restatement policy.
Water stress
Reduce aggregate water footprint 
in own brand textile products by 
30% by 2030
116.5m M³ in calendar 
year (CY)19
195.0m M3 in CY23. Increased by 67% compared to base year. 
This is due to selling more products containing cotton. The 
majority of cotton sourced is Better Cotton and we continue 
to work with industry via WRAP’s Textiles 2030 collaboration 
towards the collective 30% reduction target.
Nature
100% of own-brand cotton more 
responsibly sourced by 2025
n/a
71% in FY24 (FY23: 26%). Increase due to improved process of 
mapping cotton supply chain and suppliers transitioning more 
cotton to Better Cotton. We intend to continue this trajectory 
into FY25. 
50% more responsibly sourced 
timber by FY25
n/a
37% in FY24. Good progress made toward sourcing more FSC 
timber in products. We intend to continue this trajectory into FY25. 
Packaging
30% less virgin packaging in 
own-brand range by 2025 
measured by weight per £1 sales 
packaging
2.2g per £1 sales 
in FY20
42% reduction in FY24 to 1.3g per £1 of sales (FY23: 36% 
reduction). Reduction due to improvements such as reducing the 
thickness of our curtain bags, and compliance checks resulting in 
more accurate data.
Circular 
economy
Easy to use take-back service in 
place for 50% of our own-brand 
products
n/a
62% in FY24 (FY23: 61%). Our take-back service has continued to 
prove popular with customers in stores and the volume of textile 
take-back has increased. We have focused on testing and trialing 
new circular business models and scaling up the ‘Home to Home’ 
offering across our estate. 
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
54

At the time of approving the financial 
statements, the Board of Directors is required to 
formally assess that the business has adequate 
resources to continue in operational existence 
and can therefore continue to adopt the ‘going 
concern’ basis of accounting. The Board is also 
required to state that it ‘has a reasonable 
expectation that the Group will continue in 
operation and meet its longer-term liabilities 
as they fall due’ (the ‘viability statement’). 
To support this statement, the Board has 
considered the Group’s current financial 
position, its strategy, the market outlook and 
its principal risks. Note that the Board reviews 
viability over a three-year period. Historically, 
this has been a five-year period, however a 
three-year horizon aligns with the wider 
business strategic plans, as well as the 
timeframe for performance targets. The base 
case for this review is the three-year plan that 
was presented to and approved by the 
Directors in May 2024. 
The Group is operationally and financially strong 
and has a long track record of consistently 
generating profits and cash, which is expected 
to continue throughout the plan period. 
Modelling potential downside scenarios
In their consideration of going concern and the 
future viability of the Group, the Directors have 
reviewed future profit forecasts and cash 
projections, reflecting their experience in 
managing the business. Both scenarios 
modelled assume that variable costs would 
reduce as sales reduce.
The ‘market downturn’ scenario assumes 
consumer spending moves away from 
homewares due to the impact of ongoing 
economic uncertainty and geopolitical 
instability. In this scenario, FY25 shows no sales 
growth on FY24 and a 4% lower growth rate in 
Reverse stress testing
To provide additional assurance around the 
Group’s viability, two reverse stress tests have 
been modelled. In both of these reverse stress 
tests we have assumed that variable costs would 
reduce in line with sales, that we would be able 
to save £20m per annum of fixed costs, that we 
would reduce the level of capital investment to 
reduce uncommitted spend in FY25 to £5m and 
to £10m in FY26 and suspend the payment of 
dividends. In the first reverse stress test, we have 
modelled the sales decline required to breach 
either of the current covenants in the Revolving 
Credit Facility (‘RCF’). A sales reduction of 26% 
in both FY25 and FY26 from the base case would 
be required for covenants to be breached by 
the end of FY26. In the second reverse stress 
test scenario, we have modelled the level of 
sales reduction required to breach the RCF limit 
of £250m. This would require a reduction in 
sales of 42% in both FY25 and FY26 from the 
base case to effectively run out of funding by 
the end of FY26, assuming reasonable 
mitigating actions have been implemented. 
Financing
The Group’s banking agreements and 
associated covenants are set out in the CFO’s 
Review and include a £250m RCF (maturing in 
September 2028, having exercised a one-year 
extension, with a further one-year extension 
option available subject to lender consent), an 
accordion option with a maximum facility of 
£100m and a £10m uncommitted overdraft. 
The Group ended the financial year with net debt 
of £56m. The financial covenants are tested in line 
with our December interim reporting and June 
year-end reporting. These covenants are met with 
significant headroom. In both downside scenarios, 
the Group continues to forecast compliance 
with all financial covenants throughout the 
going concern and viability period.
FY26 than in the base case scenario. In addition, 
higher costs than base case are assumed 
throughout the three-year period. This ‘market 
downturn’ scenario does not include any 
mitigating cost reduction actions, which would 
be taken if such a downturn occurred, and 
assumes the continuation of dividend payments 
in line with our current dividend policy. In this 
‘market downturn’ scenario, the Group would 
not breach any of its financial covenants and 
would have sufficient funds to meet obligations 
as they fall due.
The ‘deeper market downturn’ scenario 
assumes a 5% sales decline in FY25 compared 
to FY24 and 4% lower growth in FY26 than in 
the base case. More severe cost increases are 
assumed in this scenario compared to the 
‘market downturn’ scenario, and costs are not 
assumed to revert or recover to the levels 
assumed in the base plan throughout the 
three-year period. Similar to the ‘market 
downturn’ scenario, we have assumed no cost 
mitigation and the continuation of dividend 
payments in line with our current dividend 
policy. As with the ‘market downturn’ scenario, 
the Group would not breach any of its financial 
covenants and would have sufficient funds to 
meet obligations as they fall due.
The Directors continue to assess the risks that 
climate change poses to the business via 
modelling and disclosures in line with the Task 
Force on Climate-related Financial Disclosures. 
The Group will actively manage and mitigate 
these risks as required within the existing 
enterprise risk management processes (as 
outlined on page 52). Currently, climate change 
is not expected to have a significant impact 
on the Group’s going concern assessment or 
on the viability of the Group over the next 
three years.
Going concern and viability conclusion 
In both downside scenarios Dunelm has 
sufficient liquidity to continue trading, including 
maintaining the payment of dividends in line 
with its dividend policy and comfortably 
meeting its financial covenants. The reverse 
stress modelling has demonstrated that a 
significant, prolonged sales reduction of 26% in 
each year is required to breach covenants by the 
end of FY26 and a 42% sales reduction in each 
year is required to breach the RCF limit by the 
end of FY26, assuming reasonable mitigating 
actions have been implemented. Even in such 
an event, management would follow a similar 
course of action to that initially undertaken 
during the COVID-19 pandemic. Such actions 
could include reductions in discretionary spend 
(e.g. marketing and travel), headcount and 
capital investment in new stores and refits.
The Board believes that the Group is well placed 
to manage its financing and other significant 
risks satisfactorily and that the Group will be 
able to operate within the level of its facilities 
and meet its liabilities as they fall due, for at least 
the next three years. For this reason, the Board 
also considers it appropriate for the Group to 
adopt the going concern basis in preparing its 
financial statements.
Strategic report
This report was reviewed and signed by order of 
the Board on 11 September 2024.
Nick Wilkinson
Chief Executive Officer
11 September 2024
Going concern and viability statement
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
55

Governance 
report
57	
Chair’s introduction
59	
Compliance with the Code
60	
Directors and officers
63	
Governance dashboard
64	
Governance framework
68	
Culture and values
71	
Board activities
74	
Nomination Committee report
81	
Audit and Risk Committee report
88	
Remuneration at a glance
89 	
Remuneration Committee report
116	
Directors’ report
120	
Statement of Directors’ responsibilities
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
56

Chair’s introduction to corporate governance
How our governance helps 
to unlock our full potential
On behalf of the Board, I am pleased to present our  
Governance report for the year ended 29 June 2024.
Our FY24 performance has been strong amidst 
a challenging market, in which the Group has 
demonstrated its resilience by means of its 
continued focus on growth and operational 
grip. These remain important attributes as we 
continue to unlock our full potential and work 
towards achieving our ambitions. As the 
business continues to evolve, innovate and grow, 
we are mindful that our approach to governance 
will need to mature with it and we are 
committed to ensuring that we maintain a clear 
and robust framework within which decisions 
are made for the benefit of all our stakeholders.
Culture and values
Our strong culture and shared values remain 
fundamental to the continued success of the 
business, and it is important to the Board that 
our purpose, values and strategy are aligned. 
We recognise our role in monitoring, assessing 
and promoting a healthy culture throughout 
Dunelm and fulfil this by means of regular 
reports from the Stores & People Director, site 
visits, attending National Colleague Voice 
meetings, reviewing the outputs and progress 
against actions arising from colleague surveys 
and Good & Circular Steering Group updates. 
The Board also regularly considers a variety of 
metrics in relation to colleagues, customers, 
sustainability and risk allowing it to assess 
culture within the Group, and ensure that it is 
aligned with our purpose and strategy. 
	See page 68 for more information on culture 
and values
Stakeholder engagement
We recognise the ongoing focus given to all 
aspects of governance by our stakeholders, 
including audit and risk, regulatory compliance 
and sustainability, and the need to ensure that 
our approach remains appropriate for Dunelm. 
I am confident in our ability to effectively 
engage with our key stakeholders, utilise the 
insights gained, incorporate their views in our 
decision-making and meet their expectations.
A good example of this was our Board away day 
in November 2023, which included a deepdive 
into our supply chain. The agenda included a 
focus on responsible and ethical sourcing and 
an in-person Q&A session with some of our key 
suppliers, which provided increased insight and 
understanding for all. 
Alison Brittain 
Chair
Strong and engaged leadership that supports long-term performance
A robust review of strategy
The Board met in May 2024 for its annual 
strategy review. The structure of the day 
enabled detailed understanding and debate 
of our strategy and growth plans, with 
challenge to management on the potential 
for further acceleration and efficiencies. 
	Read more on page 72
Implementing effective 
succession plans
Refreshing and implementing succession 
plans was an important priority for the Board 
this year, with changes implemented during 
FY24 and further to come in FY25.
	Read more on pages 76 and 77
Understanding our suppliers and 
delving into the supply chain
On-site visits are essential to understanding 
how our operations work and are evolving. 
In-person conversations are equally important 
and the Board appreciated hearing directly 
from key suppliers what matters most to them.
	Read more on page 73
Delivering improvements in 
infrastructure 
With the increase in our Home Delivery sales, 
and taking account of feedback from 
colleagues, we relocated our Barnsley depot 
to a new location with increased space and 
improved facilities. 
	Read more on page 73
57
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Chair’s introduction to corporate governance continued
Our Non-Executive Directors also enjoyed 
a number of site visits during the year, some 
undertaken independently and others planned 
around Board meetings. These visits enabled 
engagement with colleagues, in addition to 
Non-Executive Director attendance at National 
Colleague Voice meetings and our review of the 
outputs from colleague surveys. 
We also appreciated conversations during 
the year with investors on remuneration and 
sustainability, and I enjoyed meeting with a 
number of our larger institutional shareholders 
at the beginning of the year to better 
understand their latest views on strategy 
and governance. 
	See pages 20 to 25 and 72 to 73 for more 
information on stakeholder engagement
Board changes and succession planning
An important priority for the Board in relation 
to governance in the past year has been 
establishing and implementing effective 
succession planning. We have already made 
changes to the Board, with further to come later 
this year. Peter Ruis stepped down in January 
2024 and Arja Taaveniku will be stepping down 
at the end of the calendar year, in both cases 
having accepted roles with other retailers. 
In July, we announced that William Reeve will 
not be standing for re-election at the AGM in 
November 2024, having completed his 
nine-year term as a Board Director. I thank each 
of William, Peter and Arja for their significant 
contributions to Dunelm. 
After the FY24 year end Kelly Devine also 
stepped down, having agreed to join Dunelm’s 
Executive Team as Customer Director. Whilst 
she will be missed around the Board table, we 
are delighted to welcome her into her new role 
where she will focus on pushing forward our 
customer proposition and working with the rest 
of our Executive Team to pursue the multiple 
opportunities we have to grow the business and 
develop our brand. 
In March we welcomed Ajay Kavan and Dan 
Taylor as independent Non-Executive Directors. 
Ajay’s experience across a range of well-known 
retailers strengthens our Board as we continue 
to drive multi-channel growth across our total 
retail system. Dan’s experience, particularly in 
the delivery of digital growth strategies in 
consumer-facing businesses, will add further 
expertise and value as we continue to evolve 
and improve our customer offer. We also 
announced in July that Ian Bull will be appointed 
Senior Independent Director and Ajay Kavan 
our Remuneration Committee Chair when 
William Reeve departs in November 2024.
	See page 76 for more information on our 
process for appointing new Directors
The Board has also continued to prioritise 
senior leadership succession planning and the 
development of internal talent to support our 
growth ambitions. We continue to promote 
diversity and inclusion on the Board and across 
the colleague population.
	See pages 79 to 80 for more information on 
our approach to diversity and inclusion
AGM
Our AGM this year takes place on 21 November 
2024. In line with the UK Corporate Governance 
Code, all Directors will be seeking re-election 
(other than William Reeve). In addition, in 
accordance with the UK Listing Rules, each of 
the Non-Executive Directors will be subject to 
a vote of shareholders independent of the 
Adderley family. In light of the Adderley family 
holding, we are also required to seek a Rule 9 
waiver to allow us to buy back shares to fulfil 
colleague share option entitlements. We hope 
that shareholders will support this resolution, 
which is limited to this purpose. 
The year ahead
As we go into FY25, we remain focused on 
growth and unlocking the business’ full potential 
to deliver long-term sustainable success. 
Alongside this, the Board is conscious of the 
ongoing need for good governance and 
I remain confident that our framework is strong 
and effective. 
I would like to take this opportunity to say thank 
you, on behalf of the Board, to all our colleagues 
in the business for their continued hard work, 
dedication and focus on ensuring we are ‘doing 
the right thing’ for Dunelm and its stakeholders, 
and to my fellow Directors for their valuable 
contribution. 
Alison Brittain 
Chair 
11 September 2024
Our Non-Executive 
Directors also enjoyed 
a number of site visits 
during the year, some 
undertaken independently 
and others planned 
around Board meetings.
58
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Compliance with the UK Corporate Governance Code
How we comply with the UK 
Corporate Governance Code 2018
The Board is responsible for demonstrating how the governance of the Company 
contributes to its long-term sustainable success.
This Governance report explains how we have 
applied the Principles of the UK Corporate 
Governance Code 2018 (the ‘Code’) issued by 
the Financial Reporting Council and available at 
www.frc.org.uk. These Principles are applied to 
the Company’s sole trading subsidiary through 
the Group’s governance, risk management and 
internal control structure.
The Board is pleased to confirm that during the 
year ended 29 June 2024, the Company applied 
the principles and complied fully with all the 
provisions of the Code throughout the year. 
Further information on compliance with the 
Code can be found throughout this Governance 
report, the Strategic report and Committee 
reports signposted as follows: 
Board leadership and 
company purpose
An effective and entrepreneurial Board 
which promotes the long-term 
sustainable success of the Company.
Directors and officers — page 60
s.172 statement — page 25 
Board evaluation — page 78
Alignment of our purpose, values, 
culture and strategic objectives.
Our strategy — page 13
CEO’s review — page 14
Board activities — page 71
Culture and values — page 68
Our governance and risk management 
framework.
Governance framework — page 64
Approach to risk management — 
page 38
Effective engagement by the Board 
with stakeholders.
Stakeholder engagement — page 20
s.172 statement — page 25
Our colleagues and alignment of our 
policies to support long-term 
sustainable success. 
National Colleague Voice — page 22
NFSIS — page 34
Codes of conduct, anti-bribery and 
other policies — page 68
Division of  
responsibilities 
The role of the Chair.
Chair’s statement — page 4
Directors and officers — page 60
Roles and responsibilities — page 65
Board evaluation — page 78
Composition of the Board and division 
of responsibilities.
Directors and officers — page 60
Roles and responsibilities — page 65
Director independence — page 66
Non-Executive Directors’ external 
commitments and role.
Directors and officers — page 60
Roles and responsibilities — page 65
Board activities — page 71
Effective and efficient functioning 
of the Board. 
Time commitment — page 66
Board evaluation — page 78
Composition, succession 
and evaluation
Formal, rigorous and transparent 
appointment procedure and effective 
succession plans.
NED succession — page 76
Diversity and inclusion — page 79
A combination of skills, experience 
and knowledge on the Board and 
Committees. 
Directors and officers — page 60
NED succession — page 76
Annual evaluation. 
Board evaluation — page 78
Remuneration
Policies and practices designed to 
support strategy, long-term success 
and aligned to culture and values. 
Remuneration Committee report 
— page 89
Formal and transparent procedure for 
developing policy.
Remuneration policy — page 91
Exercise of independent judgement 
in respect of 2024 outcomes.
Annual Statement — page 89 
Annual report on remuneration 
— page 101
Audit, risk and internal 
controls 
Transparent policies and procedures to 
ensure independence and effectiveness 
of auditors and integrity of the Annual 
Report and Accounts.
External auditor — page 85
Internal audits — page 87
Year end review process — page 84
Fair, balanced and understandable 
assessment of position and prospects.
Fair, balanced and understandable 
— page 83
Internal controls and management 
of risk.
Approach to risk management 
— page 38
Principal risks and uncertainties 
— page 41
Risk management and internal 
controls — page 86 
59
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Directors and officers
Key
A  Audit and Risk Committee member
N  Nomination Committee member
R  Remuneration Committee member
 Committee Chair
I  Independent Director
D  Designated NED for colleague matters
Alison Brittain
Chair
N  R  I
Independent on appointment
Appointed: September 2022 and as Chair in 
January 2023
Skills and contribution: Alison is an experienced 
business leader who brings considerable expertise 
to the Board as NED and former Chief Executive of 
a range of consumer-facing companies. Her skillset 
enables her to provide valuable insight on strategic 
matters and a strong focus on execution, which are 
key to our continued growth. In addition, she has 
successfully scaled businesses in the UK and 
internationally, has long-standing plc experience and 
a deep understanding of stakeholder perspectives. 
This positions her perfectly to facilitate constructive 
challenge and debate as our Chair. 
Previous roles: Alison was CEO of Whitbread PLC from 
2015 to 2023. Prior to that, she held several senior roles 
in the UK banking industry, serving as Group Director 
in the Retail Division of Lloyds Banking Group PLC 
(2011—2015), Board Director at Santander UK PLC 
(2007—2011) and Barclays PLC (1987—2007). Alison was a 
Non-Executive Director of Marks & Spencer Group PLC 
from 2014 to 2020.
Other commitments: Chair of English football’s Premier 
League. Senior Independent Director at Experian plc. 
Non-executive Director at British Airways plc. Chair of 
the King’s Trust Group of Charities (formerly The 
Prince’s Trust).
Nick Wilkinson 
Chief Executive Officer
Non-independent
Appointed: February 2018
Skills and contribution: Nick is an experienced Chief 
Executive, with a proven track record in multichannel 
retail businesses operating across a number of 
consumer brands and geographies. His leadership is 
pivotal in developing and overseeing delivery of our 
strategy, driving growth and ongoing transformation, 
increasing market share, and continuing to strengthen 
our customer offer and experience. Nick chairs our 
Good and Circular Steering Group, steering our plans 
to build sustainability into all that we do. 
Previous roles: Nick was Chief Executive of Evans 
Cycles from 2011 to 2016 and the Chief Executive of 
Maxeda DIY from 2007 to 2010. Prior to that, he was 
Group Buying Director and MD of Currys at Dixons 
Retail Group (1999 to 2006). Nick spent his early career 
at Unilever and McKinsey & Co.
Other commitments: Trustee of Rewilding Britain.
Karen Witts 
Chief Financial Officer
Non-independent
Appointed: June 2022
Skills and contribution: Karen is a highly experienced 
Chief Financial Officer with a strong background in 
finance and management across global retail and 
consumer-facing businesses. She plays an important 
role in developing and overseeing delivery of our 
strategic initiatives, driving innovation, and ensuring 
that we maintain strong operational grip. In addition 
to leading on financial management, Karen regularly 
engages with our investors and corporate advisors. 
Karen chairs the Risk and Resilience Committee, 
providing oversight of risk management and ensuring 
that the business is operating within our risk appetite. 
Past experience: Karen was Chief Financial Officer of 
Compass Group plc from 2019 to 2021 and CFO of 
Kingfisher Group plc from 2012 to 2019. Before that, 
she held various senior finance, strategic and operational 
roles with Vodafone Group plc (2010 to 2012), and at BT 
Group plc (1999 to 2010). Karen qualified as 
a Chartered Accountant with Ernst & Whinney.
Other commitments: Non-Executive Director of 
Ipsen Pharma, SA.
Sir Will Adderley
Deputy Chair
N
Non-independent
Appointed: April 2003
Skills and contribution: Will brings a unique 
perspective to the Board as a result of his broad and 
deep understanding of the business and in-depth 
knowledge of its corporate history. This adds significant 
value to Board debate and informed decision-making. 
Will also plays a key role in contributing to the ongoing 
development of our purpose and culture, which has 
been built from the shared values instilled by the 
Adderley family when the business was founded. Will 
retains an executive role to support the business in 
matters agreed with the Chief Executive, as required. 
Previous roles: Will has worked for Dunelm his 
whole career since joining in 1992. He took over the 
day-to-day running of the Group from his father in 1996 
and remained as Chief Executive through the Group’s 
IPO in 2006. Will became Deputy Chair in February 
2011 and was reappointed Chief Executive in 
September 2014 for an interim period until 
31 December 2015.
Other commitments: Owner of WA Capital Limited 
and Trustee of Stoneygate Trust.
60
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Directors and officers continued
Ian Bull 
Non-Executive Director
A  N  R  I
Independent
Appointed: July 2019
Skills and contribution: Ian has over 30 years’ 
experience as a strategy and finance specialist built 
from executive and non-executive roles at online and 
multi-site consumer-facing businesses. He has 
long-standing plc experience, with a deep 
understanding of audit practices and risk management 
frameworks, which enables him to promote open and 
frank discussions and challenge, as well as ensure 
strong relationships with management, auditors, and 
other stakeholders. Ian is a Fellow of the Chartered 
Institute of Management Accountants.
Ian will be appointed Senior Independent Director with 
effect from the end of the 2024 AGM.
Previous roles: Ian was Chief Financial Officer of 
Parkdean Resorts Group from 2016 to 2018 and Chief 
Financial Officer of Ladbrokes plc from 2011 to 2016. 
He was Group Finance Director of Greene King plc 
(2006 to 2011), having spent his early finance career at 
Whitbread PLC, Walt Disney Company and BT Group. 
Ian is a former Non-Executive Director and Audit Chair 
of Paypoint Limited, Senior Independent Director and 
Audit Committee Chair of St. Modwen Properties plc 
and Chair of Lookers plc.
Other commitments: Senior Independent Director at 
Domino’s Pizza Group plc and Non-Executive Director 
at Croda International Plc. Member of Chapter Zero, 
the Directors’ Climate Forum.
Ajay Kavan 
Non-Executive Director
A  N  R  I
Independent
Appointed: March 2024
Skills and contribution: Ajay is an accomplished 
business leader with strong digital and retail credentials 
and experience driving organic growth, strategic 
partnerships, and M&A. Ajay’s expertise in delivering 
online and multi-channel propositions, together with 
his in-depth understanding of operations and 
relationships from his work as an advisor and mentor, 
strengthens the Board’s skills as we continue to drive 
growth across our total retail system. 
Ajay will be appointed as Chair of the Remuneration 
Committee with effect from the end of the 2024 AGM.
Previous roles: Ajay was Chief Executive of Matches 
Fashion from 2020 to 2021 and Vice President at 
Amazon from 2011 to 2020. Prior to that, he was 
Marketing and Strategy Director, Homebase at Home 
Retail Group (2004—2011) and Multi-Channel Director, 
B&Q at Kingfisher (2000—2004).
Other commitments: Senior Advisor at KKR, member 
of advisory panel to Piper Private Equity, Non-Executive 
at Rohlik Group, mentor to CEOs of high growth US/EU 
digital businesses and Vice Chair of In Kind Direct.
William Reeve 
A  N  R  I
Senior Independent Non-Executive Director
Independent
Appointed: July 2015
Skills and contribution: William is a serial entrepreneur 
and technology investor with extensive experience in 
the digital sector and of M&A. He has served as a 
Non-Executive Director of listed companies, P/E 
backed businesses and startups, placing him in an ideal 
position to be our Senior Independent Director and 
chair our Remuneration Committee, ensuring that our 
approach to remuneration is aligned with our strategic 
objectives and values. 
William Reeve will not be standing for re-election at the 
Company’s 2024 AGM.
Previous roles: William co-founded three internet-
related businesses: Fletcher Research, LOVEFiLM.com, 
and Secret Escapes. He is a former Non-Executive 
Director of Graze.com, Paddy Power plc, Zoopla and 
Nutmeg among others.
Other commitments: Chief Executive of Oh 
Goodlord Limited.
Marion Sears 
Non-Executive Director
N  D  
Non-Independent 
Appointed: July 2004
Skills and contribution: A long-standing Board 
Director, Marion brings a wealth of expertise from her 
extensive City, investment and banking career which 
included navigating complex mergers and acquisitions. 
Utilising her significant plc experience and stakeholder 
understanding, enhanced by her role as the 
Designated Colleague NED for colleague matters, 
Marion plays an important role in facilitating informed 
Board decision-making.
Previous roles: Marion was Dunelm’s Senior 
Independent Director and Chair of the Remuneration 
Committee from 2006 to 2015 and was Chair of the 
Nomination Committee until 2016. She had an 
executive career in the City in investment banking at 
Flemings, Chase and JP Morgan, prior to which she 
worked in corporate finance, as an investment analyst 
and in industry. Marion’s previous Non-Executive 
Director experience includes WH Smith and 
Persimmon where she chaired the remuneration 
and ESG committees. 
Other commitments: Non-Executive Director and 
Chair of Remuneration Committee at Keywords Studios 
plc, Non-Executive Director at Schroder Asian Total 
Return Investment Company plc and Director of 
WA Capital Limited. Member of Chapter Zero, the 
Directors’ Climate Forum.
Key
A  Audit and Risk Committee member
N  Nomination Committee member
R  Remuneration Committee member
 Committee Chair
I  Independent Director
D  Designated NED for colleague matters
61
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Directors and officers continued
Arja Taaveniku 
Non-Executive Director
A  N  R  I
Independent
Appointed: February 2021
Skills and contribution: Arja is an experienced business 
leader, with a wealth of knowledge from her executive 
roles at international home retail businesses. She has 
particular expertise in the strategic and operational 
development of customer propositions and product 
value chains, as well as environmental, social and 
governance (‘ESG’) initiatives, driving Board debate 
in these important areas. 
Arja Taaveniku will step down from the Board at the end 
of the calendar year.
Past experience: Arja was a member of the Group 
Executive at Kingfisher plc and Chief Executive of its 
subsidiary, Kingfisher International Products Limited 
from 2015 to 2018. Before that, she was Chief Executive 
of lkano Group S.A. (2012 to 2015), having previously 
held various leadership roles at IKEA Group from 1989 
to 2012 including Global Business Area Director. 
Arja is a former Chair of Polarn O. Pyret and Svenska 
Handelsfastigheter AB and Non-Executive Director at 
Handelsbanken Group.
Other commitments: CEO of HomeCentre 
(Landmark Group). 
Vijay Talwar
Non-Executive Director
A  N  R  I
Independent 
Appointed: October 2021
Skills and contribution: Vijay is a proven business 
leader in driving significant digital and operational 
transformations. He has broad international executive 
experience developed at consumer-facing, omni-
channel businesses, bringing a different dimension to 
Board discussions. Further, as a former Certified Public 
Accountant and CFO, he provides depth to the Audit 
and Risk Committee’s oversight. 
Previous roles: Vijay was Chief Executive Officer of 
ContextLogic Inc from February to September 2022. 
Prior to that, he was Chief Executive Officer of 
Footlocker EMEA from 2019 to 2022 and President of 
Digital at Foot Locker from 2016 to 2019. Previously, he 
was President of Gifts/Special Occasions at Sears 
Holdings (2014 to 2016), held C-suite positions at Blue 
Nile from 2010 to 2014 and was Chief Executive Officer 
at William J Clinton Foundation India (2008 to 2010). 
Vijay was COO for EMEA at Nike from 2002 to 2008.
Other commitments: Chief Commercial Officer and 
Chief Digital Officer at Avolta AG (formerly Dufry AG).
Dan Taylor
Non-Executive Director
A  N  R  I
Independent 
Appointed: March 2024
Skills and contribution: Dan is an experienced CEO, 
with a recognised track record of delivering strategic 
plans to drive growth in digital and consumer-facing 
brands and leading on M&A and integration 
programmes, both in the UK and internationally. 
His experience adds further depth and understanding 
to Board debate as we continue to evolve our 
customer proposition.
Previous roles: Dan held senior Executive roles at 
PaddyPowerBetfair from 2015 to 2020; he was Chief 
Executive (2018—2020), MD, UK & Ireland (2017—2018) 
and MD, Retail (2015—2017). Before that, he was 
Managing Director of Teletext Holidays (2013—2014), 
Director of Strategy and Commercial Development 
at DMG Media (2009—2013) and Associate Partner at 
OC&C Strategy Consultants (2001—2009).
Other commitments: CEO of Flutter International at 
Flutter Entertainment plc.
Luisa Wright 
Group General Counsel & Company Secretary
Appointed: November 2022
Skills and contribution: Luisa is an accomplished 
general counsel, company secretary and regulatory 
advisor, with extensive plc experience built at 
consumer-facing digital, retail and technology 
companies. She attends Board and Board Committee 
meetings, ensures that legal and governance matters 
are not only anticipated but also considered and 
addressed, and offers invaluable support to the Board. 
Previous roles: Luisa was Group General Counsel & 
Company Secretary of The Rank Group Plc from 2018 
to 2022 and Group General Counsel & Company 
Secretary of Sportech Plc from 2011 to 2017. Prior to 
that, Luisa was a private practice lawyer at Olswang LLP 
(now CMS Cameron McKenna Nabarro Olswang LLP) 
from 2000 to 2011. Luisa qualified as a lawyer with 
Olswang LLP.
Other commitments: None.
Bill Adderley
Founder and Life President
Bill together with his wife Jean founded the business 
in 1979. Although no longer on the Board or actively 
involved in management, Jean remains a major 
shareholder.
Key
A  Audit and Risk Committee member
N  Nomination Committee member
R  Remuneration Committee member
 Committee Chair
I  Independent Director
D  Designated NED for colleague matters
62
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

A leadership team with good balance 
and relevant experience
Governance dashboard
Board overview as at 29 June 2024
Independence*
	1. Non independent 45%
	2. Independent 55%
FY24 Board and Committee attendance
The table below sets out Board and Committee meeting attendance during the year to 29 June 2024. 
The number of meetings attended is shown next to the maximum number of meetings that each Director was 
entitled to attend.
Director
Committee
memberships
Board
Audit and Risk 
Committee
Remuneration 
Committee
Nomination 
Committee
Will Adderley
N
8/8
n/a
n/a
3/3
Alison Brittain
R   N
8/8
n/a
3/3
3/3
Ian Bull
A   R   N
8/8
4/4
3/3
3/3
Kelly Devine1
A   R   N
8/8
3/3
2/2
2/2
Ajay Kavan2
A   R   N
3/3
1/1
2/2
1/1
William Reeve
A   R   N
8/8
4/4
3/3
3/3
Peter Ruis3
A   R   N
3/3
2/2
2/2
2/2
Marion Sears
N
8/8
n/a
n/a
3/3
Arja Taaveniku
A   R   N
8/8
4/4
3/3
3/3
Vijay Talwar
A   R   N
8/8
4/4
3/3
3/3
Dan Taylor2
A   R   N
3/3
1/1
2/2
1/1
Nick Wilkinson
n/a
8/8
n/a
n/a
n/a
Karen Witts
n/a
8/8
n/a
n/a
n/a
1.	
Kelly Devine was not considered independent with effect from 11 March 2024 due to her accepting a role in-house with the Company. She was not a 
member of any Board Committee after such date. Kelly stepped down from the Board on 5 July 2024, ahead of commencing her new role later in the month.
2.	
Ajay Kavan and Dan Taylor joined the Board on 1 March 2024.
3.	
Peter Ruis stepped down from the Board on 10 January 2024.
* Number excludes the Chair 
who was independent on 
appointment.
	For more information on 
our Board appointment 
process see page 76
	For our annual statement 
on Board diversity targets 
see page 80
Chair
Senior 
Independent 
Director
Senior Board positions
Chief 
Executive 
Officer
Chief 
Financial 
Officer
Ethnicity
	1. White 83%
	2. Asian 17%
2.
1.
2.
1.
Age diversity
	1. 40—50 17%
	2. 50—60 58%
	3. 60+ 25%
3.
2.
1.
Gender
	1. Male 58%
	2. Female 42%
	Female
	Male
2.
1.
Length of tenure
	1. 0—3 years 50%
	2. 3—6 years 17%
	3. 6—9 years 17%
	4. 9+ years 17%
1.
2.
3.
4.
63
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Governance 
framework
We have always believed that good 
governance — in our words ‘doing the right 
thing’ — helps companies make better 
decisions for the benefit of all stakeholders. 
Our governance framework enables 
informed decision-making, effective 
oversight and clear accountability. It also 
allows for delegation of specific matters to 
the appropriate committees. A high-level 
summary of our approach, illustrating where 
responsibilities fall, is set out on the right.
The Board believes that good governance 
supports Dunelm’s purpose, shared values 
and strategy, and is satisfied that these 
elements and Dunelm’s culture are aligned.
Group Board
Board Committees
Group Board reviews/challenges/approves
The Board is supported by three Committees 
to which it has delegated certain matters in 
order to ensure that they receive the 
appropriate level of consideration. These 
Committees support the Board in discharging 
its duties. Each of the Committees operates 
under terms of reference approved by the 
Board, which are reviewed annually and can 
be found on the corporate website: 
corporate.dunelm.com.
Nomination Committee
Recommends appointments to the Board, 
keeps the composition of the Board under 
review, oversees the succession plans for the 
Board, Executive Team and senior leadership 
and promotes diversity on the Board and 
across the Group. 
	See page 74 for Nomination 
Committee report
Audit and Risk Committee
Maintains oversight of the Group’s financial and 
narrative reporting, assesses the effectiveness 
of internal control and risk management 
systems, monitors the independence of internal 
and external audits and manages the 
relationship with the external auditor.
	See page 81 for Audit and Risk 
Committee report
Remuneration Committee
Establishes the Remuneration Policy, 
determines the remuneration of the Executive 
Directors and Chair, oversees implementation 
of the Remuneration Policy and remuneration 
policies and practices across the Group. 
	See page 89 for Remuneration 
Committee report
The Executive Team is supported by three 
executive-led committees, which provide 
updates to the Board, Audit and Risk 
Committee, Remuneration Committee and 
Executive Team as appropriate. 
Risk and Resilience Committee
Oversees and reviews principal and operational 
risks, tracks key risk indicators, receives updates 
on key compliance areas such as data 
protection, regulated credit, ethical sourcing, 
store security and business conduct and 
monitors trends. Chaired by the CFO.
	See pages 39 and 86 for more 
information
Good and Circular Steering Group
Oversees initiatives focused on achieving our 
Good and Circular goals, tracks progress 
against targets and reviews new proposals such 
as new circular business models and further 
improvements to data collection and 
monitoring. Chaired by the CEO.
SR 	See our Sustainability Report 2024
Talent Committee
Oversees and develops succession planning at 
all levels of the business and monitors progress 
against our ‘Know-Grow-Flow’ talent 
management initiative. Chaired by the Stores 
and People Director. 
SR  See our Sustainability Report 2024 for 
more information on our ‘Know-Grow-
Flow’ initiative
The Board as a whole is 
responsible for the overall 
direction, performance and 
long-term success of the Group. 
It is responsible for setting and 
role modelling our purpose and 
shared values. It provides 
effective challenge to 
management on the execution 
of the strategy and is 
responsible for ensuring that 
the Group maintains effective 
risk management and internal 
control systems.
The Board delegates 
responsibility for the day-to-day 
operational management of the 
Company to the CEO.
The CEO is supported by a 
team of executives each of 
whom head a key function area 
of the Group and form the 
Executive Team, which 
operates under the CEO’s 
direction and leadership. 
Executive Team Committees
Executive Team
Executive Team informs/recommends/reports
64
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Governance framework continued
Roles and 
Responsibilities 
The Chair and Chief Executive have clearly 
defined roles which are separate and distinct. 
The specific duties and division of 
responsibilities between them have been 
agreed by the Board and are summarised 
here, together with an overview of the roles 
of the Senior Independent Director, the 
Executive Directors, the Non-Executive 
Directors, the Group General Counsel and 
Company Secretary and the Designated 
NED for colleague matters. 
	Written statements setting out the full 
responsibilities for each role are available 
to download from the corporate website:  
corporate.dunelm.com
Chief Executive Officer
•	Proposing the strategic objectives of the Group for approval by the 
Board and delivering the strategic and financial objectives in line with 
the agreed purpose and strategy.
•	Leading the Executive Team and senior leadership in managing the 
operational requirements of the business.
•	Leading on climate change and sustainability objectives of the Group. 
•	Providing clear and visible leadership of our shared values.
•	Effective and ongoing communication with colleagues and 
shareholders. 
Chief Financial Officer
•	Working with the CEO to develop and implement the Group’s 
purpose and strategic objectives.
•	Focusing on the financial delivery and performance of the Group.
•	Ensuring that the Group remains appropriately funded to pursue 
our strategic objectives.
•	Ensuring proper financial controls and risk management of the 
Group and compliance with associated regulations.
•	Leading on investor relations activities and communications 
with shareholders.
Deputy Chair
•	Maintaining a close dialogue with the Chair and the CEO.
•	Contributing to the development of the Group’s purpose, culture 
and values by promoting and visibly demonstrating the Company’s 
long-established shared values.
•	Assisting the CEO in strategic and operational activities as requested.
•	Supporting and deputising for the Chair as required.
Group General Counsel and Company Secretary
•	Supporting the Chair and Non-Executive Directors with their 
responsibilities. 
•	Advising on corporate governance matters and regulatory compliance.
•	Facilitating individual induction programmes for Directors and 
assisting with training needs as required.
•	Assisting with communications with shareholders and organising 
the AGM. 
Chair
•	Leading the Board and responsible for its effectiveness. Leading on 
governance.
•	Setting the agenda, style and tone of Board discussions with 
a particular focus on strategic matters.
•	Ensuring that each Non-Executive Director makes an effective 
contribution to the Board.
•	Ensuring that the Directors receive accurate, timely and clear 
information.
•	Promoting a culture of openness and debate.
•	Facilitating constructive Board relations.
Senior independent Non-Executive Director
•	Acting as a ‘sounding board’ for the Chair and an intermediary for 
the other Directors.
•	Leading the Non-Executive Directors in their annual assessment of 
the Chair’s performance.
•	Available to shareholders, particularly if they have concerns that the 
normal channels have failed to resolve, or for which such contact 
would be inappropriate.
•	Leading the Chair succession process.
Non-Executive Directors
•	Providing constructive contribution and challenge to the development 
of strategy and ensuring that decisions are taken so as to promote 
the success of the Company in the interests of all stakeholders.
•	Monitoring operational and financial performance and scrutiny of 
management performance in the delivery of strategic objectives.
•	Providing oversight of financial and other control processes for 
risk management. 
Designated Non-Executive Director for colleague matters 
•	Engaging with colleagues (for example through the National 
Colleague Voice) to represent the ‘Colleague Voice’ at the Board. 
•	Monitoring the effectiveness of colleague engagement initiatives.
•	Providing regular updates to the Board.
Executive
Governance
Non-Executive
65
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Governance framework continued
About our Board 
The Board has agreed that our optimum 
number of Board Directors is between nine and 
eleven. As at the date of this report it comprises 
eleven1, with an independent Chair, four 
Executive Directors/non-independent Non-
Executive Directors, and six independent 
Non-Executive Directors. We consider that this 
structure provides a good mix of backgrounds 
and skills, enables the right level of independent 
challenge, and is one that allows for effective 
decision-making. We maintain a clear division 
o1esponsibilities between the leadership of the 
Board and the executive leadership of the 
business, as articulated on the preceding page.
Schedule of Matters Reserved
Certain key matters requiring Board approval 
are set out in a formal schedule of matters 
reserved, which the Board reviews periodically. 
Examples of such matters include Group 
strategy and budget, Group capital structure, 
approval of financial results and Annual Report 
and Accounts, significant capital or contractual 
commitments, ensuring maintenance of internal 
control and risk management systems and 
approval of significant Group-wide policies. 
	The schedule of matters reserved for the 
Board is available on corporate.dunelm.com
Managing conflicts of interests
Directors are required to disclose any actual 
or potential conflicts of interest to the Board 
immediately as and when they arise throughout 
the year. These are considered by the Board 
and any authorisations given are recorded in the 
Board minutes and reviewed annually. In addition, 
a formal process is undertaken each year when 
all Directors confirm to the Board details of any 
other directorships and relevant information in 
connection with related parties.
The Board takes action to ensure that the 
influence of third parties does not compromise 
or override the independent judgement of the 
Board. Should Directors have any concerns 
about the operation of the Board or Dunelm 
management that cannot be resolved, these 
can be recorded in the Board minutes. If, upon 
resignation, any Non-Executive Director has 
concerns of this nature, they may provide a 
written statement to the Chair for circulation.
The Board considers that its procedures to 
approve actual and potential conflicts of interest, 
to ensure that any related party transactions 
involving Directors or their connected persons 
are conducted on an arm’s length basis and 
to provide a communications channel for 
any unresolved concerns, are in place and 
operating effectively.
Director independence 
The Board considers that Alison Brittain was 
independent on her appointment to the Board 
and subsequently as Chair. Kelly Devine was 
not considered independent with effect from 
11 March 2024 upon accepting a role in-house 
with the Company and as a result stepped 
down from all Board Committees. She stepped 
down from the Board in July 2024, ahead of 
commencing her new role the following month. 
William Reeve reached his nine-year tenure in 
July 2024. The Nomination Committee 
confirmed that it is comfortable that he continues 
to demonstrate independent judgement and 
leadership skills — further information can be 
found in the Nomination Committee Report on 
page 74. William will be stepping down from 
the Board at the close of the AGM. All other 
Non-Executive Directors with the exception of 
Marion Sears, are considered to be independent. 
The Board has treated Marion Sears as non-
independent since September 2015 in view of 
her tenure of more than nine years on the 
Board, and her subsequent appointment as a 
Director of WA Capital Limited in March 2016. 
WA Capital Limited is a private limited company 
established by Sir Will Adderley (the Deputy 
Chair, and major shareholder) to act as a 
long-term holding company for his beneficial 
interest in the Company and various other 
investments. The Board determined that this 
appointment does not affect her judgement as 
a Non-Executive Director of Dunelm, and that 
any potential conflict of interest has been 
cleared on the basis that WA Capital Limited 
and Sir Will Adderley are parties to a 
Relationship Agreement, details of which can 
be found in the Directors’ Report on page 117.
Re-election
In accordance with the UK Corporate 
Governance Code, all Directors, with the 
exception of William Reeve, will stand for 
re-election at the 2024 AGM.
Non-Executive Directors will be subject to 
a separate vote by shareholders independent 
of the Adderley family as required by the UK 
Listing Rules. Marion Sears will put herself 
forward for reappointment at the AGM by 
shareholders, independent of the Adderley 
family, as well as under a full shareholder vote.
Time commitment 
The Board recognises the importance of 
individual members having sufficient time to 
discharge their duties. On behalf of the Board, 
the Nomination Committee reviews the time 
commitment of the Chair and each Non-
Executive Director. The Board is satisfied that 
they each commit sufficient time to their duties 
to discharge their responsibilities effectively.
None of the Executive Directors hold any non-
executive board positions at a FTSE 100 company.
	Please see pages 60 to 62 for each Director’s 
biography, which includes details of their 
other key commitments
1.	
There were twelve Directors at FY24 year end. Kelly Devine 
stepped down from the Board on 5 July 2024.
66
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Governance framework continued
Induction and training
Upon joining the Board, each new Director is 
offered a comprehensive and tailored induction 
programme with visits to key sites and meetings 
with the Executive Team, senior leadership and 
other colleagues. 
	See page 76 for an overview of the recently 
appointed NEDs’ induction process
The Group General Counsel and Company 
Secretary reports to the Board at each meeting 
on new legal, regulatory and governance 
developments that affect the Group and actions 
are agreed where needed. Directors attend 
seminars provided by independent organisations 
which cover a wide range of governance topics. 
As part of the annual Board evaluation, any 
additional training or development needs are 
addressed by the Chair with each Director. 
	For details of the specific skills and 
contribution of each Director see the 
Directors’ biographies on pages 60 to 62 
Advice and insurance
All Directors have access to the advice and 
services of the Group General Counsel and 
Company Secretary. In addition, Directors may 
seek legal advice at the Group’s expense if they 
consider it necessary in connection with their 
duties. The Group purchases Directors’ and 
Officers’ liability insurance cover for its Directors 
and officers.
Share buyback and Rule 9 waiver
Since the time of flotation of the Company, 
the members of the Adderley family, including 
Bill and Jean Adderley, Lady Nadine Adderley 
and Sir Will Adderley, have been considered to 
be acting in concert (‘a Concert Party’) for the 
purposes of Rule 9 of the City Code on 
Takeovers and Mergers (the ‘Takeover Code’). 
At the date of this report, Sir Will Adderley is 
beneficially interested in 31.1% of the issued 
share capital of the Company, and the Concert 
Party controls 42.4%. Bill and Jean Adderley are 
no longer Directors of the Company or actively 
involved. Sir Will Adderley is a Director and 
Deputy Chair.
As usual we will be requesting authority to buy 
back up to 5 million shares (2.5%) of our share 
capital) at the AGM. This authority is to allow the 
Company to purchase shares in order to satisfy 
future share option entitlements for colleagues, 
excluding Sir Will Adderley. Given that it is 
expected that shares bought by Dunelm in the 
market will be reissued, then no dilution or 
change of control should occur either for the 
Concert Party or for other shareholders. As Sir 
Will Adderley has a beneficial interest of above 
30% of our share capital, and the interest of the 
Concert Party is less than 50%, we are required 
to ask shareholders to approve a waiver of Rule 
9 of the Takeover Code. This waiver permits the 
Company to exercise its authority to buy back 
shares without triggering an obligation on 
Sir Will Adderley to make an offer to buy all 
of the shares in the Company. 
We understand that some shareholders have 
concerns about Rule 9 waivers in general and/or 
they may be bound by their voting policy to vote 
against the resolution. Nevertheless, we hope 
that shareholders will give this administrative 
matter full consideration and conclude that they 
can support the waiver in line with the Board’s 
recommendation, notwithstanding any internal 
voting policy. In this regard we would like to 
reassure shareholders that:
•	Shares bought back by the Company would 
be held in treasury and used only to satisfy 
share option entitlements, and not cancelled.
•	Since 2012, Sir Will Adderley no longer 
participates in the Long-Term Incentive Plan 
or any other share-based incentive plan, and 
therefore his shareholding will not increase 
through that mechanism.
•	Since flotation of the Company in 2006, the 
Adderley family has reduced its holding (from 
67% to 42.4% currently).
•	There has been a Relationship Agreement in 
place since flotation which provides 
safeguards to other shareholders — for details 
please see page 117.
We therefore request that shareholders take 
into account our specific circumstances when 
making their voting decision on the waiver 
resolution, and hope that shareholders will 
support the Board’s recommendation.
The Board has reviewed whether our policy to 
purchase shares in the market to satisfy share 
option entitlements (as opposed to issuing 
shares) is still appropriate; we believe that it is in 
the interests of our shareholder base as a whole 
as it avoids dilution of shareholdings, and it is 
supported by the majority of our institutional 
shareholders. We would like to reiterate that 
shares bought back by the Company will be 
held in treasury and used only to satisfy share 
option entitlements, and not cancelled. The 
Company did not purchase any of its own 
shares during FY24.
Risk
The Board has overall responsibility for the 
management of risk and for setting the risk 
appetite. During the year, the Board conducted 
a review of the Company’s principal risks and 
approved the Group’s risk appetite. 
	See page 38 to 45 for the risk management 
framework and the Group’s principal risks 
and uncertainties
67
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Culture and values
Culture
Dunelm has an open and straightforward 
culture, with a focus on doing the right thing 
and taking decisions for the long term. This 
reflects the values instilled by the Adderley 
family, who founded our business 45 years 
ago and are still our major shareholders. 
The foundations of our culture and values are 
apparent in the reflections of some of our 
longest-serving colleagues who came together 
as part of our recent celebration of 40 years of 
stores; a snapshot of their comments is set out 
on the following pages. 
The Board is careful to ensure that we protect 
and retain this culture as the business grows and 
becomes more complex. 
Our shared values
Our shared values have inevitably evolved over 
time from the business principles formulated 
by Sir Will Adderley, our Deputy Chair, over 
a decade ago. However, that they have not 
changed significantly is testament to their 
strength and importance to the business. 
We very much believe in setting the tone from 
the top and consider it the Board’s responsibility 
to instil and maintain a culture of openness, 
integrity and transparency. We also expect our 
Directors and senior leadership team to role 
model our shared values and consider them 
when making decisions and communicating 
with stakeholders.
We believe that our shared values are an 
essential contributor towards driving the right 
behaviours and maintaining a positive culture of 
mutual respect, trust and constructive challenge.
We are strongly opposed to any form of 
corruption or bribery and have controls in place 
that have been built around a clear understanding 
of how and where bribery risks could affect our 
business. This includes policies (such as our 
Anti-bribery & Anti-corruption policy), 
procedures such as conducting due diligence 
on suppliers, annual training for colleagues 
on bribery risks and an ongoing audit and 
assurance programme in respect of our 
suppliers. Bribery risk management is discussed 
at senior leadership meetings, including at the 
Risk and Resilience Committee, and also at the 
Audit and Risk Committee.
We encourage any colleagues and other 
stakeholders with concerns to speak out and 
have facilitated this through our Whistleblowing 
policy, which enables reports to be submitted 
on a named or anonymous basis. Reports are 
kept strictly confidential and concerns identified 
are referred to appropriate managers within the 
Group for investigation. An analysis of reports is 
provided regularly to the Audit and Risk 
Committee.
Monitoring our culture
We aim to provide an environment that inspires, 
engages and develops all of our colleagues to 
reach their full potential. The Board engages 
directly with our colleagues in a number of ways 
that assist it in monitoring our culture, including 
by means of our colleague representative body, 
National Colleague Voice (‘NCV’) (see page 22 
for more information). 
Our Designated NED for colleague matters 
(who attends NCV meetings) is Marion Sears, 
who has a wealth of workforce experience from 
her roles as chair of remuneration and ESG 
committees at listed companies, including 
Dunelm’s Remuneration Committee from 2006 
to 2015. She also has an in-depth understanding 
Our purpose is ‘To help create the joy of truly 
feeling at home, now and for generations to 
come’. It informs our strategy, is underpinned 
by our shared values and is supported by our 
approach to sustainability (see our Sustainability 
Report 2024 for more information). We are 
committed to ensuring that the Company’s 
actions are in keeping with our culture, values 
and purpose to drive long-term success.
Codes of Conduct, anti-bribery and other 
policies
Our shared values are reflected in our Group 
policies, which are an important expression of 
how we look after our colleagues and how they 
should expect to be treated by others. These 
policies include a Code of Business Conduct 
and a Colleague Code of Conduct, which set 
out specific standards of ethics and behaviour. 
These Codes make reference to a number of 
other policies and procedures that have to be 
followed, including Equality & Diversity, Health 
& Safety, Prevention of Slavery and Human 
Trafficking Statement, Ethical Code of Conduct 
for Suppliers and Partners, Tax Strategy, 
Whistleblowing and our privacy notices. 
Mandatory training is provided on all high-risk 
areas as part of induction and on an annual basis.
of Dunelm’s culture, values and people, having 
been on the Board since 2004, placing her in an 
ideal position to understand colleague views 
and ensure that these are fed into the Board’s 
decision-making processes.
People and culture is one of our principal risks, 
which are considered formally by the Executive 
Team and Board of Directors twice a year with 
relevant trends tracked and discussed as 
appropriate. For more information on our 
People and Culture risk see page 43.
Culture is also monitored by way of regular 
reporting to the Group Board and Executive 
Team, by way of specific ‘People’ reports 
(covering engagement, retention, gender pay 
and diversity, amongst other things) and others 
that are indicative of culture, such as health and 
safety and whistleblowing. The Nomination 
Committee supports the Board in reviewing 
culture, diversity, inclusion and talent 
management and the Remuneration Committee 
in assessing executive performance. 
Finally, we encourage our Directors, Executive 
Team and senior leadership to ensure that they 
regularly interact in-person with colleagues 
working in all areas of our business. By 
engaging with, listening to, respecting and 
responding to our colleagues, we facilitate an 
open working environment, encourage a sense 
of belonging and develop a strategy that 
resonates, all of which supports our ongoing 
ambition to deliver continuous improvement 
and further growth.
We very much believe in setting 
the tone from the top… we are 
committed to ensuring that the 
Company’s actions are in keeping 
with our culture, values and 
purpose to drive long-term success.
68
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Culture and values continued
40
This year we celebrated the 40th anniversary 
of the first Dunelm store, which opened at 
Leicester Churchgate in the early 1980s. The 
store marked the first move by the Adderley 
family away from the market stall where they 
started the Dunelm business back in 1979. 
To mark the milestone, over the summer 
we provided colleagues with an additional 
‘Double Discount’ day, an opportunity to 
celebrate with their teams and reflect on our 
heritage and culture, and featured a pop-up 
museum of Dunelm memorabilia at our Head 
Office in Leicester. 
We brought together 10 of our longest-
serving colleagues to reminisce about their 
earliest memories of Dunelm stores, including 
Churchgate. They also discussed how far the 
business has come since that opening, and 
what makes it special to work at Dunelm. 
We filmed an internal video to capture 
their recollections and a few snippets from 
their discussions can be found on the 
following page.
Will Adderley
Deputy Chair 
(31 years)
Sarah Way  
Central E-Fulfilment Manager  
(26 years)
Cheryl Archer
Furniture Operations 
Support Manager 
(21 years)
Emma Connor
Buyer — Bathroom 
(27 years)
Ian Sanders
Project Manager 
(30 years)
years of stores
Steve Barton  
Director of Property  
(21 years)
Rory McAllister
Stores Director 
(16 years)
Barbara Inchley  
Senior Manager, 
Commercial  
(22 years)
Lisa Allen  
Buying Administration  
Manager (35 years)
James Rowell
Audit and Security 
(33 years)
69
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Leicester Churchgate: 
Dunelm’s first store opened in 
an old foundry in the early 1980s 
— and the brand Dunelm Mill 
was established.
Culture and values continued
Barbara: [On Churchgate] “That was an 
absolute favourite shop of mine…I worked 
just down the road, so at lunchtime I used to 
go into Churchgate and it was just a treasure 
trove of really exciting products.”
Will: [On Churchgate] “It was an old foundry, 
most people would describe it as a mill. It 
certainly wasn’t designed to be a shop and 
had an awful configuration. But we set it up 
and in the lobby, we had all of the wall 
covered in curtains. Initially it just sold 
seconds, but over time, it really got us on the 
map in Leicester, and my Dad was able to 
close his market stall and move there. 
Because it had three floors above, that 
became the warehouse.”
James: “Churchgate traded on its own for 
a few years before the likes of Coalville, 
Cannock and Hinkley, and then East Street.”
Barbara: “The fabrics were always so 
important for us.” 
Lisa: “[In our early stores] customers kept 
coming back…some people would come 
every single week…they were gutted if they 
were going on holiday in case they missed 
something. You didn’t know what was on our 
delivery from one week to the next…it was 
simply whatever Bill could buy. Customers 
might have bought something the week 
before and came back, hoping to find 
something to match it.” 
Barbara: “I remember driving down the road 
and we would look out the window thinking 
“that could be a good store”, and we’d write 
it down!”
Rory: “Colleagues really knew what they 
were doing — but did make the odd error. 
I remember walking into the Thurmaston 
store one day and there was a huge table 
full of purple bedding. I asked where it all 
came from and the manager said his auntie 
quite liked it so he’d ordered loads of it.”
Cheryl: “I joined when we opened our first 
distribution centre in Burton-on-Trent back 
in 2003…we thought we were never going to 
fill it…we filled it within the first six months.”
Sarah: “We took the first order for our 
website in 2005, from the basement of our 
Radcliffe store.”
Steve: “We once opened 16 stores in one 
year — big stores and big investments.” 
Rory: “It’s still really exciting when we open 
a new store, with lots of energy. For the 
customers in that catchment, it’s something 
new for them. Recently in Cwmbran we 
had a queue of over 400 customers 
waiting outside.”
Will: “If you think about our history, 
including our first website, and the Covid 
period, we seem to be at our best when it’s 
almost chaos. We move quickly when it’s 
difficult. We have to keep taking those 
opportunities, to move quicker…and that’s 
exciting. If we’d stayed the same, we 
wouldn’t still be here, and if we don’t 
change we’ll be less relevant.” 
70
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Board activities
Board meetings follow a rolling agenda of strategic, operational and 
governance matters, which is refreshed during the year as necessary 
to ensure the Board continues to focus on areas of priority.
The Board discharges its responsibilities 
through an annual programme of Board and 
Committee meetings, with additional ad hoc 
meetings as required to meet business needs. 
These are supplemented by visits to stores and 
other sites. Agendas are determined in advance 
to ensure that meetings are well-planned and 
time is allocated as appropriate. Papers are 
circulated ahead of time to ensure that 
Directors are able to review and arrive at 
meetings fully prepared. 
The Chair meets with the Non-Executive 
Directors at the end of each Board meeting. 
This is a useful way of exchanging views and 
dealing with any concerns or questions. In 
addition to this, the Chair and the other 
Non-Executive Directors regularly have informal, 
individual meetings with the Executive Directors, 
other members of the Executive Team and 
other senior leaders in the business.
At each meeting in the year, the CEO reports on 
strategic progress and operational performance 
(including customers, colleagues and health 
and safety) and the CFO reports on financial 
performance. A rolling agenda of other 
strategic, operational, sustainability, risk and 
governance matters is refreshed during the year 
as necessary to ensure the Board continues to 
focus on areas of priority, whilst also continuing 
to meet regulatory requirements. 
•	Annual strategy review
•	Presentations on strategic
plans for each of stores,
digital and commercial
•	Review of tech strategy
and roadmap
•	Overview of responsible
sourcing
•	Business development
updates
•	Review of culture and values
•	Deep dive on supply chain
•	Q&A with suppliers
•	Reviewed sustainability
strategy and received
updates on Good & Circular
initiatives and KRIs
•	Received presentation on
generative AI
•	Deep dive on customer
segmentation
•	CEO and CFO reports
(which include trading
updates, KRIs, people and
H&S updates, customer and
market trends etc)
•	Received feedback from the
National Colleague Voice
•	Reviewed colleague
dashboard
•	Reviewed interim and
preliminary results
•	Approved final, interim and
special dividends
•	Discussed feedback on
results and investor
engagement
•	Reviewed principal risks
•	Received cyber and data
protection updates
•	Approved tax strategy
•	Received corporate
governance and legislative
updates
•	Annual health and safety
update
•	Approved delegation
of authorities
•	Approved actions from
Board evaluation
•	Received Modern Day
Slavery update and
approved annual statement
•	Approved share plans
•	Approved Notice of
Meeting, received AGM
results and feedback
•	Reviewed NED fees
•	Reviewed conflicts of
interest register
•	Approved gender pay
gap report
•	Reviewed forward agenda
planner
•	Confirmed risk appetite
Strategy
Operational performance
Governance
Strategy
31%
Time spent
Operational performance
38%
Time spent
Governance
26%
Time spent
FY24 Board activities
The Board held eight formally scheduled 
meetings in FY24, as well as a full day 
dedicated to strategy. Its activities are 
broadly split between strategy, operational 
performance & governance.
71
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Board activities continued
Our approach to Section 172
Each of our Directors is mindful of their duties 
under section 172 of the Companies Act 2006 
(‘s.172’) to run the Company for the long-term 
benefit of its shareholders and, in doing so, to 
consider the interests of its key stakeholders 
during its decision-making, and the impact of its 
decisions on stakeholder relationships, on the 
Company’s reputation for high standards of 
business conduct, and on the environment. 
The matters encompassed in s.172 touch on 
everything we do, at a Board level in our 
discussions and decision-making, and also at 
a business level by members of our Executive 
Team and the senior leadership team. Examples 
of the ‘Board in action’ are set out on this page 
and on page 73. On pages 20 to 24 we describe 
our key stakeholders and summarise how and 
why we engage with them more generally, what 
matters most to them, allocation of responsibility 
within the business and how we consider the 
effectiveness of our engagement.
A key consideration when making decisions is 
for the Board to balance the needs of our various 
stakeholders, which may not themselves always 
be aligned, while considering the Company’s 
purpose, values and strategic priorities. The 
Board acknowledges that not all decisions that 
it makes will result in a positive outcome for all 
stakeholders, but it remains focused on ensuring 
that its decision-making is consistent and in the 
best interests of the Company. 
We ensure that the requirements of s.172(1) 
Companies Act 2006 are met and the interests 
of our stakeholder groups are considered, 
challenged and debated through a combination 
of the following practical approaches (all of 
which were applied during FY24):
•	the Board carries out an annual review of 
strategy which assesses the long-term 
sustainable success of the Group and our 
impact on key stakeholders. Agenda items for 
the following year are based on the decisions 
and next steps agreed at this meeting;
•	the Board’s risk management procedures 
identify the principal and emerging risks 
facing the Group, and the mitigation in place 
to manage their impact. We consider these 
through a stakeholder lens as set out on 
pages 20 to 24;
•	the Group General Counsel and Company 
Secretary references relevant s.172 factors 
against each agenda item in the minutes to 
ensure they remain at the forefront of Directors’ 
minds when reflecting on discussions;
•	the rolling Board agenda includes standing 
items to ensure that stakeholders are fully 
considered, including investor roadshow 
feedback, updates on people matters, the 
annual health and safety presentation, 
modern slavery and anti-bribery reporting 
and sustainability updates;
•	there is a formal review of many of these 
topics through standard Audit and Risk 
Committee and Remuneration Committee 
agenda items, as described later in this report;
•	the Board considers impact on key 
stakeholders when it reviews Group KPIs and 
requests additional information as 
appropriate; and
•	all Directors attend our AGM, which provides 
a valuable opportunity each year for all 
shareholders to hear from the Board, and for 
the Board to hear from our shareholders.
Strategy review
The Board met in May 2024 for its annual 
strategy review. The day commenced with 
a store-walk accompanied by commentary 
from product category directors enabling 
engagement with senior leaders and store 
colleagues. Key topics then presented by the 
Executive Team over the course of the day 
included consumer trends and customers of 
the future, elevating product mastery, 
connecting with our customers digitally and 
instore and reviewing our technology roadmap. 
The structure of the day enabled a detailed 
understanding and debate by the Board of 
our strategy and growth plans. The extent of 
our operational grip was both welcomed and 
challenged, as was the scale of our ambition 
and innovation. The Board also challenged 
management on the potential for acceleration 
of business change and efficiencies, whether 
there can be even greater focus on operational 
leverage and how the risks and opportunities 
in the three-year plan have been balanced.
The Board acknowledged the importance of 
continued investment in technology, insights 
and data as key drivers to sustainable growth, 
as well as the value of ongoing engagement 
with our key stakeholders so as to ensure we 
really understand their views, how our actions 
are likely to impact them and consider this 
within our decision-making. 
The Board welcomed management’s 
articulation of the growth strategy: building 
‘The Home of Homes’. It participated in a lively 
discussion on our culture and values and 
confirmed its support for the three-year plan. 
The agreed actions and takeaways for 
management were noted with updates to be 
provided by way of further presentations and 
deep dives by business area built into the 
Board agenda over the course of the next 
12 months.
Board in action
72
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Board activities continued
The investment has given the 
team a place they can be proud to 
work in and there’s an amazing 
sense of togetherness. Furniture 
is a fast-growing category, and 
HDN is a core part of that. Having 
our own people, in our own vans, 
giving a fantastic service to 
customers is a real point of 
difference and one that we 
should celebrate.
Faye Atkins
Director of Commercial and Supply Chain
New home delivery depot 
To ensure continued growth and delivery 
on our strategic ambitions, it is critical that 
we invest appropriately in our infrastructure. 
With the increase in our Home Delivery sales 
and ongoing development of our customer 
proposition, together with feedback from 
colleagues, we considered that our existing 
Barnsley depot was no longer suitable to 
support our ambitions. We therefore made 
the decision to relocate the depot to another 
location within Barnsley with increased space, 
better colleague facilities and improved 
security and transport links. It provides for a 
more suitable and safer operation, improving 
how much stock can pass through the site 
and enhancing our customer service.
The site is one of five standalone hubs for our 
Home Delivery Network (‘HDN’), which is a key 
part of Dunelm’s customer proposition, enabling 
us to deliver furniture directly to a room of our 
customer’s choice.
Commercial and supply chain deep dive
In November 2023, the Board met at our Stoke 
Distribution Centre. The Director of Logistics 
Operations provided an update on logistics 
performance, ongoing improvement projects, 
our carrier strategy and colleague engagement 
specific to this area of the business. Guided 
tours were conducted around our site, 
reminding Directors how our fulfilment 
operations work and enabling them to ask 
questions directly of colleagues at this location 
and see firsthand improvements articulated in 
previous Board updates, including those 
relating to health and safety. 
At the same meeting, the Directors were 
provided with an overview of our Commercial 
plans by our Director of Commercial and 
Supply Chain and participated in detailed 
discussions relating to our sustainability 
initiatives, including our better manufacturing 
programme and our responsible sourcing 
programme (and the new tools that we are 
implementing to assist with the collation and 
monitoring of data and actions). 
The Board considered the role that a trusted 
and transparent supply base, with strong 
communication and understanding, plays in 
maintaining our reputation for high standards 
of business conduct and meeting our 
sustainability goals. The Directors were also 
reminded of how our supply base has been 
built up and the important role that committed 
suppliers have played, and continue to play, in 
our growth story. They discussed the ways in 
which the role and demands on suppliers have 
developed over time and how our own model 
and approach has evolved to-date and will 
need to evolve further in the future in order to 
maintain value and competitive advantage.
To bring to life those relationships, the Board 
then met in-person with a number of our 
committed suppliers, participating in an 
engaging Q&A, which further demonstrated 
the value of direct engagement in 
understanding what matters most to our 
key stakeholders, in the short, medium and 
longer term.
Board in action continued
73
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Alison Brittain
Committee membership
Alison Brittain (Committee Chair)
Sir Will Adderley
Ian Bull
Ajay Kavan
William Reeve
Marion Sears
Arja Taaveniku
Vijay Talwar
Dan Taylor
	See page 63 for meeting attendance
Composition, succession 
and evaluation
Nomination Committee report
On behalf of the Nomination Committee 
(‘Committee’), I am pleased to present the 
Nomination Committee report for the year 
ended 29 June 2024. It was another busy 
year, with added emphasis on ensuring that 
we maintain the appropriate combination 
of skills, experience and knowledge on our 
Board in light of several changes to its 
membership. 
FY24 highlights/key activities
•	Reviewed Board composition and Director 
independence.
•	Recommended the appointment of 
Ajay Kavan and Dan Taylor as NEDs.
•	Recommended the appointment of 
Ian Bull as Senior Independent Director and 
Ajay Kavan as Chair of the Remuneration 
Committee.
•	Focused on senior leadership succession 
planning.
•	Conducted an internal Board effectiveness 
evaluation.
FY25 focus/priorities
•	Externally facilitated Board evaluation.
•	Further evolution of succession plans.
•	Continued focus on diversity and inclusion.
1.	
Peter Ruis resigned from the Board on 10 January 2024, ahead 
of the ninth anniversary of his appointment.
New appointments
We were mindful that a review of the 
composition of the Board was required, with 
Peter Ruis and William Reeve both approaching 
nine years’ tenure during the course of 20241. 
Therefore, we commenced a search for new 
Non-Executive Directors in the autumn of 2023. 
We were delighted to welcome Ajay Kavan and 
Dan Taylor to the Board in March 2024. Ajay and 
Dan bring varied experience from different 
multi-channel, consumer-facing businesses, 
adding further expertise and skills to the Board 
as we continue to unlock our potential and grow 
our customer proposition. More information 
about the recruitment process and Ajay and 
Dan’s induction can be found on pages 76 and 
77 respectively. 
We announced on 11 July 2024, that after nine 
years on the Board, William Reeve will not be 
standing for re-election at our 2024 AGM. 
In anticipation of this decision, during the year 
the Committee’s work on succession planning 
included the positions of Senior Independent 
Director and Chair of the Remuneration 
Committee, and I am delighted that, with effect 
from 21 November 2024, Ian Bull and Ajay Kavan 
respectively have been appointed by the Board 
to undertake those roles. 
Ian is our Audit and Risk Committee Chair 
and is a long-standing Board member with an 
in-depth understanding of the business and its 
culture, placing him in an ideal position to be 
appointed as our Senior Independent Director. 
Ajay joined the Board earlier this year, and 
whilst he is relatively new to the Company, 
will have served nearly nine months on the 
Remuneration Committee by the time of his 
appointment and have completed a full annual 
cycle of Remuneration Committee meetings. 
We are confident that his wealth of executive 
retail experience and role as an advisor and 
mentor to CEOs stand him in good stead to 
take on the role of Remuneration Committee 
Chair. A detailed handover is underway 
between William and Ajay. In addition, Ajay 
has been engaging with colleagues, including 
by attending National Colleague Voice 
meetings, participating in a series of meetings 
with me, our Group General Counsel and 
Company Secretary, Stores and People 
Director and other senior leaders in the 
people and finance teams, and meeting with 
our external remuneration consultants. 
Independence
We apply careful consideration to ensuring 
that we meet all relevant independence 
criteria and, with a number of appointments 
and resignations this year, this has been a 
particular area of focus for the Committee.
74
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Nomination Committee report continued
In light of other Board changes, and our wish 
to ensure a smooth handover of responsibilities, 
we asked William Reeve to continue on the 
Board for an additional five-month period 
beyond his ninth anniversary. However, in 
doing so, we were mindful of the need to 
consider his ongoing independence. The 
Committee reflected on William’s contribution 
and performance as an independent Non-
Executive Director and concluded that there 
is no reason to suggest that his length of time 
on the Board has or will affect his effective 
challenge of the status quo and of management, 
nor has it resulted in his being considered too 
close to management to fulfil his oversight 
roles. Although we agreed to reassess the 
position regularly, the Committee remains 
comfortable that he continues to demonstrate 
independent judgement and leadership skills, 
enhanced by his knowledge of the Company. 
As mentioned above, William will step down 
in November and will not seek re-election at 
our AGM.
During the year, the Committee remained 
informed on plans to appoint a new Customer 
Director to the Executive Team. Following 
a formal and robust recruitment process, 
Kelly Devine, an independent Non-Executive 
Director on our Board, was offered the role. 
Kelly’s new role with us was announced 
on 11 March 2024, when we confirmed that 
she would step down from the Board on 
5 July 2024. We also confirmed that she 
would be considered non-independent with 
immediate effect and would step down from 
all Board Committees. 
Diversity and inclusion
Diversity and inclusion remain a central and 
vital area of focus for the Committee. We 
welcomed the progress that management 
made during the year in developing and 
introducing new initiatives, and in particular 
those focused on supporting colleagues from 
underrepresented groups and ethnicities. 
For details of our progress see page 80.
The diversity of our Board is on page 79, and 
I am pleased to report that we have exceeded 
the target set in the UK Listing Rules and Parker 
Review guidelines to have at least one Board 
member from a minority ethnic background. 
Similarly, we exceed the requirement to have 
at least one senior Board position held by a 
woman and, throughout FY24, met the UK 
Listing Rule and FTSE Women Leaders Review’s 
target to have at least 40% female Board 
members. We are extremely mindful that, for 
the period between Kelly stepping down in July 
2024 and William stepping down in November 
2024, we will briefly fall below this target and 
we will carefully consider gender balance in 
the process for our next Board appointment. 
Board evaluation
Finally, I am pleased to confirm that this 
year’s Board evaluation process, which was 
conducted internally, found that the Board and 
its Committees continue to operate effectively. 
Further details can be found on pages 78 and 79.
I look forward to meeting shareholders at the 
Annual General Meeting on 21 November 2024.
Alison Brittain
Chair of the Nomination Committee 
11 September 2024
Committee composition and governance 
The majority of the Committee was 
independent throughout FY24. It remains 
so as at the date of this report, its members 
comprising six independent Non-Executive 
Directors, the independent Chair of the 
Board, one non-independent Non-Executive 
Director1 and the Board’s non-independent 
Deputy Chair2. 
	See pages 63 and 66 for more information on 
the independence of Directors.
Only members of the Committee have the 
right to attend Committee meetings. Other 
individuals, such as the CEO and People and 
Stores Director, are invited to attend all or part 
of the meetings as appropriate. No Director 
attends that part of a meeting during which his 
or her own position is discussed. The Group 
General Counsel and Company Secretary 
acts as secretary to the Committee and attends 
all meetings. 
In FY24, the Committee met formally on three 
scheduled occasions. An additional meeting 
was held to recommend the appointment of 
two new Non-Executive Directors. The agenda 
for each scheduled meeting is based on a 
standing agenda for the financial year, which 
is updated as appropriate. 
Role and principal duties
The Nomination Committee is responsible for 
leading the process for Board appointments, 
ensuring appropriate succession plans are 
in place, and overseeing the development 
of a diverse talent pipeline. Its principal 
duties include: 
•	reviewing the structure, size and 
composition (including the skills, knowledge, 
experience and diversity) of the Board, 
ensuring it remains effective and suited to 
the Company’s strategic priorities;
•	ensuring plans are in place for an orderly 
succession to Board, Executive Team and 
senior leadership positions and overseeing 
the development of a diverse pipeline 
for succession;
•	keeping under review the leadership needs 
of the business with a view to ensuring its 
continued ability to compete effectively in 
the marketplace;
•	identifying and nominating for the approval 
of the Board, candidates to fill Board 
vacancies as and when they arise;
•	leading a rigorous and transparent process 
for Board appointments; and
•	keeping under review demands on 
Directors’ time.
	The Committee’s full terms of reference can 
be found at: corporate.dunelm.com
1.	
Marion Sears is not considered independent, due to the length 
of her tenure and her role as a Director of WA Capital Limited.
2.	
Sir Will Adderley is not considered independent as he is a 
significant shareholder and due to the length of his tenure and 
his executive Deputy Chair role.
75
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Nomination Committee report continued
NED succession — review of skills, 
experience and knowledge
During the year, the Committee undertook 
a detailed skills review, utilising the framework 
introduced the previous year for considering 
each Director’s skills and experience. The 
process anticipated the forthcoming departure 
of two long-standing Non-Executive Directors 
in 2024, which would also lead to the roles of 
Senior Independent Director and Remuneration 
Committee Chair being vacated. 
The Committee considered the impact of the 
expected departures from a skills perspective, 
alongside other areas where additional 
experience might be beneficial in light of the 
Group’s strategic aims and objectives. The 
same framework was used to review how 
Directors identify from a gender and ethnicity 
perspective. This was then used to guide the 
search brief for recruiting Ajay Kavan and Dan 
Taylor, who were appointed in March 2024. 
The work has since been updated to reflect Ajay 
and Dan’s respective skills and diversity, as well 
as the impact of Kelly Devine stepping down 
from the Board in July 2024 and Arja Taaveniku 
stepping down at the end of the calendar year. 
It is being used to inform the search brief for 
the recruitment of the next independent 
Non-Executive Director. 
Key search criteria
•	Consumer-focused leader with growth 
mindset.
•	Clear experience of driving innovation and 
using technology to build businesses.
•	Strong understanding of digital and 
data-centric strategies to drive performance.
External search firm
MWM Consulting supported the search in 
FY24 for Non-Executive Directors. It has no 
further connection with the Company or 
its Board.
External search diversity (longlist)
29%
of profiles female
14%
of profiles ethnic minority
8
nationalities represented
FY24 independent Non-Executive Director appointment process 
We generally follow a well-established process for Board appointments as set out below, adapted where necessary to account for specific skills 
required and circumstances. 
Stage 1
Jul 2023
Stage 2
Sep 2023
Stage 3
Nov 2023
Stage 4
Nov 2023—
Jan 2024
Stage 5
Jan 2024
Stage 6
Feb 2024
MWM Consulting 
engaged to support 
the process and 
conduct the search.
Detailed role and 
person specification 
drawn up and 
approved by the 
Committee, with 
MWM Consulting 
asked to ensure 
a diverse longlist.
Longlist of potential 
candidates presented 
and discussed by the 
Committee, following 
which a shortlist was 
determined.
Shortlisted candidates 
met with the Chair, 
Deputy Chair and 
Marion Sears, 
following which the 
two preferred 
candidates, Ajay 
Kavan and Dan Taylor, 
met with all other 
Board members.
References taken, 
alongside reputational 
checks. Other 
commitments were 
assessed to ensure 
that the candidates 
had sufficient time to 
dedicate to Board 
member duties.
Recommendation 
made to the Board 
for approval and 
announcement issued 
on 8 February 2024 
that they would join 
the Board, and be 
appointed to the Audit 
and Risk, Nomination 
and Remuneration 
Committees with effect 
from 1 March 2024.
76
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Nomination Committee report continued
Each new Board Director receives a full and tailored induction, 
led by the Chair and Group General Counsel and Company 
Secretary. Dan and Ajay’s induction when they joined the Board 
in FY24 included the following meetings:
Members of the Board.
•	Chair provided an overview of the Board and its annual 
programme of meetings.
•	CEO discussed the strategy and ‘Plan on a Page’.
•	Committee Chairs discussed how their respective 
Committees operate and matters of significance. 
•	CFO provided a summary of the Group’s financial 
performance and future plans.
Executive Team and senior leadership team.
•	Introduction to management structure, business operations, 
focus areas and performance.
•	Introduction to key opportunities and risks in each area of 
the business.
•	Group General Counsel and Company Secretary provided an 
overview of the governance framework and corporate structure.
Other colleagues and site visits.
•	Attended a National Colleague Voice meeting to develop 
an understanding of the views of colleagues.
•	Visits to stores.
•	Visits to our logistics and manufacturing centres.
Key advisors
•	External and internal auditors.
•	Remuneration consultants.
•	Brokers.
	For more information about our new NEDs, see biographies 
on pages 61 and 62
Induction process for our new NEDs
Dan Taylor
Dan is a customer-oriented leader with strong retail credentials, 
fluent on customer trends within the UK market and clear 
understanding of how to harness insight and customer data 
across online platforms to drive strategic decisions.
Ajay Kavan
Ajay has strong digital expertise across multiple consumer 
categories, bringing strong focus on value creation. He has a 
proven track record of developing and refining strategic plans 
to drive performance and growth. 
Executive Director succession
The Committee reviewed and refreshed CEO 
and CFO succession plans during the year, 
having dissolved the working groups initially 
established for this purpose in favour of 
discussions taking place with the full Committee 
present. Work in this area built upon the 
previously conducted market mapping exercise. 
It also included a review of the internal pipeline 
for the CEO and CFO roles, with a particular 
focus on learning and development plans, 
mentoring and Board exposure.
Senior leadership succession
During the year, the Committee reviewed 
succession plans for the Executive Team and 
other senior leadership roles. It also received 
updates on the talent and skills of the senior 
leadership team within our ‘Know, Grow, Flow’ 
framework, which provides the Committee 
with a clear and consistent approach to 
understanding capabilities. The focus this year 
on ‘role model leadership’ as part of senior team 
career development was particularly welcomed. 
The Committee also discussed the interim 
arrangements that were put in place for the 
period between the previous Customer 
Director’s departure from the business in early 
2024 and Kelly Devine commencing the role in 
July 2024.
77
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Nomination Committee report continued
Assessing Board effectiveness 
An evaluation of the Board, its Committees and 
Directors is carried out each year. The review 
helps to identify areas for improvement, informs 
training plans and identifies areas of knowledge, 
expertise or diversity which should be 
considered in our succession plans. The Chair 
engages with each individual Director during the 
year on their performance and contribution and 
the Senior Independent Director and Deputy 
Chair review the performance of the Chair. The 
Committee reviews the time commitment of the 
Chair and each Non-Executive Director during 
the year as appropriate.
During the year, the Board and each Committee 
reflects on progress against the actions 
identified from the previous year’s effectiveness 
review. Progress against our FY23 evaluation is 
set out on the right.
The FY24 evaluation was conducted internally 
on a consistent basis with FY23. Each Director 
completed a questionnaire in respect of the 
Board and each Committee of which they are a 
member or otherwise attended meetings on a 
regular basis. The Group General Counsel and 
Company Secretary collated the responses and 
shared them with the Chair and each respective 
Committee Chair. An executive summary with 
the key findings was then shared, alongside 
each report, with the Board and each 
Committee’s members for discussion. 
Progress against FY23 evaluation recommendations
Theme/Topic
Outcomes from FY23 evaluation
Actions implemented in FY24
Succession Planning
•	Acknowledgement that the appointment of new NEDs 
to the Board, and to the roles of Senior Independent 
Director and Chair of the Remuneration Committee 
when William Reeve and Peter Ruis step down in 2024, 
is a priority.
•	Continue to focus on succession plans and capability 
development for key senior positions.
Successful conclusion of recruitment process with the 
appointment of Ajay Kavan and Dan Taylor in March 
2024. Ian Bull to be appointed as Senior Independent 
Director and Ajay Kavan as Chair of the Remuneration 
Committee with effect from 21 November 2024.
Updates delivered on succession plans and capability 
development for senior leadership during the year.
Stakeholder engagement 
•	Undertake a more detailed review of supplier 
relationships and consider increased supplier 
engagement at Board level to further develop 
understanding of opportunities and risks.
Supplier deep dive included presentations on supply 
chain strategy, circular sourcing, and responsible 
sourcing. The Board also participated in a Q&A event 
with key suppliers.
ESG-related risks and 
opportunities
•	Continue to support management in refining our ESG 
strategy and approach and ensure that it remains 
relevant to our strategy. 
•	Provide feedback on reporting and share wider 
learnings and experience.
Supported evolution of governance, reporting and 
communication in this area, as articulated further in 
the TCFD report on pages 46 and 47 and in our 
Sustainability Report 2024.
Testing the Company’s 
strategy and ambitions
•	Include key topics raised by the Board at the strategy 
day in May on the agenda for the forthcoming year. 
•	Continue to constructively challenge the Executive 
Team in order to maintain our focus on driving 
long-term growth.
Standing agenda items and allocation of time to 
topics reviewed.
Executive presentations given at Board meetings 
throughout the year and May strategy day provided 
opportunity for in-depth review and challenge of 
three-year plan and strategic objectives (please see 
page 72 for further information).
78
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Nomination Committee report continued
Overall, the results of the FY24 evaluation were 
very positive, with no major concerns or issues 
raised. High scores continue to reflect a strong 
and positive culture and an effective and 
well-managed Board, notwithstanding the 
changes in its composition during the year. 
The comments are being used to help shape 
the Board agenda and its priorities in FY25. It 
was also confirmed that each Director, including 
the Chair, continues to make an effective 
contribution to the Board, is well-prepared and 
demonstrates commitment to their role. It is 
anticipated that an externally-facilitated 
evaluation will be conducted in FY25.
Committee effectiveness
The effectiveness of the Committee was 
considered as part of this year’s Board evaluation 
process, details of which are set out on the 
previous page. The review concluded that the 
Committee continues to operate effectively and 
having considered the findings, it was agreed 
that the particular areas of focus for the 
forthcoming year should be:
1. Continuing to focus on Executive and senior 
leadership succession plans, both short term 
and longer term;
2. Maintaining the emphasis on diversity and 
inclusion in appointments and succession 
plans and oversight of the impact of 
initiatives; and
3. Appointing a new Non-Executive Director.
Diversity and Inclusion
Policy
Our overriding aim is to ensure that the Board, 
its Committees and the Company comprise 
outstanding people and teams who can lead 
the business effectively in a manner aligned 
to our purpose, shared values and strategy. 
We believe that the Group’s best interests are 
served by ensuring that our people represent 
a range of skills, experiences, backgrounds and 
perspectives. This is encapsulated in our 
’stronger together’ shared value.
To achieve this aim, we remain focused on three 
broad principles:
•	refining the way we recruit;
•	identifying, supporting and mentoring 
existing diverse talent in the business; and
•	increasing diversity amongst senior 
appointments as they are made, including to 
our Board and each of its Committees.
In line with this approach, the Committee is 
committed to ensuring that the Board is at least 
40% female1, that at least one of the Chair, 
Senior Independent Director, CEO and CFO 
positions is held by a woman and at least one 
Board Director is from an ethnically diverse 
background.
In addition, the Committee receives updates on 
our approach to recruitment at all levels of the 
business as part of its oversight of colleague 
policies and practices. It continues to require 
that specific effort is made to bring forward 
diverse candidates for senior leadership and 
Board appointments and monitors the Group’s 
approach to people development to ensure 
that it continues to enable talented individuals, 
regardless of gender, marital status, sexual 
orientation, disability, race, religion, colour, 
nationality, ethnic origin, or age to enjoy career 
progression within Dunelm.
Board
At a Board level, the UK Listing Rules prescribe 
diversity targets. As at 29 June 2024, these were 
met as follows:
Target
Compliance
At least 40% of the 
Board are women.
42% of our Board 
were women.
At least one of the 
senior Board 
positions is held by 
a woman.
Alison Brittain is Chair 
and Karen Witts is 
CFO.
At least one member 
of the Board is from a 
minority ethnic 
background.
Vijay Talwar joined 
the Board in October 
2021 and Ajay Kavan 
joined the Board in 
March 2024.
FY24 Board evaluation findings 
The key themes and outcomes from the Board review were as follows:
Theme
Outcome
Board size and 
composition 
•	Acknowledgement that the Board is going through a period of change.
•	Gender balance is a consideration in light of recent and forthcoming 
changes.
•	Continue to focus on succession plans.
Monitoring of 
culture and 
behaviours
•	Further reflect on how we assess and monitor culture, how our desired 
culture has been embedded and how we will continue to align 
behaviours with our purpose, values and strategy.
Stakeholder 
engagement
•	Ongoing desire for deeper understanding of key stakeholders.
ESG-related risks 
and opportunities
•	Noted to still be a maturing area, with a need to continue to develop and 
maintain clarity of plans and reporting.
Testing the 
Company’s strategy
•	Include key topics raised by the Board at the strategy day in May on the 
agenda for the forthcoming year.
•	Request for deeper understanding of how leveraging technology will 
continue to drive our growth.
1.	
We are extremely mindful that, for the period between Kelly 
Devine stepping down in July 2024 and William Reeve stepping 
down in November 2024, we will briefly fall below this target. 	
79
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Nomination Committee report continued
Group
We have strong representation of women at a 
senior leadership level. As at 29 June 2024, 50% 
of our Executive Team (FY23:62%) and 38% of 
our senior leadership¹ roles (FY23:47%) were 
held by women. 
Dunelm published its seventh Gender Pay report 
in April 2024 and an overview is provided in our 
Sustainability Report 2024. Both documents are 
available to download at corporate.dunelm.com. 
Following the recommendation of the Parker 
Review to set targets for ethnic minority 
representation across senior leadership teams, 
we have set an ethnic diversity target of 8% of 
our senior leadership¹ to achieve by FY27. This 
sits alongside the ethnic diversity target of 8% of 
role-model leaders2 by the end of FY26 that was 
included in last year’s LTIP grant (see page 116 
of the 2023 Annual Report and Account for 
more details). At year-end FY24, ethnic minority 
representation was 2.9% (FY23: 2.6%) for 
senior leadership and 5.5% (FY23: 3.7%) for 
role-model leaders.
FY24 initiatives and progress
The Committee was updated during the year 
on the significant work undertaken in FY24 to 
link our diversity and inclusion aims to initiatives 
within the business and to our values, purpose 
and strategy. This includes raising leadership 
awareness through a series of training and 
development workshops and supporting all 
colleagues more generally in building their 
knowledge and understanding by way of a 
series of learning modules, collecting and 
sharing more data so that we can review and 
track from a pay gap perspective and also 
enable stores to consider the representation 
of their teams versus the local community, to 
further develop understanding and engagement. 
Other key initiatives have included the launch 
of our ‘Reach’ ethnicity talent programme, 
designed to support colleagues from under-
represented ethnic groups as they develop their 
careers at Dunelm and further focus on our 
approach to recruitment. 
SR 	More information on our diversity and 
inclusion initiatives can be found in our 
Sustainability Report 2024
	Our equality and diversity policy can be found 
at: corporate.dunelm.com
1.	
‘Senior leadership’ for these purposes means our Executive 
Team (including Executive Directors) and members of our 
Dunelm leadership team).
2.	
‘Role-model leaders’ is a wider definition than ‘senior 
leadership’ to reflect leadership roles more broadly across our 
colleague base as a national retailer. It includes Heads of roles 
and Regional and Store Coaches.
Annual statement on Board diversity targets 
Our Board and Executive Team gender and ethnicity data is provided below in accordance with UK 
Listing Rule 6.6.6R(9) as at 29 June 2024. Diversity data is collected for Executive Team members via 
the engagement survey. At the end of the financial year the Board were asked to confirm the 
categories with which they identified.
Gender
Dunelm Group plc
Group Board
Executive Team
Number of 
Board 
members
Percentage 
on the Board
Number of 
senior positions 
on the Board 
(CEO, CFO, SID 
and Chair)
Number in 
Executive 
Team
Percentage 
of Executive 
Team
Men
7
58%
2
4
50%
Women
5
42%
2
4
50%
Not specified/prefer not to say
—
—
—
—
—
Ethnicity
Dunelm Group plc
Group Board
Executive Team
Number of 
Board 
members
Percentage 
on the Board
Number of 
senior positions 
on the Board 
(CEO, CFO, SID 
and Chair)
Number in 
Executive 
Team
Percentage 
of Executive 
Team
White British or other white 
(including minority-white 
groups)
10
83%
4
8
100%
Mixed/Multiple ethnic groups 
—
—
—
—
—
Asian/Asian British
2
17%
—
—
—
Black/African/Caribbean/
Black British
—
—
—
—
—
Other ethnic group including 
Arab
—
—
—
—
—
Not specified/prefer not to say
—
—
—
—
—
80
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Audit, risk and 
internal control
Audit and Risk Committee report
On behalf of the Audit and Risk Committee 
(‘Committee’) I am pleased to present the 
Audit and Risk Committee report for the year 
ended 29 June 2024. This report provides an 
overview of the Committee’s main activities 
during FY24, the highlights of which I have set 
out below.
FY24 highlights/key activities
•	Reviewed the financial judgements made 
during the year. 
•	Conducted a review of the Annual Report 
and Accounts to confirm that it was fair, 
balanced and understandable.
•	Continued to monitor the internal controls 
framework and its effectiveness.
•	Approved the FY24 internal audit plan 
and provided oversight of the internal 
audit function.
•	Continued focus on cyber security and 
data protection.
•	Ensured a smooth and effective transition 
to our new external audit partner. 
•	Approved move to co-sourcing 
arrangement for internal audit.
•	Monitored progress and key improvements 
in GHG reporting including the adoption of 
a Scope 3 recalculation policy.
FY25 priorities 
•	Support management’s plans to meet the 
requirements of the Corporate Governance 
Code 2024 and continue to monitor changes 
in regulatory reporting requirements.
•	Continue to provide oversight of integration 
of new controls systems across the Group.
•	Ongoing focus on cyber security and data 
protection.
•	Support the delivery of the FY25 internal audit 
plan in light of the transition to a co-source 
arrangement.
Consideration of significant issues 
and judgements 
The Committee has reviewed and constructively 
challenged the accounting methodologies, 
judgements and disclosures set out in papers 
prepared by management during the year. It 
has determined their appropriateness and 
assessed for consistency, with input from PwC. 
Our review of key judgements and financial 
reporting matters (including inventory 
provisions, store impairment assessments, 
deferred tax and going concern considerations) 
made during the year are described on pages 
83 and 84 of this report.
Reporting and governance
On behalf of the Board, the Committee 
undertook a review of whether the Annual 
Report and Accounts 2024, taken as a whole, 
was fair, balanced and understandable and 
provides the necessary information to 
shareholders to assess the Group’s position 
and performance, business model and strategy. 
This is described in more detail on pages 83 
and 84. 
Looking externally, we maintained a watching 
brief on regulatory and Government 
announcements and updates relating to audit 
and governance reform and discussed the 
impact of the revised Corporate Governance 
Code 2024, most notably for this Committee 
the requirement for an internal controls 
declaration. This will be considered further 
over the forthcoming year.
The Committee undertook a detailed review 
of its schedule of proposed meetings and 
rolling agenda items. This resulted in a new 
cadence this year that we felt provided an 
improved flow to our discussions, particularly 
in relation to internal control and risk reporting.
Sustainability reporting
The Committee has continued to monitor 
the ongoing development of management’s 
approach to sustainability reporting, both in 
respect of current requirements and future 
disclosure obligations such as the UK 
Sustainability Reporting Requirements. The 
Company’s ESG reporting team has refined 
and streamlined our processes in this area, 
providing greater efficiency and clarity of 
reporting for disclosure purposes.
As last year, we can confirm that we are 
reporting on all areas of the TCFD framework. 
The report can be found on pages 46 to 54. 
Ian Bull
Committee membership
Ian Bull (Committee Chair)
Ajay Kavan
William Reeve
Arja Taaveniku
Vijay Talwar
Dan Taylor
	See page 63 for meeting attendance
81
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Audit and Risk Committee report continued
Risk management, internal controls 
and internal audit 
During the year, the Committee received 
regular updates on work to further improve 
and strengthen our risk management 
processes and internal control environment. 
We welcomed the evolution of the Executive-
led Risk and Resilience Committee, which has 
provided clearer accountability and increased 
visibility and challenge on higher risk aspects 
of the Group’s operations for both 
management and the Committee.
	See pages 39 and 86 for more information 
about our Risk and Resilience Committee 
Other Committee highlights have included 
reviewing progress to standardise key finance 
processes as part of our wider finance 
transformation programme, its objective 
being to support current and future business 
growth plans; overseeing implementation 
of governance and controls around our 
regulated credit offer which launched in 
October 2023; and overseeing implementation 
of enhancements to our fraud risk framework 
in response to the new corporate criminal 
offence for failure to prevent fraud. The 
Committee also oversaw the development 
of our programme to monitor internal 
controls over financial reporting and 
considered relevant control observations 
that were identified.
KPMG, who has been the Group’s internal 
auditor since December 2019, delivered the 
FY24 internal audit plan (as approved) in full. 
This included completion of six internal audits 
covering areas such as store audits process, 
risk management and supply chain resilience. 
More details can be found on page 87. 
An important decision for the Committee 
this year, which reflects the extent to which 
the Group’s internal control framework has 
matured, was that we should bring the internal 
audit function in-house in FY25, initially by 
way of a co-source arrangement, with the 
appointment of a head of internal audit.
Engagement
The Committee has been pleased with the 
high level of engagement throughout the year, 
including with senior colleagues, KPMG 
(internal auditor) and PwC (external auditor), 
to ensure our processes and controls remain 
robust. In particular, I have held regular 
meetings with Gill Hinks, our new external 
audit partner at PwC, as well as with our 
KPMG lead internal audit partner.
It has again been a busy year, and I would 
like to take this opportunity to recognise the 
valuable input and support provided by 
members of the Committee, Executive Team 
and senior leadership and thank them for their 
constructive engagement. I would be happy 
to answer any shareholder questions on the 
activities of the Committee at the AGM.
Ian Bull
Chair of the Audit and Risk Committee
11 September 2024
Committee composition and governance 
The Committee comprises solely independent 
Non-Executive Directors, and did so 
throughout FY24. The Board is satisfied that 
they demonstrate a breadth of knowledge 
and experience, including sector expertise, to 
enable the Committee to fulfil its duties. Both 
Ian Bull and Vijay Talwar are considered by the 
Board to have recent and relevant financial 
experience and to be competent in auditing 
and accounting. Ian, who has chaired the 
Committee since joining the Board in 2019, 
is a Fellow of the Chartered Institute of 
Management Accountants with over 30 years’ 
business and financial experience in leading 
consumer-facing businesses. Vijay, who joined 
the Committee in October 2021, is a former 
Certified Public Accountant. 
Only members of the Committee have the 
right to attend meetings. Other Board 
Directors, as well as the Group Finance 
Director, Chief Technology and Information 
Officer, Head of Cyber Security, PwC (external 
audit) and KPMG (internal audit) are invited to 
attend, as appropriate. The Group General 
Counsel and Company Secretary acts as 
secretary to the Committee and attends 
all meetings.
The Committee met four times in FY24. It has 
also met once since the end of the financial 
year prior to the signing of this Annual Report. 
Meetings are generally scheduled in line with 
key times in the Company’s financial reporting 
calendar. The Committee maintains a rolling 
calendar of items for consideration at each 
meeting and reviews and updates it regularly. 
The external auditor and the internal auditor 
are provided with the opportunity at each 
meeting to discuss matters without the 
presence of management and, the Committee 
Chair meets with the external and internal 
audit partners outside of meetings.
Role and principal duties
The Committee’s role is to support the Board 
in fulfilling its corporate governance and 
reporting obligations as to the effectiveness 
of our risk management systems, internal 
controls, and financial reporting. Its principal 
duties include monitoring, reviewing and 
challenging:
•	the integrity of the Group’s financial 
statements and public announcements 
relating to financial performance;
•	key accounting policies and judgements;
•	the effectiveness of internal controls and the 
process for identifying and managing risk;
•	statements concerning internal control, risk 
management (including the assessment of 
principal risks), and the viability statement 
and approving them for inclusion in the 
annual report;
•	the internal audit plan and the role and 
effectiveness of the internal audit function 
and, ensuring its ability to exercise 
independent judgement; and 
•	the relationship with the external auditor, its 
reports, effectiveness and independence.
	The Committee’s full terms of reference can 
be found at: corporate.dunelm.com
82
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Audit and Risk Committee report continued
Key judgements and financial 
reporting matters
An important aspect of the Committee’s work is 
monitoring the integrity of the annual and interim 
reports, including a review of the significant 
financial reporting matters and judgements 
contained in them prior to recommending them 
to the Board for approval. 
Key accounting judgements relating to the 
financial statements considered by the 
Committee during the year under review were:
Provisions for inventory 
The Committee discussed in detail the 
approach taken by management to provisions 
for inventory. Particular attention was given to 
reviewing the provision for obsolete, slow-
moving or discontinued inventories including 
the utilisation of provisions reported in prior 
periods. The external auditor challenged 
management’s assumptions on what they 
deemed to be the ‘at risk’ inventory lines, 
and corroborated this position with the 
commercial team. They also challenged the 
completeness of such lines concluding that the 
relevant provision was consistent with the 
evidence obtained. The Committee noted the 
work undertaken by both management and 
the external auditor, and that there was a high 
degree of consistency in the methodology 
applied by management, with any updated 
inputs based on specific trading experience. 
The Committee concurred with management’s 
conclusions that the values recorded in the 
financial statements are appropriate.
Other accounting matters
The Committee received regular updates on 
management’s assessment of impairment 
triggers as required under IFRS and it was noted 
that only minor charges were appropriate in 
FY24. The Committee also noted that there is 
no material change in deferred tax assets and 
the Group has no uncertain tax provisions.
Going concern and viability statement
The Directors must determine that the 
business has adequate resources to continue 
in operational existence and can continue to 
adopt the ‘going concern’ basis of accounting. 
Furthermore, the Directors are required to make 
a statement in this Annual Report as to the 
longer-term viability of the Company. 
The Committee conducted an assessment 
based on the Group’s current financial position, 
its strategy, the market outlook and its principal 
risks. It also considered the Group’s available 
facilities, including the revolving credit facility, 
which was renegotiated during the year to an 
extended limit of £250m and runs until 
September 2028, subject to a further one-year 
extension. The Committee reviewed financial 
models (including downside scenarios over a 
three-year period and two reverse stress tests), 
taking time to understand and challenge, 
where necessary, significant judgements and 
assumptions in the modelling, the reverse stress 
test models and covenant and liquidity headroom. 
The Committee evaluated management’s 
work in conducting a robust assessment of 
the Company’s longer-term viability. It affirmed 
the reasonableness of the assumptions 
and considered the appropriateness of 
a viability period of three financial years. 
It noted that historically viability has been 
considered over a five-year period, but 
determined that a three-year horizon is 
appropriate, aligning with wider strategic 
plans and the timeframe for performance 
targets. The Committee confirmed this as 
part of its recommendation to the Board.
Further to this, the Directors were able to 
conclude that it is appropriate to prepare the 
financial statements on a going concern basis.
	See page 55 for going concern and viability 
statements
Fair, balanced and understandable
At the request of the Board, the Committee 
considered whether the Annual Report and 
Accounts 2024, taken as a whole, is fair, balanced 
and understandable, and provides the information 
necessary for shareholders to assess the 
Company’s position and performance, business 
model and strategy.
To form its opinion, the Committee reviewed 
the financial statements set out in the 
Company’s annual and interim results and 
reflected on the information and reporting 
received from management and the external 
auditor and the discussions that took place 
during the year. In carrying out its review, the 
Committee had regard to the following: 
Fairness and balance
•	Is the report open and honest with the whole 
story presented and difficulties/challenges 
presented alongside successes/opportunities?
•	Is the review of business performance in 
the narrative reporting consistent with that 
used for the financial reporting in the 
financial statements?
•	Do we provide clear explanations of our 
KPIs and is there strong linkage between 
our KPIs and our strategy? Are the KPIs 
disclosed at an appropriate level based on 
the financial reporting?
•	Do we show our progress over time and is 
there consistency in our metrics, KPIs and 
measurements? 
•	How do the key judgements identified 
compare with the risks that PwC plans to 
include in its report?
Understandable
•	Do we explain our business model, strategy 
and accounting policies simply, using precise 
and clear language? 
•	Do we have a consistent tone across the 
Annual Report & Accounts? 
•	Are the important messages highlighted 
appropriately throughout the document? 
•	Are we clearly ‘signposting’ to where 
additional information can be found? 
•	Is the layout clear with good linkage 
throughout in a manner that reflects the 
whole story?
The Board considered the recommendations 
of the Committee and concluded that, taken 
as a whole, the 2024 Annual Report and 
Accounts is fair, balanced and understandable. 
The Board further believes that the 2024 Annual 
Report and Accounts provides sufficient clarity 
for shareholders to adequately assess our 
business model, strategy, financial position 
and performance.
83
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Audit and Risk Committee report continued
Sustainability reporting
The Committee’s role is to gain assurance that 
the effects and consequences of climate 
change are being adequately reflected in our 
financial statements and valuations, that we are 
applying appropriate standards and rigour 
when reporting progress against our 
Greenhouse Gas (‘GHG’) reduction 
commitments and fulfilling our mandatory 
disclosure obligations.
Throughout FY24 our internal ESG reporting 
team has refined and streamlined our GHG 
Reporting and Task Force on Climate-related 
Financial Disclosures (‘TCFD’) processes. 
This dedicated team supports the various 
sustainability-related workstreams across the 
business and ensures ongoing efficiency and 
clarity of reporting for disclosure purposes. 
We are reporting for FY24 on carbon emissions 
on a ‘spend-based’ basis that is consistent with 
our baseline and are in full compliance with the 
TCFD recommendations. All GHG 
measurement and reporting is in line with the 
GHG Protocol. 
	See pages 46 to 54 for more detailed 
information about TCFD and GHG reporting 
The Committee is aware that as our 
understanding and processes continue to 
evolve, there is a need to enable ongoing data 
consistency and meaningful comparisons. With 
this in mind, during the year, it approved a 
baseline recalculation policy, which guides on 
when and how to recalculate our baseline year 
or update prior year disclosures for Scope 3 
emissions. This was not considered necessary 
for the year under review.
The Committee will continue to monitor the 
Company’s progress against forthcoming 
sustainability-related disclosure requirements, 
such as the UK Sustainability Reporting 
Standards, and consider further developments 
in best practice, seeking training/guidance 
when required, to ensure that it continues to 
effectively oversee our reporting in this area. 
To support the Committee in its oversight 
management has proposed a progressive 
assurance plan around our processes, 
governance and data over our material 
ESG-related measures. 
Corporate and financial reporting 
developments 
The Committee has considered the impact 
of key findings of the FRC’s thematic reviews 
of corporate reporting issued during the year, 
as well as other matters which have come to its 
attention which impact corporate reporting. 
The Committee has also reviewed changes 
to accounting standards and interpretations 
(both those adopted during the year and 
future changes for FY25 and beyond). It is 
comfortable that these have been adopted 
as appropriate and that none have a material 
impact on the Company.
Provision 29 of the revised Corporate 
Governance Code 2024, which requires the 
Board to provide a declaration on the 
effectiveness of material controls, will apply to 
the Company in FY27. In preparation for this 
change, management presented a high-level 
roadmap to the Committee that will be 
discussed in more detail over the forthcoming 
year to ensure that the Group is well-prepared 
to meet the new requirement.
Year end review process
The Committee noted the robust year end governance processes that were performed in parallel with the formal process undertaken by the 
external auditor, as set out below:
Mar 2024
Apr—Aug 2024
Aug 2024
Aug 2024
Jul—Sep 2024
Discussions begin 
with Executive Directors 
on plans, developments 
and key messaging for 
the year. 
Work commences 
with external advisors on 
how best to present 
information in a clear and 
understandable way.
Project management 
undertaken by a team 
including the Group GC 
and Company Secretary, 
Head of FP&A and 
Investor Relations, Director 
of Communications and 
Group Finance Director, 
overseen by the CFO.
Wider team reminded 
of ‘fair, balanced and 
understandable’ 
requirements.
Internal verification 
conducted by the finance 
team of non-financial 
factual statements, key 
performance indicators 
and descriptions used 
within the narrative.
Engagement with, and 
feedback from, external 
parties (including 
remuneration advisors 
and the external auditor) 
to enhance the quality 
of reporting.
Engagement with the 
senior colleagues on 
proposed content and 
changes.
Opportunities for the 
Committee to challenge 
management and the 
external auditor on the 
process and content of 
the report before it is 
recommended to the Board 
for approval.
Process to ensure that any 
unfavourable outcomes 
have been duly highlighted.
84
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Audit and Risk Committee report continued
External auditor
The Committee is responsible for overseeing 
the relationship with the external auditor, 
including recommending to the Board their 
appointment, reappointment and removal, 
assessing their independence on an ongoing 
basis, and approving the statutory audit fees.
Tenure
PwC has been the Group’s external auditor 
since 2014. They were reappointed at the 
Company’s 2023 AGM in respect of the FY24 
audit following a formal tender process. Gill 
Hinks replaced Mark Skedgel as the external 
audit partner following the conclusion of Mark 
Skedgel’s fifth year in FY23 and the 2024 
financial year is therefore her first year as lead 
audit partner. 
The Committee recommended, and the 
Board intends to propose, the reappointment 
of PwC as the Company’s auditor for FY25. 
It believes the independence and objectivity 
of the external auditor and the effectiveness 
of the audit process are safeguarded and 
remain strong.
The Committee considers that the Company 
has complied with the Competition and Markets 
Authority’s Statutory Audit Services for Large 
Companies Market Investigation (Mandatory 
Use of Competitive Tender Processes and 
Audit Committee Responsibilities) Order 2014 
for the financial year under review. There are 
no contractual obligations that restrict the 
Committee’s choice of external auditor.
The external audit
PwC is engaged to express an opinion on the 
financial statements. It reviews the data contained 
in the financial statements, discusses with 
management the reporting of results and the 
financial position of the Company and presents 
its findings to the Committee. Where it makes 
recommendations in its reports to the 
Committee, the Committee reviews them and 
agrees with management the manner and 
extent to which they should be implemented. 
None of the Directors in office at the date of this 
report is aware of any relevant information that 
has not been made available to PwC and each 
Director has taken steps to be aware of all such 
information and to ensure it is available to PwC. 
PwC did not report any significant deficiencies 
in controls nor did it disagree with any of the 
Group’s accounting judgements and estimates 
in relation to FY24. PwC’s audit report is 
published on pages 122 to 127. 
Fees paid to PwC for its FY24 audit work were 
£359,000 (2023: £327,000).
Audit quality and auditor effectiveness
The Committee is responsible for ensuring audit 
quality is maintained, and reviews and challenges 
PwC’s proposed external audit plan, including 
its scope and materiality, before approval.
It is also the Committee’s responsibility to assess 
the effectiveness and independence of the 
external audit process. The assessment is 
conducted in accordance with a process agreed 
with the Committee. It involves seeking the 
views of the Committee, as well as those of 
colleagues who have regular interactions with 
the external auditor and considering them 
alongside five Audit Quality Indicators which 
have been developed with PwC and are 
measured and tracked annually and the FRC’s 
Audit Quality Inspection and Supervision report. 
The Committee was provided with a summary 
of the responses received in respect of the FY23 
audit to assist with its considerations. Feedback 
was positive, consistent with previous years and 
no material concerns were raised. A common 
theme, which was discussed with the external 
audit partner, was continuing to find ways in which 
year end processes can be made even more 
efficient, using technology where appropriate.
Having conducted its review, and also 
considered the quality of interactions during the 
year, the Committee concluded that PwC had 
applied appropriately robust challenge and 
professional scepticism throughout the audit to 
demonstrate independence, that it possessed 
the skills and experience required to fulfil its 
duties effectively and efficiently, and that the 
audit was effective.
The Committee will formally assess PwC’s 
performance in relation to the FY24 audit 
following its completion. The assessment will 
also include a review of the aforementioned Audit 
Quality Indicators to ensure that they remain 
appropriate in assisting the Committee in its 
review of the quality of the audit going forwards.
Safeguarding auditor independence 
and objectivity 
The Committee recognises the importance of 
ensuring that the independence and objectivity 
of the external auditor is not impaired through 
the provision of non-audit services. We have in 
place robust policies on the use of auditors for 
non-audit work and the recruitment of former 
employees of the external auditor, which can be 
found on our website at corporate.dunelm.com. 
These include the following:
•	fees for non-audit services provided by the 
statutory auditor in any year may not exceed 
70% of the average fees for the Group 
statutory audit in the three previous years;
•	the auditor is prohibited from providing 
certain non-audit services as set out in our 
policy, including almost all tax work, internal 
audit, corporate finance, and those that 
involve any part in management activities;
•	the external auditor may not be engaged to 
provide any non-audit services without the 
approval of the Committee; and 
•	time restrictions on employees of the 
external auditor involved in our audit joining 
the Company.
During the period we paid PwC £50,000 (2023: 
£46,000) for their review of the interim financial 
statements (a non-audit service). This was 
12.22% of the total audit fees, and the three-year 
average is 12.26%. No other non-audit services 
were provided by the external auditor.
The Committee can confirm that the policies 
referred to above were complied with 
throughout the year and, in its opinion, the 
external auditor remains independent. 
85
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Audit and Risk Committee report continued
Risk management and internal controls
Risk management
Whilst the Board has overall responsibility for risk 
management, it delegates to the Committee 
responsibility for assessing the effectiveness of 
systems to identify, assess, manage and monitor 
financial and non-financial risks.
During the year, the Committee undertook 
the following risk management and assurance 
activities, which enabled it to maintain oversight 
and discuss risks and challenges faced by 
the Company:
•	reviewed principal risks and the Company’s 
formal risk appetite statement ahead of 
submission to the Board for approval (for 
more information see pages 38 to 45);
•	considered and challenged management’s 
key risk indicators to ensure that they remain 
appropriate and monitored performance 
against them;
•	received regular reports and updates from 
the CFO as chair of the Risk and Resilience 
Committee on its activities and on any specific 
matters that impacted internal controls 
(more information on our Risk and Resilience 
Committee can be found on the right);
•	received reports from management on 
developments and improvements to the 
control environment during the year, 
including details of an enhanced monitoring 
and testing programme for internal controls 
over financial reporting;
•	reviewed internal and external audit 
reports and progress on delivering 
management actions;
•	received updates on data protection, 
anti-bribery, material litigation and 
business continuity;
•	approved the annual fraud risk assessment 
and considered improvements to fraud 
monitoring and the actions taken by 
management to mitigate (including 
consideration of processes management has 
in place in readiness for the new corporate 
criminal offence of failing to prevent fraud, 
which comes into effect at the end of 2024);
•	approved a co-source model for internal audit;
•	approved a refreshed Whistleblowing policy 
and procedure (see page 68 for more 
information about our Whistleblowing policy);
•	discussed the governance framework and 
controls established ahead of the launch of 
our regulated credit offer;
•	considered the output from a Business Risk 
Review conducted by HMRC, the outcome of 
which aligned to our risk appetite; and 
•	noted that a satisfactory insurance 
programme is in place.
In addition, there was continued focus on 
IT systems and cyber security by way of 
presentations to the Committee from the Chief 
Technology and Information Officer and Head 
of Cyber Security. During the year a maturity 
review was undertaken to assess our cyber 
controls against ISO27001. It found that 
management has made significant progress in 
enhancing controls, with several areas of good 
practice identified alongside opportunities for 
further improvement. The Committee welcomes 
the ongoing work in this area, recognising that 
our approach to mitigation must continue to 
evolve at pace in line with the risk.
The Committee considers that the processes 
in place to manage risk by the Board and 
management are robust and working effectively.
Internal control framework
Management is responsible for establishing 
and maintaining an effective system of internal 
controls and the Committee has responsibility 
for ensuring the effectiveness of those controls. 
The Group has established internal controls 
and risk management systems in relation to the 
process for preparing consolidated financial 
statements. Examples of the controls in 
operation include regular balance sheet 
reconciliations, monthly analysis and reviews, 
technical accounting papers and review and 
approval of externally reported financial 
information. A status update on the monitoring 
programme for internal controls over financial 
reporting is provided on a regular basis to the 
Committee. The Committee is satisfied as to the 
effectiveness of these controls.
We continue to invest in the modernisation of 
our key business systems to ensure that we have 
the right foundations in place to support our 
ambitious strategic growth plans and the 
Committee continues to monitor progress. 
Risk and Resilience Committee
During FY24, management conducted 
a review of the structure and role of the 
Risk and Resilience Committee (‘R&R 
Committee’), chaired by the CFO, to critically 
assess the effectiveness of its format and 
composition. As a result of this work, the R&R 
Committee has evolved its membership and 
scope to ensure balanced representation 
from all key functional areas, with clearer 
ownership and accountability across 
operational as well as principal risks. This has 
enabled greater visibility, stronger governance 
and increased challenge on higher risk 
aspects of the Group’s operations, with 
regular updates provided on:
•	data protection and information security;
•	regulated credit;
•	health and safety;
•	ethical sourcing;
•	store security;
•	business conduct (including fraud); and
•	outstanding internal audit actions.
The Audit and Risk Committee receives 
regular updates on the R&R Committee’s 
activities and is informed of any material 
issues or concerns. As part of our continued 
focus on improving our control environment, 
we will assess the effectiveness of the new 
format after twelve months.
	See pages 38 to 39 for more information 
about our approach to risk management
86
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Audit and Risk Committee report continued
Internal audits
The internal audit function provides 
independent and objective assurance to all 
levels of management up to the Board. Its 
responsibilities include evaluating and reporting 
on the adequacy and effectiveness of the 
systems of risk management and internal 
controls. The function has been outsourced 
to KPMG since December 2019.
KPMG’s purpose, scope and authority are 
defined within its charter which is approved by 
the Committee annually. The team develops an 
internal audit plan for the year, with input from 
management, that is structured to align with 
the Group’s strategic priorities and key risks and 
is approved by the Committee. The plan is 
reviewed periodically throughout the year to 
confirm it remains relevant. 
Each review concludes with a formal report 
with graded recommendations, management 
responses and actions. These are communicated 
to the Committee by KPMG, and rigorously 
tracked through to completion. The Committee 
as a whole and the Committee Chair each meet 
with KPMG without management present on 
a regular basis to allow for open discussion.
During the year, the Committee carried out a 
review of the effectiveness of the internal audit 
function. This was undertaken by way of a 
questionnaire, and feedback was sought from 
members of the Committee and the senior 
leadership team. The Committee concluded 
that overall the function continues to operate 
effectively, with areas noted for further 
consideration being greater collaboration with 
management around the timing of audits and 
ways to improve communication of progress 
during audits and in presenting findings.
Committee effectiveness
The effectiveness of the Committee was 
considered as part of this year’s Board 
evaluation process, more details of which can 
be found on page 78. The review concluded 
that the Committee continues to operate 
effectively and having considered the findings, 
the following actions were agreed for the 
forthcoming year: 
1.	continue to engage with the external lead 
audit partner and find ways in which year-end 
processes can be made even more efficient;
2.	manage and support the internal audit 
transition to a co-sourcing arrangement; and
3.	maintain focus on non-financial disclosures, 
key performance indicators and assurance in 
light of regulatory changes.
Internal audits undertaken in FY24
KPMG conducted the following risk-based internal audits in FY24:
Internal audits
Overview of scope
Stores audit process
Evaluated the design and effectiveness of processes in place 
to manage the delivery of the stores audit programme.
Risk management
Assessed the maturity of our strategic/enterprise risk 
management processes.
Order to cash
Assessed the design and effectiveness of controls over the 
end-to-end order-to-cash process across our main revenue 
streams, including in-store and online sales. This audit also 
considered the new complaints process for regulated credit. 
Review of ESG processes: 
phase 21 
Considered processes, controls, and governance relating to 
methodology, data collection, and reporting on Scope 3 
emissions.
Cloud controls: phase 1 and 2
Assessed the effectiveness of controls relating to the 
management of our cloud services, including third-party 
service partners, to provide a risk-based assessment of cloud 
maturity capabilities.
Supply chain resilience
Assessed the risks relating to IT and operational service 
providers, specifically in respect of vendor resilience, 
dependency and data management.
1.	
Phase 1 was completed in FY23.
During the year, the Committee reviewed our 
approach to internal audit and the outsourced 
model, reflecting on how the business has 
changed since 2019, and noting in particular 
its growth, the increased maturity of our internal 
control framework and the potential future 
needs of the business. It concluded that a 
move to a co-sourced arrangement would 
deliver increased capacity to enable higher 
levels of assurance going forwards. 
The internal audit function will transition to 
this new model from the beginning of FY25, 
following the appointment of a head of internal 
audit. This role reports to the Chair of the Audit 
and Risk Committee to ensure independence, 
with a dotted line to the CFO. 
87
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Remuneration at a glance
Remuneration principles
Our remuneration principles guide our approach 
to reward, ensuring that it remains aligned with 
our vision, values and purpose, and clearly linked to 
the successful delivery of our strategic plans, as we 
seek to unlock our full potential.
Pay fairly for an 
individual’s role and 
responsibilities
Aligned to shared 
values and ownership 
structure
Rewards strong 
performance and 
sustainable growth 
over the long term
Enshrined in 
Remuneration Policy
Summary of Executive Remuneration Structure under 2023 Policy
Base Pay
•	Median or below
Pension
•	Aligned to workforce 
average
Benefits
•	Median
Variable pay — annual cash 
bonus and LTIP
•	Maximum opportunity 375% 
for CEO and 325% for CFO
Annual cash bonus
•	Median
•	Up to 150% of salary*
•	Linked to performance: 
sales, profit, strategic/
personal
•	Clawback and malus apply
*	
Subject to maximum variable pay 
opportunity.
Lifetime lock-in
•	Two-thirds of bonus and 
LTIP outcome retained in 
shares for the duration of 
employment
Shareholding requirements
•	During employment retain 
shares worth maximum LTIP 
opportunity
•	Two-year post-employment 
holding requirement
Simple and transparent
Consistently applied 
throughout business
LTIP
•	Upper quartile
•	Up to 250% of salary*
•	Three-year performance 
period
•	Two-year retention period
•	Mix of performance 
conditions
•	Clawback and malus apply
88
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Remuneration
Remuneration Committee report
FY24 business performance and incentive 
outcomes 
Our Executive Team performed well throughout 
the year, delivering a solid performance in what 
remains a challenging environment for UK 
consumers and businesses, and resulting in sales 
of £1,706.5m, and profit before tax of £205.4m. 
The Committee’s decision-making on the 
remuneration outcome for our Executive 
Directors has been shaped by this year’s financial 
performance, as well as recognition of the 
opportunities and challenges for our business 
that lie ahead. We remain committed to ensuring 
that we reward sustainable, profitable growth 
over the longer term on a consistent basis and 
aligned with our shared values.
The overall formulaic vesting level for the FY24 
annual bonus is 36% of maximum opportunity 
for Nick Wilkinson and 37% of maximum 
opportunity for Karen Witts. Full details of 
performance against FY24 measures and 
objectives are set out on pages 103 and 104. 
Nick Wilkinson was granted an LTIP award in 
October 2021 with vesting subject to 
performance conditions assessed over the 
three-year period FY22 to FY24. Karen Witts 
was granted an award in June 2022 that was 
subject to the same performance conditions 
assessed over the same three-year period, but 
pro-rated to reflect her joining date. These 
awards have vested at 58% as set out on 
page 105. 
The Committee considered whether to use its 
discretion to adjust either the bonus outcomes 
or the LTIP award outcome. We concluded 
that the outcomes of the annual bonus and 
LTIP were fair and well-deserved and reflect 
both the performance of the business and the 
overall stakeholder experience, including the 
wider workforce, and therefore no discretion 
should be applied. 
At least two-thirds of Nick and Karen’s 
respective cash bonuses (after payment of 
tax and National Insurance contributions) 
must be invested in shares and retained in 
accordance with our in- and post-employment 
shareholding guidelines. Two-thirds of their 
vesting LTIP awards (after payment of tax 
and National Insurance contributions) must 
similarly be retained, and they are, in any 
event, subject to a two-year hold on the 
full amount.
FY25 remuneration
Our review of salaries for Executive Directors 
in FY24 and intended operation of the new 
Policy for the financial year ending 28 June 
2025 is as follows:
Salary
When considering salary increases, the 
Committee was mindful of Director 
performance, our remuneration principles as 
set out on page 88 and the wider colleague 
experience. We also considered feedback on 
William Reeve
Committee membership
William Reeve (Committee Chair)
Alison Brittain
Ian Bull
Ajay Kavan
Arja Taaveniku
Vijay Talwar
Dan Taylor
	See page 63 for meeting attendance
On behalf of the Remuneration Committee 
(‘Committee’) I am pleased to present the 
Remuneration Committee report for the year 
ended 29 June 2024. This comprises:
•	my Annual Statement as Chair of the 
Committee (pages 89 to 90);
•	the Directors’ Remuneration Policy (‘Policy’) 
approved at the 2023 AGM (pages 91 to 
100); and
•	the Annual Report on Remuneration (pages 
101 to 115), describing how the Policy has 
been applied for the year ended 29 June 
2024 and how we intend to implement the 
Policy for FY25. 
The Remuneration Committee report 
(excluding the Policy) will be subject to an 
advisory shareholder vote at the 2024 AGM. 
FY24 highlights/key activities
•	Reviewed variable pay outcomes.
•	Approved revised measures for LTIP grant 
and bonus.
•	Approved gender pay gap report for 
publication.
FY25 priorities 
•	Ensure smooth transition to our new 
Remuneration Committee Chair.
•	Review measures proposed for FY25 bonus 
and LTIP grant.
•	Continue to consider the evolution of our 
reward structure in line with our principles.
89
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Remuneration Committee report continued
Executive pay received from our National 
Colleague Voice. Further to this, we reviewed 
the salary levels of the Executive Directors and 
approved a 2.75% increase in base salary for 
each of Nick Wilkinson and Karen Witts in line 
with the average percentage increase for 
senior colleagues. The median pay award 
made to the wider colleague population 
was 6.9%. 
Variable pay/incentives
We apply a consistent pay structure 
throughout the business, with the 
remuneration of Executive Directors more 
heavily weighted towards variable pay and 
share-based incentives than other colleagues 
so that a greater part of their pay is linked to 
successful delivery of strategy and aligned 
with shareholders. 
A significant change to our approach for FY25 
has been to the measures that we will be 
applying to the annual bonus and the LTIP.
In prior years, performance conditions for the 
annual bonus have been based on financial 
measures (with a 75% weighting) and strategic 
and personal targets (with a 25% weighting), 
with the LTIP based on an EPS measure 
(with an 80% weighting) and ESG measures 
(with a 20% weighting). We have changed our 
approach for FY25. 
Our use of ESG measures for the LTIP over 
the last three LTIP cycles has been positive for 
Dunelm, and we have benefitted from the 
resultant step change. However, we have 
become increasingly aware of the challenges 
arising from the rebasing and restating of ESG 
measures as understanding and capability to 
measure progress has evolved. The Committee 
has also recognised the extent to which ESG is 
now embedded in the business, meaning that 
we can continue to drive Dunelm’s sustainability 
strategy more effectively by way of annual 
targets within bonus objectives, rather than over 
a three-year period. Therefore, for FY25, ESG 
measures will be moved from the LTIP to the 
annual bonus, with a 10% weighting allocated 
to specific ESG targets. 
We have decided to replace the ESG measures 
in the LTIP with a measure based on Total 
Shareholder Return (‘TSR’). The introduction 
of a TSR-based measure follows discussions 
with some of our investors and a detailed review 
by the Committee as to the appropriateness of 
this measure for Dunelm. The Committee 
recognises that a TSR-based measure will 
maintain the alignment of the Executive Directors’ 
interests with those of shareholders, by providing 
a direct link to share price performance and 
dividends paid. The Committee considers that 
returns to shareholders as reflected by a 
TSR-based measure will align with Dunelm’s 
longer-term prospects, and reward long-term 
thinking. The TSR-based measure will be 
assessed on a relative basis against the 
constituents of the FTSE 350 excluding financial 
services companies and investment trusts.
The weightings of the measures are summarised 
below (with a small re-weighting of the EPS 
measure for the LTIP which is reduced from 
80% to 75%), with further information on the 
measures and targets set out on page 113. For 
the EPS measure, which accounts for three-
quarters of the overall LTIP award, for delivery of 
threshold performance the vesting level will be 
10%. In line with the Policy approved by 
shareholders at the 2023 AGM and in line with 
market practice, vesting in respect of the TSR 
element (accounting for one quarter of the 
overall award) will be 25%, and will require 
median performance, with maximum vesting 
requiring upper quartile performance.
Annual bonus
Measure
Weighting
PBT
50%
Sales
25%
Strategic and personal targets 
(including ESG measures)
25%
LTIP
Measure
Weighting
EPS
75%
Relative TSR
25%
The targets for the LTIP award expected to be 
made in October 2024 are set out on page 113. 
Two-thirds of variable pay will continue to be 
invested in Dunelm shares, to be held for the 
duration of employment.
Non-Executive fees
It is the responsibility of the Board to review 
Non-Executive Director fees, and the 
responsibility of this Committee to review 
Chair fees. The Board considered the former 
at its meeting in June 2024, having conducted 
a detailed benchmarking exercise and 
reflected on the role and contribution of our 
Directors, as well as our remuneration 
principles. The Board determined that fees 
for the Non-Executive Directors had fallen 
some way behind the market and our own 
remuneration principles and approved 
increases as set out on page 114. In relation to 
our Chair’s fee, the Committee recommended 
an increase of 2.75% (in line with the average 
percentage increase for senior colleagues and 
below the median pay award made to the 
wider colleague population of 6.9%) which 
was approved by the Board.
Finally, I will be stepping down on 
21 November 2024 following completion of 
our 2024 AGM, having completed just over 
nine years on the Board. The Company 
confirmed on 11 July 2024 that Ajay Kavan will 
be replacing me as Chair of this Committee 
with effect from the end of the 2024 AGM. 
I wish him every success in the role and, noting 
that this is my final Remuneration Committee 
report, would like to take this opportunity to 
thank my fellow Directors for their support and 
that of the Executive Team, senior leadership 
and all other colleagues with whom I have had 
the pleasure of engaging during my tenure. 
William Reeve
Chair of the Remuneration Committee
11 September 2024 
90
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Remuneration Committee report continued
Our current binding Remuneration Policy was approved by shareholders at the Annual General Meeting on 16 November 2023 with over 99% of votes in favour. We remain confident that it aligns with our 
strategic goals, investor sentiment and market practice, as well as our shared values, which include ‘long-term thinking’ and to ‘act like owners’, in keeping with the family origin of the business. 
The Committee has ensured that the Policy and practices are consistent with the factors set out in Provision 40 of the UK Corporate Governance Code:
Clarity and Simplicity
Predictability
•	We operate a simple, sustainable, and transparent remuneration structure. 
•	Performance targets for variable pay are linked to our strategy.
•	Performance requirements are clearly disclosed and transparent and we provide detailed 
disclosures of the relevant performance assessments and outcomes for our stakeholders 
to consider.
•	Engagement is welcomed from stakeholders throughout the year.
•	A National Colleague Voice meeting (see pages 22 and 115) is dedicated to providing clarity 
to colleagues and inviting discussion on our approach to executive pay.
•	The remuneration scenarios for Executive Directors on page 97 indicate the potential values that 
may be earned through the remuneration structure.
•	Where discretion may be exercised, this is clearly stated in the Policy.
Risk
Proportionality
•	The Committee is comfortable that the Company’s incentive arrangements do not encourage 
inappropriate risk-taking.
•	Our Policy includes (i) balanced use of short- and long-term incentives, (ii) the ability for the 
Committee to apply discretion and judgement to outcomes, (iii) malus and clawback provisions, 
and (iv) the majority of the variable remuneration of the Executive Directors is paid in shares which 
are subject to in-employment and post-employment shareholding requirements.
•	Our variable pay arrangements include the ability on the part of the Committee to adjust 
formulaic vesting outturns so that vesting levels can be aligned with overall performance.
•	Shareholding requirements apply both during and after employment to promote alignment with 
the longer-term interests of shareholders and longer-term performance.
•	Variable pay arrangements include malus and clawback provisions.
•	Our Policy is drafted with clear consideration of the need to ensure that total remuneration fairly 
reflects performance and enables meaningful and appropriate targets to be set with a significant 
proportion linked to long-term shareholder value.
•	A significant proportion of the Executive Directors’ remuneration is subject to performance 
conditions and awarded in shares to ensure alignment with shareholders’ interests.
Alignment to culture
•	The Committee ensures that our incentive structure drives the right behaviours and reinforces the Group’s purpose and shared values. 
•	Alignment is reflected in the approach to performance measures used in our incentive schemes, for example (i) financial targets under the annual bonus and LTIP are the same for all management, 
regardless of seniority, linking everyone’s contribution to a shared Group financial outcome; (ii) strategic targets require our Executive Directors and senior leadership to work together to deliver growth 
and value to the benefit of our stakeholders; and (iii) non-financial performance measures continue to focus on ensuring that participants ‘do the right thing’, including delivery of our sustainability strategy.
Directors’ Remuneration Policy 2024
91
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Remuneration Committee report continued
The Policy sets out the structure of remuneration for Directors of the Company. It was approved by 
shareholders at the 2023 AGM and is set out in full on pages 92 to 100 of this Report. The illustrative 
performance scenarios on page 97 have been updated to reflect the proposed implementation 
of the Policy in FY25 as set out on pages 112 to 114 and other changes have been made to reflect 
elements of Karen Witts’ recruitment remuneration that are no longer relevant. Sir Will Adderley has 
requested that he not be considered for participation in the annual bonus or LTIP. 
The full Policy can also be found on our corporate website: corporate.dunelm.com.
Executive Directors
Base Salary
Purpose and link to strategic 
objectives
•	Fixed remuneration for the role.
•	To attract and retain the high calibre talent necessary to 
develop and deliver the business strategy.
•	Reflects the size and scope of the Executive Director’s 
responsibilities.
Operation
•	Normally paid monthly.
•	Base level set in the context of:
	
— Pay for similar roles in companies of similar size and 
complexity in the relevant market. 
	
— Scale and complexity of the role.
•	Should comprise a minority of potential remuneration.
Maximum opportunity 
•	Reviewed annually, with percentage increases usually in line 
with or below the Group-wide review unless other 
circumstances apply, such as:
	
— A significant change in the size, scale or complexity of the role 
or of the Group’s business.
	
— Development and performance in role (for example, on a 
new appointment, base salary might be initially set at a lower 
level with the intention of increasing over time).
•	The Committee does not consider it to be appropriate to set a 
monetary limit on the maximum base salary that may be paid 
to an Executive Director within the terms of this Policy.
Performance metrics
•	None, although performance of the individual is considered 
at the annual salary review.
Retirement benefits 
Purpose and link to strategic 
objectives 
•	To provide a competitive post-retirement benefit.
•	To attract and retain the high calibre talent necessary to 
develop and deliver the business strategy.
Operation
•	Contribution to a defined contribution plan or a cash allowance 
in respect of some or all of the contribution that would 
otherwise be made to a pension plan.
Maximum opportunity 
•	An amount as a percentage of base salary not exceeding the 
maximum rate available to the majority of the wider workforce 
(currently 3%).
Performance metrics
•	None.
Benefits 
Purpose and link to strategic 
objectives 
•	To provide a competitive benefits package.
•	To attract and retain the high calibre talent necessary to 
develop and deliver the business strategy.
Operation
•	A range of benefits are provided which may include car or 
allowance; private health insurance for the individual and their 
family; permanent health cover; life assurance; mobile phone; 
use of a car and driver in connection with the role or an 
appropriate travel allowance; and colleague discount.
•	Additional benefits, such as relocation expenses, housing 
allowance and school fees may also be provided in certain 
circumstances if considered reasonable and appropriate by 
the Committee.
•	For non-UK Executives (none at present) the Committee 
may consider additional allowances in accordance with 
standard practice. 
Maximum opportunity 
•	The Committee reserves the right to provide such benefits as 
it considers necessary to support the strategy of the Group.
•	The Committee does not consider it to be appropriate to set 
a maximum cost to the Group of benefits to be paid. 
Performance metrics
•	None.
The policy report 
92
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Remuneration Committee report continued
Executive Directors continued
Bonus
Purpose and link to strategic 
objectives 
•	Rewards and incentivises delivery of annual financial, strategic 
and personal targets.
Operation
•	The amount of the bonus earned is determined after the 
results for the financial year have been audited, subject to 
performance targets having been met. The Committee has 
discretion to adjust the bonus payout upwards or downwards 
if it considers that the formulaic outturn does not reflect its 
assessment of the overall financial or non-financial performance 
of the participant or the Group, or is inappropriate in the context 
of circumstances that were unexpected or unforeseen at the 
start of the relevant year, or is inappropriate for any other reason.
•	At least two-thirds of any bonus earned will be either subject to 
a requirement that the after-tax amount is invested in Dunelm 
shares or will be granted in the form of a share bonus award 
on a pre-tax basis. Any shares acquired pursuant to such a 
requirement are subject to retention provisions as set out in 
the ’Shareholding requirements’ section below.
Maximum opportunity 
•	Maximum opportunity: 150% of base salary per annum.
•	The combined annual bonus and LTIP opportunities for any 
year may not exceed: (a) 375% of salary in the case of the 
Company’s CEO; and (b) 325% of salary in the case of any other 
Executive Director.
•	Where bonus awards are granted as share awards, dividend 
accruals may be made in respect of dividends paid during the 
vesting period applicable to an award. Any such dividend 
equivalents will ordinarily be paid in shares.
Performance metrics
•	Stretching performance targets are set each year. Performance 
targets for the Executive Directors may be based on financial 
objectives and/or strategic objectives and/or personal goals set 
by the Committee annually.
•	Financial objectives may include, but are not limited to, 
budgeted PBT for the financial year.
•	The strategic objectives will vary depending on the specific 
business priorities in a particular year.
•	The Committee will determine the weighting of performance 
measures for any year based on specific business priorities for 
the year. Ordinarily, at least 50% of the annual bonus for 
Executive Directors will be subject to financial objectives.
•	Subject to the Committee’s discretion to override formulaic 
outturns, for financial measures typically up to 10% of the 
maximum opportunity will be earned for threshold performance, 
and for on-target performance up to 50% of the maximum 
opportunity will be earned, and for exceeding on-target 
performance up to 100% of the maximum opportunity will be 
earned. Bonuses will typically be earned between threshold 
and on-target and between on-target and maximum on a 
straight-line basis.
•	For strategic measures and personal goals, vesting of the 
bonus will be determined by the Committee between 0% and 
100% based on its assessment of the extent to which the 
relevant metrics or objectives have been met.
•	Awards are subject to recovery provisions (malus and clawback) 
as set out below.
93
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Remuneration Committee report continued
Executive Directors continued
Long-Term Incentive Plan
Purpose and link to strategic 
objectives 
•	Supports delivery of strategy by requiring the achievement of 
appropriate targets and objectives which will normally include 
a measure based on EPS.
•	Rewards strong financial performance and sustained increase 
in shareholder value over the long term.
•	Aligns with shareholder interests through the delivery of shares, 
with share retention requirements as set out below.
Operation
•	Awards (which can take the form of a conditional award, nil-cost 
option or nominal value option) are made annually, with vesting 
subject to performance, usually assessed following the end of a 
performance period of three years, followed by a ‘Holding 
Period’ of two years. The Holding Period may operate on the 
basis of: (i) the award vesting following assessment of 
performance but that, other than as regards sales of shares to 
cover tax liabilities, shares acquired must be retained until the 
end of the Holding Period; or (ii) vesting being deferred until 
the end of the Holding Period.
•	Shares acquired are then subject to retention provisions as set 
out in the ’Shareholding requirements’ section below.
•	The Committee has discretion to adjust the LTIP vesting outturn 
upwards or downwards if it considers that the formulaic output 
does not reflect its assessment of the overall financial or 
non-financial performance of the participant or the Group, 
or is inappropriate in the context of circumstances that were 
unexpected or unforeseen at grant, or is inappropriate for any 
other reason.
Maximum opportunity 
•	The maximum award for an Executive Director in respect of any 
financial year is an award over shares with a value (as 
determined by the Committee) of 250% of salary.
•	The combined annual bonus and LTIP opportunities for any 
year may not exceed: (i) 375% of salary in the case of the 
Company’s CEO; and (ii) 325% of salary in the case of any other 
Executive Director.
•	Dividend accruals may be made in respect of dividends paid 
during the performance period applicable to an award and up 
to the vesting date. Payment would only be made in respect of 
shares vesting after applying performance criteria. Any such 
dividend equivalents will ordinarily be paid in shares.
Performance metrics
•	The Committee will determine the weighting of performance 
measures for any year. For at least 75% of an award, vesting will 
be subject to the satisfaction of one or more financial measures, 
which will normally include a measure based on EPS. The balance 
of the award vesting will be subject to one or more other financial, 
strategic, environmental, social or governance measures.
•	The Committee considers the targets annually taking into 
account a range of factors which will include the Group’s plans, 
external forecasts and the overall business environment.
•	Subject to the Committee’s discretion to override formulaic 
outturns, for financial measures typically up to 10% of an award 
will vest for threshold performance (the lowest level of 
performance at which awards will vest), rising to up to 50% for 
achieving a stretching level of ‘on-target’ performance and to 
100% for achieving or exceeding a stretch level of performance. 
Vesting between threshold and on target and between 
on-target and maximum will typically be on a straight-line basis.
•	For strategic, environmental, social or governance measures, 
vesting will be determined by the Committee between 0% and 
100% based on its assessment of the extent to which the 
relevant measures have been met.
•	Awards are subject to recovery provisions (malus and clawback) 
as set out below.
94
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Remuneration Committee report continued
Executive Directors continued
All employee share plan (Sharesave) 
Purpose and link to strategic 
objectives 
•	Promotes share ownership by all eligible colleagues (including 
Executive Directors).
Operation
•	All UK employees with a minimum service requirement are 
eligible to join the UK tax qualifying Dunelm Group Savings 
Related Share Option Plan (the Sharesave). Employees outside 
the UK are eligible to join an equivalent plan which is not 
tax qualifying.
•	Monthly savings are made over a period of three years (or such 
other period as may be permitted by the applicable UK tax 
legislation) linked to the grant of an option over Dunelm shares 
at a discount of up to 20% to the market price (or such other 
amount as permitted by the applicable UK tax legislation) at the 
date of invitation to join the plan.
•	Invitations are normally issued annually at the discretion of the 
Committee, which also has discretion to set the minimum 
service requirement, maximum discount, maximum monthly 
savings and any other limits within the terms of the plan rules.
Maximum opportunity 
•	Maximum participation limits reflect the limits prescribed by 
the applicable UK tax legislation from time to time. Currently 
the maximum limit is savings of £500 per month.
Performance metrics
•	None.
Shareholding requirements 
To align the interests of Executive Directors with 
those of shareholders and to promote long-
term thinking, the Committee has adopted 
shareholding requirements which apply both 
during employment and for a period following 
employment, as set out below. The Committee 
retains the right to waive or relax the retention 
requirements in respect of shares acquired 
pursuant to annual bonus deferral arrangements 
or following the end of the Holding Period 
applying to any LTIP award granted after 1 July 
2020 if the Executive Director meets the required 
level of shareholding during employment. 
The Committee also retains the right to waive 
or relax any element of the shareholding 
requirements in exceptional circumstances, 
such as death, divorce, ill health or severe 
financial hardship.
Shareholding requirements during 
employment
•	Executive Directors are expected to make a 
personal investment in Dunelm shares on 
appointment as an Executive Director (subject 
to closed periods).
•	Each Executive Director is required to build a 
beneficial holding of shares with a value (as a 
percentage of salary) equal to the higher of: 
(i) their normal annual LTIP grant; and (ii) 200% 
of salary. Executive Directors are ordinarily 
expected to achieve this holding within five 
years from appointment. Shares subject to: 
(i) LTIP awards which are exercisable but which 
have not been exercised; (ii) LTIP awards for 
which the performance assessment has been 
carried out but for which vesting is deferred 
until the end of the Holding Period; and 
(iii) share bonus awards, count towards this 
requirement on a net of assumed tax basis.
•	Any shares acquired pursuant to required 
annual bonus deferral arrangements must be 
retained during employment, other than any 
shares sold to cover associated tax liabilities. 
•	Following the end of the Holding Period 
applying to any LTIP award granted after 
1 July 2020, an Executive Director must retain 
at least two-thirds of the shares acquired, 
other than any shares sold to cover associated 
tax liabilities.
Shareholding requirements following 
termination of employment
Following termination of their employment for 
any reason, an Executive Director must retain 
for two years shares equal to the lower of the 
shareholding requirement applicable to them 
during employment, and their actual 
shareholding on departure. This is a contractual 
requirement set out in each Director’s service 
contract. The Company also reserves the right 
to require share certificates to be lodged in 
its custody.
Payment of fixed remuneration in shares 
The Company may deliver any element of fixed 
remuneration for an Executive Director in shares 
rather than in cash or any other form in which 
it is usually provided. The number of shares 
would be such number as have a value at the 
relevant time equal to the value of the fixed 
remuneration being delivered in shares.
95
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Remuneration Committee report continued
Recovery provisions (malus and clawback)
The annual bonus (including any granted as a 
share award) and LTIP are subject to recovery 
provisions as set out below.
Malus provisions apply which enable the 
Committee to determine before the payment of 
an annual bonus or the vesting of an LTIP award, 
that the bonus opportunity or LTIP award may 
be cancelled or reduced.
Clawback provisions apply which enable the 
Committee to determine for up to three years 
following the payment of a cash bonus or the 
assessment of the performance outturn for an 
LTIP award, that the amount of the bonus paid 
may be recovered and the LTIP or share bonus 
award may be cancelled or reduced (if it has 
not been exercised) or recovery may be applied 
to it (if it has been exercised).
The malus and clawback provisions may be 
applied in the event of:
•	a material misstatement of any Group 
company’s financial results;
•	a material error in assessing a performance 
condition applicable to the award or in the 
information or assumptions on which the 
award was granted or vests;
•	a material failure of risk management in any 
Group company or a relevant business unit;
•	serious reputational damage to any Group 
company or a relevant business unit;
•	serious misconduct or material error on the 
part of the participant;
•	a material corporate failure as determined by 
the Board;
•	fraud; or
•	any other circumstances which the Committee 
in its discretion considers to be similar in their 
nature or effect to those set out above.
Salary, pension, benefits and Sharesave options 
are not subject to recovery.
Non-Executive Directors 
Fees and appropriate benefits
Purpose and link to strategic 
objectives 
•	To attract and retain a high calibre Chair and Non-Executive 
Directors by offering competitive fee levels and, where relevant, 
appropriate benefits.
Operation
•	Fees for the Chair are set by the Committee. Fees for 
Non-Executive Directors are set by the Board. No Director 
participates in any decision relating to their own remuneration.
•	The Chair is paid an all-inclusive fee for all Board 
responsibilities. The Non-Executive Directors receive a 
basic fee, with supplemental fees for additional Board 
responsibilities.
•	The level of fee reflects the size and complexity of the role and 
the time commitment.
•	Fees are normally reviewed annually, having regard to a range 
of factors, including increases in remuneration across the 
Group. In addition, a periodic review is undertaken against 
market rates and taking into account time commitment and any 
change in size, scale or complexity of the business.
•	The Group’s colleague discount is available to the Chair and 
Non-Executive Directors. In addition, they may receive benefits 
such as travel, accommodation and other reasonable expenses 
incurred in the fulfilment of their duties, which may be ‘grossed 
up’ to reflect any tax liabilities associated with the benefits. 
Additional benefits may be provided where considered 
appropriate. The Chair and Non-Executive Directors do not 
participate in any incentive scheme.
Maximum opportunity 
•	The maximum to be paid by way of fees to the Non-Executive 
Directors is set out in the Company’s Articles of Association as 
amended from time to time.
Performance metrics
•	None.
The Committee may make minor changes to this Policy which do not have a material advantage to 
Directors, to aid its operation or implementation without seeking shareholder approval but taking 
into account the interests of shareholders.
96
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Remuneration Committee report continued
Performance measures and how they 
are set
The Committee selects performance measures 
that it believes are:
•	aligned with the Group’s strategic goals and 
set, where relevant, taking into account market 
consensus and individual broker expectations. 
For the LTIP, financial measures will normally 
include EPS which the Committee considers 
to be the most appropriate measure for 
medium-term performance, aligned with our 
growth ambitions and continuing to win 
market share; 
•	unambiguous and easy to calculate; and
•	transparent to Directors and shareholders.
For both the annual bonus and the LTIP, the 
Committee reserves the right to vary or 
substitute any performance measure if justified 
by the circumstances, for example if there was 
a significant transaction.
Performance measures for the annual bonus 
for FY25 are set out on page 113. Performance 
measures for the LTIP awards proposed to be 
granted in respect of FY25 are set out on 
pages 113.
Illustrative performance scenarios
At his request, Sir Will Adderley does not 
receive any remuneration apart from an annual 
salary, car allowance and healthcare benefits. 
Therefore, his remuneration has not been 
included in the scenarios below.
The following graphs set out what Nick Wilkinson 
and Karen Witts, the other Executive Directors 
in office at the date of this report, could earn in 
FY25 under the following scenarios: 
Nick Wilkinson
Remuneration (£’000)
100%
Total
701
0
500
1,000
1,500
2,000
2,500
3,000
3,500
4,000
Maximum plus 
50% increase 
in price of LTIP 
shares vesting
Maximum
In line with 
expectations
Minimum
39%
Total
1,831
23%
46%
Total
3,055
19%
Total
3,762
37%
25%
31%
19%
23%
38%
Karen Witts
Remuneration (£’000)
100%
Total
540
0
500
1,000
1,500
2,000
2,500
3,000
3,500
4,000
Maximum plus 
50% increase 
in price of LTIP 
shares vesting
Maximum
In line with 
expectations
Minimum
37%
Total
1,299
21%
46%
Total
2,118
19%
Total
2,604
37%
23%
29%
21%
25%
42%
	Minimum
	Annual bonus
	LTIP
	Maximum plus 50% increase 
in price of LTIP shares vesting
The following assumptions have been made in respect of the scenarios set out on this page:
Fixed pay (base salary, benefits and pension only)
Base salary
£’000
Benefits
£’000
Pension
£’000
Nick Wilkinson
628
54
19
Karen Witts
485
40
15
Performance level
Fixed pay
Annual Bonus
LTIP
Minimum 
(performance 
below threshold)
As above
Nil
Nil
In line with 
expectations
As above
45% of bonus opportunity 
earned (67.5% of salary for Nick 
Wilkinson, 56.25% of salary for 
Karen Witts).
50% of the LTIP award vests 
(112.5% of salary for Nick 
Wilkinson and 100% of salary 
for Karen Witts), based on face 
value of the award at the date 
of grant.
Maximum 
performance
As above
100% of bonus opportunity 
earned (150% of salary for Nick 
Wilkinson, 125% of salary for 
Karen Witts).
100% of the LTIP vests (225% 
of salary for Nick Wilkinson and 
200% of salary for Karen Witts), 
based on face value of the 
award at the date of grant.
Maximum 
performance, 
plus share price 
increase
As above
100% of bonus opportunity 
earned (150% of salary for Nick 
Wilkinson, 125% of salary for 
Karen Witts).
100% of the LTIP vests (225% 
of salary for Nick Wilkinson and 
200% of salary for Karen Witts),
plus an increase in the value of 
the LTIP of 50% across the 
relevant performance period 
to reflect possible share price 
appreciation.
97
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Remuneration Committee report continued
Service contracts and loss of 
office payments 
All of the Executive Directors have service 
contracts. The notice period for termination for 
Sir Will Adderley is 12 months from either party, 
and for Nick Wilkinson and Karen Witts is six 
months from either party. 
In connection with her joining Dunelm and as 
disclosed in the Directors’ Remuneration Report 
for the year ended 2 July 2022, Karen Witts is 
entitled to an allowance of £1,500 per month to 
cover the cost of rent on a property close to 
Dunelm’s offices in Leicester and/or other 
expenses and travel costs.
If the Company terminates the employment 
of an Executive Director it would honour its 
contractual commitments. If termination was 
with immediate effect, a payment in lieu of notice 
may be made. The Committee may apply 
mitigation in respect of any termination payment.
Details in relation to the service contracts for 
Executive Directors are set out in Table 6 on page 
107 of the Annual Report on Remuneration.
Bonus
The Committee has discretion to make a 
payment to a ‘good leaver’ (as determined by 
the Committee) in respect of any annual bonus. 
Any such bonus would normally be pro-rated to 
the period of active service during the relevant 
financial year. Ordinarily, any bonus would be 
subject to deferral into shares in the usual way; 
however, the Committee retains discretion not 
to apply deferral in appropriate circumstances. 
Share bonus awards will lapse on termination 
of employment before vesting other than in the 
event of death, serious ill health and any other 
reason at the discretion of the Committee. 
If an award does not lapse, the Committee will 
determine whether it vests on termination or at 
the ordinary vesting date.
LTIP
If a participant leaves the employment of the 
Group, the following provisions apply to awards 
granted under the LTIP:
•	awards in the form of options that have vested 
but have not yet been exercised may be 
exercised within six months of cessation of 
employment (12 months in the case of death);
•	except in the case of dismissal for gross 
misconduct, awards which have not yet 
vested, but where the performance period 
has elapsed, may vest at the relevant vesting 
date. The Committee has discretion to vest 
the award earlier but would only use this in 
exceptional circumstances (such as ill-health). 
In the event of death, unless the Board 
determines otherwise, vesting will be as soon 
as practicable. In the case of an option, the 
option must be exercised within six months of 
vesting (or 12 months in the case of death), to 
the extent that the performance conditions 
have been met; and
•	if the participant leaves the Group before an 
award has vested and before the performance 
period has elapsed, the award will usually 
lapse. However, if the participant ceases 
employment due to ill-health, injury or 
disability or if the Committee exercises its 
discretion to treat the participant as a ‘good 
leaver’, the award will be retained and vest at 
the normal vesting date. The Committee has 
discretion to vest the award earlier, but would 
only use this in exceptional circumstances 
(such as ill-health). In the event of death, unless 
the Board determines otherwise, vesting will 
be as soon as practicable. In the case of an 
option, the option may be exercised within 
six months of the relevant vesting date (or 12 
months in the case of death). Any vesting 
would be subject to assessment of the 
performance conditions (and the exercise of 
any discretion to vary formulaic outturns in line 
with the Policy) and, unless the Committee 
determined otherwise, a reduction to reflect 
the proportion of the performance period that 
had elapsed at cessation.
In all cases, LTIP awards would be subject to the 
applicable malus and clawback provisions.
Sharesave
If a participant leaves the Group, options 
granted under the Sharesave will normally lapse, 
but may be exercised within six months from 
the cessation of employment due to injury, 
disability, retirement, or redundancy (or 12 
months in the case of death), or the employing 
company leaving the Group or, provided that 
the option has been held for at least three years, 
cessation for any other reason (apart from 
dismissal by the Company).
Non-Executive Directors’ letters 
of appointment
Non-Executive Directors have letters of 
appointment. The term is for an initial period of 
three years with a provision for termination on 
one month’s notice from either party, or three 
months’ notice from either party in the case of 
the Chair. Letters are renewed for up to two 
additional three-year terms, and then renewed 
annually. The letter of appointment will terminate 
without compensation if the Director is not 
reappointed at the AGM.
Details in relation to the letters of appointment 
are set out in Table 6 on page 107 of the Annual 
Report on Remuneration.
Other payments
The Committee reserves the right to make any 
other payments in connection with a Director’s 
cessation of office or employment where the 
payments are made in good faith in discharge 
of an existing legal obligation (or by way of 
damages for breach of such an obligation) or 
by way of settlement of any claim arising in 
connection with the cessation of a Director’s 
office or employment or for any fees for 
outplacement assistance and/or the Director’s 
legal and/or professional advice fees in 
connection with their cessation of office or 
employment. In appropriate circumstances, 
the Committee may continue the provision of 
certain benefits (for example health insurance) 
for a period following cessation.
98
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Remuneration Committee report continued
Change of control and other 
corporate events 
Share bonus awards
Share bonus awards will vest on a change of 
control or winding up of the Company before 
the originally anticipated vesting date.
LTIP
The following provisions apply to awards 
made under the Long-Term Incentive Plan in 
accordance with the plan rules if there is a 
change of control or winding up of the 
Company:
•	any vested but unexercised options may 
be exercised; 
•	any unvested awards in respect of which the 
performance period has ended and to which 
the performance condition has been applied 
will vest and, in the case of options, may 
be exercised;
•	any unvested awards in respect of which the 
performance period has not ended may vest 
and, in the case of options, be exercised at the 
discretion of the Committee, subject to any 
adjustment to take into account the amount of 
time that has elapsed through the performance 
period (unless the Committee decides not to 
apply a time-based reduction) and the extent 
to which any performance criteria have been 
met (and the exercise of any discretion to 
vary formulaic outturns in line with the Policy 
table); and
•	the Executive Director may agree that their 
awards are ‘rolled over’ into shares of the 
acquiring company as an alternative.
If the Company has been, or will be, affected 
by any demerger, dividend in specie, special 
dividend or other transaction which will 
adversely affect the current or future value of 
any awards under the LTIP or any share bonus 
awards, the plan rules allow the Committee, 
acting fairly and reasonably, to determine the 
extent to which any awards should vest and the 
period within which options may be exercised.
Sharesave
Sharesave options may be exercised within 
six months following a change of control or 
winding up of the Company, using savings in 
the participant’s account at the date of exercise. 
The participant may agree that their awards 
are ‘rolled over’ into shares of the acquiring 
company as an alternative.
Operation of share plans
All discretions available under the Company’s 
share plan rules will be available under this 
Policy, except where explicitly limited under this 
Policy. This includes that:
•	the Committee may amend the terms of 
awards and options under the Company’s 
share plans in accordance with the plan rules 
in the event of a variation of Dunelm’s share 
capital or a demerger, special dividend or 
other similar event or otherwise in accordance 
with the rules of those plans; and 
•	awards may be settled, in whole or in part, 
in cash, although the Committee would only 
settle an Executive Director’s award in cash in 
exceptional circumstances, such as where 
there is a regulatory restriction on the delivery 
of shares, or in connection with the settlement 
of tax liabilities arising in respect of the award.
Executive pay and the pay of 
other colleagues 
The remuneration principles set out on page 
88 are applied consistently to pay throughout 
the Group.
Pay for all colleagues is set at a level that is fair 
for the role and responsibilities of the individual, 
and is designed to attract and retain high 
calibre talent that is needed to deliver the 
Group’s strategy, without paying too much.
The remuneration of Executive Directors is more 
heavily weighted towards variable pay than for 
other colleagues, so that a greater part of their 
pay is linked to successful delivery of strategy 
and aligned with shareholders. They are also 
required to build and maintain a shareholding 
in the Company as set out above.
The remuneration of colleagues below the 
Board (including participation in the LTIP) 
reflects the seniority of the role, market practice 
and the ability of the individual to influence 
Group performance.
All colleagues who have met a minimum service 
requirement (usually three months or less) are 
encouraged to participate in the Sharesave plan, 
which enables them to become shareholders 
at a discounted rate. Participation is usually 
offered annually at the maximum price discount 
permitted (currently 20%), at the discretion of 
the Committee.
In setting the policy for the Executive Directors’ 
remuneration, the Committee takes note of the 
overall approach to remuneration in the Group. 
Although the Committee does not formally 
consult with employees when setting the Policy, 
details of how it engages with colleagues on 
pay are set out on page 115.
Shareholder views 
The Board is committed to ongoing engagement 
with shareholders in respect of all governance 
matters, including executive remuneration.
We consulted with shareholders in relation to 
the current Policy including, in particular, our 
approach to variable pay and shareholding 
requirements for Executive Directors. We were 
pleased with the level of engagement from 
shareholders and for the support shown for our 
proposals, which we finalised having regard to 
feedback received.
99
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Remuneration Committee report continued
Approach to recruitment remuneration
The Committee will apply the principles set out 
below when agreeing a remuneration package 
for a new Executive Director (whether an 
external candidate or an internal promotion): 
•	the package must be sufficient to attract and 
retain the high calibre talent necessary to 
develop and deliver the Group’s strategy;
•	no more should be paid than is necessary;
•	pension provision will be in line with the Policy 
table; and
•	the Committee reserves the discretion to 
make appropriate remuneration decisions 
outside the standard policy to meet the 
individual needs of the recruitment provided 
the Committee believes the relevant decisions 
are in the best interests of the Group.
Circumstances in which the Committee might 
apply its discretion to make appropriate 
remuneration decisions as referenced 
above include:
•	where an interim appointment is made on 
a short-term basis, including where the Chair 
or another Non-Executive Director has to 
assume an executive position;
•	where employment commences at a time in 
the year when it is inappropriate to provide a 
bonus or share incentive award as there is 
insufficient time to assess performance, the 
quantum for the subsequent year might be 
increased proportionately instead; and
•	where an executive is recruited from a 
business or location that offered benefits that 
the Committee considers it appropriate to 
‘buy out’, or which the Committee considers 
it appropriate to offer.
Examples of remuneration decisions that the 
Committee may make are set out below:
•	it may be appropriate to offer a lower salary 
initially, with a series of increases to reach the 
desired salary over a period of time, subject 
to performance;
•	the Committee may also alter the 
performance criteria applicable to the initial 
annual bonus or LTIP award so that they are 
more applicable to the circumstances of 
the recruitment;
•	an internal candidate would be able to retain 
any outstanding variable pay awarded in 
respect of their previous role that pays out in 
accordance with its terms of grant; and/or
•	appropriate costs and support will be 
provided if the recruitment requires the 
relocation of the individual.
The maximum level of variable pay that could 
be awarded to a new Executive Director in the 
first year of employment, excluding any buyout 
arrangements, would be 375% of salary as set 
out in the Policy table. The Committee would 
explain the rationale for the remuneration package 
in the next Annual Report of the Company.
In addition, on hiring an external candidate the 
Committee may make arrangements to buy out 
remuneration that the individual has forfeited 
on leaving a previous employer. The Committee 
will generally seek to structure buyout awards 
and payments on a comparable basis to 
remuneration arrangements forfeited. These 
awards or payments are excluded from the 
maximum level of variable pay referred to in 
the Policy; however, the Committee’s intention 
is that the value awarded or paid would be 
no higher than the expected value of the 
forfeited arrangements.
In order to implement the arrangements 
described, the Committee may rely on the 
exemption in UK Listing Rule 9.3.2, which allows 
for the grant of share or share option awards to 
facilitate, in unusual circumstances, the 
recruitment of a Director.
The Committee does not intend to use any 
discretion in this section to make a non-
performance-related incentive payment (for 
example a ‘golden hello’).
On the appointment of a new Chair the fee will 
be set taking into account the experience and 
calibre of the individual and pay for similar roles 
in companies of similar size and complexity in 
the market. The fees for any newly appointed 
Non-Executive Director would be set in 
accordance with the Policy table on page 96. 
No share incentives or performance-related 
incentives would be offered.
Legacy remuneration arrangements
The Committee reserves the right to make 
remuneration payments and payments for loss 
of office (including exercising any discretion 
available to it in connection with any such 
payment) notwithstanding that they are not in 
line with the Policy set out above where the 
terms of payments were agreed: 
•	before the Policy came into effect (provided 
that, in the case of any payments agreed on or 
after 11 November 2014 they are in line with 
any applicable shareholder approved 
Directors’ remuneration policy in force at the 
time they were agreed or were otherwise 
approved by shareholders); or
•	at a time when the relevant individual was not 
a Director of the Company (or other person to 
whom the Policy set out above applies) and, in 
the opinion of the Committee, the payment 
was not in consideration for the individual 
becoming a Director of the Company (or 
other such person).
For these purposes, ‘payments’ includes the 
satisfaction of variable remuneration and, in 
relation to an award over shares, the terms of 
the payment are ‘agreed’ no later than the time 
the award is granted.
100
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Remuneration Committee report continued
This report has been prepared on behalf of the 
Board by the Committee, chaired by William 
Reeve. It sets out how the Directors’ Remuneration 
Policy which was approved by shareholders on 
16 November 2023 has been applied in FY24 
and how the policy will be applied in FY25. 
Committee members and meeting attendance during FY24 
Member
Attendance
Notes
William Reeve
3/3
Alison Brittain
3/3
Ian Bull
3/3
Kelly Devine
2/2
Kelly stepped down from the Committee on 11 March 2024 and 
the Board on 5 July 2024.
Ajay Kavan
1/1
Ajay joined the Board and the Committee on 1 March 2024. 
Peter Ruis
2/2
Peter stepped down from the Board and Committee on 10 
January 2024.
Arja Taaveniku
3/3
Vijay Talwar
3/3
Dan Taylor
1/1
Dan joined the Board and the Committee on 1 March 2024.
Annual Report on Remuneration 
Composition of the Committee 
The Committee comprises solely independent 
Non-Executive Directors (including the Chair, 
who was independent on appointment), and 
did so throughout FY24. William Reeve has 
chaired the Committee since 2018. 
Only members of the Committee have the 
right to attend meetings. Other Directors and 
individuals such as the CEO and People & 
Stores Director are invited to attend all or part 
of meetings, as appropriate. No Director 
participates when his or her own remuneration 
is discussed. The Group General Counsel and 
Company Secretary acts as secretary to the 
Committee and attends all meetings.
During the year, the Committee met formally 
three times with an additional ad hoc meeting 
held in May. The Committee has held two 
further meetings prior to the publication of 
this report. 
Role and principal duties
The Committee is responsible for determining 
the policy for Directors’ remuneration and 
setting the remuneration for the Chair of the 
Board, Executive Directors and 
members of the Executive Team in accordance 
with the Principles and Provisions of the Code. 
Its other principal duties include:
•	establishing remuneration schemes that 
support alignment with long-term 
shareholder interests;
•	designing remuneration policies and 
practices to support strategy and promote 
long-term sustainable success;
•	reviewing the design of all share incentive 
plans for approval by the Board and for any 
such plans determine whether awards will be 
made each year; and
•	reviewing workforce remuneration and 
related policies.
	The Committee’s full terms of reference can 
be found at: corporate.dunelm.com
Together with the Chair’s statement on pages 
89 to 90, it will be put to shareholders for an 
advisory vote at the FY24 AGM. 
The information contained in this report is 
unaudited unless expressly stated otherwise.
101
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Remuneration Committee report continued
Single figure for total remuneration (audited)
The following table sets out total remuneration for Directors for the period ended 29 June 2024:
Table 1: Directors’ remuneration — single figure table 
Salary/fees
£’0001
Benefits
£’0002 
Pension
£’0003 
Total fixed 
remuneration
£’0004 
LTIP award
£’0005
Bonus
£’0006
Total Variable 
remuneration
£’0007
Total
£’000
Director
FY24
FY23
FY24
FY23
FY24
FY23
FY24
FY23
FY24
FY23
FY24
FY23
FY24
FY23
FY24
FY23
Nick Wilkinson
609
582
53
48
18
17
680
647
632
964
331
335
963
1,299
1,643
1,946
Karen Witts
471
450
40
38
14
14
525
502
525
—
218
252
743
252
1,268
754
Sir Will Adderley
—
—
21
20
—
—
21
20
—
—
—
—
—
—
21
20
Sub-total
1,080
1,032
114
106
32
31
1,226
1,169
1,157
964
549
587
1,706
1,551
2,932
2,720
Non-Executive Director
Alison Brittain
337
179
—
—
—
—
337
179
—
—
—
—
—
—
337
179
Ian Bull
70
67
—
—
—
—
70
67
—
—
—
—
—
—
70
67
Kelly Devine
58
56
—
—
—
—
58
56
—
—
—
—
—
—
58
56
Ajay Kavan
20
—
—
—
—
—
20
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
20
—
William Reeve
77
73
—
—
—
—
77
73
—
—
—
—
—
—
77
73
Peter Ruis
31
56
—
—
—
—
31
56
—
—
—
—
—
—
31
56
Marion Sears 
58
56
—
—
—
—
58
56
—
—
—
—
—
—
58
56
Arja Taaveniku
58
56
—
—
—
—
58
56
—
—
—
—
—
—
58
56
Vijay Talwar
58
56
—
—
—
—
58
56
—
—
—
—
—
—
58
56
Dan Taylor
20
—
—
—
—
—
20
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
20
—
Total
1,867
1,631
114
106
32
31
2,013
1,768
1,157
964
549
587
1,706
1,551
3,719
3,319
1.	
Alison Brittain joined the Board on 7 September 2022 and was appointed Chair on 1 January 2023. Ajay Kavan and Dan Taylor were appointed on 1 March 2024 and Peter Ruis stepped down on 10 January 2024. Basic fees for Alison Brittain, Ajay Kavan, Dan Taylor and Peter Ruis have 
been pro-rated over the relevant year as appropriate. Sir Will Adderley’s base salary was held at £1 per annum. The salary for the Executive Directors increased by 5% and the fees for the Chair and other Non-Executive Directors increased by 5% with effect from 1 August 2023.
2.	
Benefits include the cost of a car allowance and private health insurance for the individual and their family. Nick Wilkinson is also entitled to an allowance of 5% of his annual salary towards the cost of travel from home to Leicester. Karen Witts is entitled to an allowance of £1,500 per 
month to cover the cost of rent on a property close to the office in Leicester and travel costs.
3.	
Pension entitlement is 3% of contractual salary to a defined contribution plan or cash allowance in lieu. For Nick Wilkinson, prior to 1 August 2022 the pension entitlement was 8% of contractual salary. Sir Will Adderley waived his entitlement to a pension from 1 July 2015.
4.	
Total fixed remuneration includes salary/fees, benefits and pension.
5.	
The figure for Nick Wilkinson and Karen Witts is the value of the FY22—24 LTIP award, the three-year performance period for which ended on the last day of the financial period being reported on. The price used to calculate the value of the awards, which will vest on 20 October 2024 
for Nick and 9 June 2025 for Karen, was the average of Dunelm’s closing share price over the last three months of FY24, which was 1,056 pence per share. The value of a share when Nick’s award was granted was 1,307p; therefore none of the value of Nick’s award is attributable to an 
increase in the share price. The value of a share when Karen’s award was granted was 946p; therefore c.10.4% of the value of Karen’s award attributable to the vesting of the shares over which the award was originally granted is attributable to an increase in the share price. The value 
also includes a ’special dividend equivalent’ of 65p per vested share in respect of the special dividend paid on 8 October 2021, 37p per vested share in respect of the special dividend paid on 18 March 2022, 40p per vested share in respect of the special dividend paid on 11 April 
2023 and 35p per vested share in respect of the special dividend paid on 9 April 2024. The share price used to calculate the number of shares in Nick and Karen’s ‘special dividend equivalent’ was 1,310p per share in respect of the October 2021 special dividend, 1,127p per share in 
respect of the March 2022 special dividend,1,081 per share in respect of the April 2023 special dividend and 1,095p per share in respect of the April 2024 special dividend, in each case being the closing share price the working day before the special dividend date. No discretion was 
applied to adjust the performance conditions or outcome of the FY22—24 LTIP for share price appreciation or depreciation or for any other reason. The prior year figures have been updated to reflect the actual closing share price of 1,089p on the day before the vesting date, 
compared to last year’s report which was based on the average closing share price over the last three months of FY23. Sir Will Adderley asked not to be considered for an LTIP award.
6.	
Nick Wilkinson and Karen Witts were awarded an annual performance-related bonus for FY24 with a maximum opportunity of (i) 150% of contractual salary for Nick Wilkinson and (ii) 125% of contractual salary for Karen Witts. The performance conditions which applied to the bonus 
were set in September 2023 and are described on pages 103 and 104. 
7.	
Total variable remuneration includes bonus and LTIP awards.
102
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Remuneration Committee report continued
FY24 annual bonus (audited)
Nick Wilkinson was eligible to earn an annual bonus of up to 150% of base salary during the year and Karen Witts was eligible to earn an annual bonus of up to 125% of base salary during the year, in each 
case subject to meeting the performance targets set out below and on the following page. Sir Will Adderley asked not to be considered for an annual bonus. 
The bonus was based on challenging targets set by the Committee at the start of the financial year, with 75% based on financial targets and 25% based on personal and strategic targets. The ‘Sales ’ and 
personal elements of the bonus would only be paid if we achieved the threshold PBT. Information on the targets set and the performance against them is set out in Table 2. Based on performance against 
those targets, Nick Wilkinson earned a bonus of £330,859 and Karen Witts earned a bonus of £217,591 as set out in Table 3. The full bonus is paid in cash, with two-thirds of the after-tax amount being 
subject to a requirement that it is invested in shares.
Table 2: annual bonus 2024 payout (audited)
Performance measures
% of bonus 
opportunity
Threshold 
performance2
On-target 
performance3
Maximum 
performance 
(100%)
FY24 actual 
performance
% outcome 
for each 
measure
Financial measures1
— Profit before tax
50%
£188.6m
£206.6m
£227.3m
£205.4m
38%
— Sales
25%
£1,660m
£1,804m
£1,894m
£1,706m
23%
Non-financial personal and strategic targets
25%
(see page 104 for details)
CEO—47%
CFO—50%
1.	
Bonus is earned between threshold and on-target and between on-target and maximum on a straight-line basis. 
2.	
For threshold vesting is at 10% of maximum for sales and 5% of maximum for PBT.
3.	
For on-target, vesting is at 50% of maximum for sales and 40% for on-target for PBT.
Table 3: overall 2024 bonus earned (audited)
Base salary
£’000
Maximum 
bonus % of 
salary
2024 bonus 
outcomes % 
of maximum
Overall 2024 
bonus 
earned 
£’000
2024 bonus 
outcome % 
of salary
Nick Wilkinson
609
150%
36%
331
54%
Karen Witts
471
125%
37%
218
46%
CEO and CFO Non-financial personal and strategic objectives 
25% of the bonus opportunity is linked to performance against objectives, both personal and strategic. Payment of this element of the bonus is subject to meeting threshold on the PBT financial metric for 
the year (which has been achieved). The targets, which are specific to each of the CEO and CFO, were set by the Committee to reflect personal and strategic priorities for FY24. Assessment against them 
(including consideration of relevant KPIs) was considered by the Committee following the end of the financial year, and a bonus outcome determined accordingly. 
It was assessed that 47% of the personal and strategic targets had been met by the CEO and 50% of the personal and strategic targets had been met by the CFO. Further details on their respective key 
achievements against each objective are set out on the next page.
103
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Remuneration Committee report continued
CEO and CFO Non-financial personal and strategic objectives (continued)
CEO FY24 performance against personal and strategic objectives — outcome 47% of maximum 
opportunity
Objectives 
Key achievements during FY24
Strategy
c.25% weighting
•	Navigated a complex and volatile trading environment to 
deliver customer growth, market share gains and meet 
margin targets. 
•	Maintained focus on improving customer experience through 
process and technology change. 
•	Further progress on cost reduction, balanced with prioritisation 
of growth drivers.
Organisation capabilities
c.25% weighting 
•	Supported improvements to tech ways of working, roadmaps 
and pace of delivery.
•	Continued progress on improving data fluency and insights to 
optimise operations, increase productivity and further develop 
the customer proposition.
•	Maintained focus on delivering our sustainability goals, 
including in relation to circular design, manufacturing, and 
strengthening governance and communications.
Corporate and investor 
relations
c.25% weighting
•	Delivered clear investor communications throughout year.
•	Continued to develop capability and approach to business 
development. 
•	Hosted successful investor and analyst event, ‘At Home 
with Dunelm’.
People
c.25% weighting
•	Successfully restructured Executive Team responsibilities and 
continued development of ways of working.
•	Continued focus on capability building and succession 
planning for senior roles.
•	Oversaw increased awareness of our inclusion and diversity 
programme and its initiatives.
CFO FY24 performance against personal and strategic objectives — outcome 50% of maximum 
opportunity
Objectives 
Key achievements during FY24
Driving business performance
c.25% weighting
•	Implemented refreshed operational KPIs to drive 
budgeted performance.
•	Adapted plans throughout the year to deliver continued 
growth in a volatile environment.
•	Further progress on cost reduction; role-modelled and 
delivered operating cost savings.
•	Maintained strong free cash flow performance, allowing 
continued investment and shareholder returns in line with 
capital allocation policy.
Financial planning and finance 
transformation projects
c.25% weighting 
•	Created financial plans to support monitoring of progress 
against the business strategy. 
•	Continued to develop plans for finance systems development 
and modernisation, whilst optimising existing functionality.
•	Revolving credit facility successfully refinanced in 
December 2023.
Corporate and investor 
relations 
c.20% weighting
•	Continued to develop capability and approach around 
business development.
•	Delivered clear investor communications throughout year.
•	Planned and delivered successful investor and analyst event, 
‘At Home with Dunelm’.
Non-financial reporting
c.15% weighting
•	Developed understanding, capability and reportable metrics 
within the business in relation to non-financial reporting.
•	Delivered detailed review of data points published. 
•	Oversaw implementation of ‘no regrets’ work ahead of the 
introduction of new regulatory requirements. 
People
c.15% weighting
•	Recruited in-house Head of Internal Audit in line with decision 
to move to a co-sourced arrangement.
•	Continued to support inclusion and diversity initiatives.
•	Ongoing focus on structure of finance team, including 
development and succession plans.
104
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Remuneration Committee report continued
LTIP awards granted in respect of performance in FY22—24 (audited)
Nick Wilkinson was granted an LTIP award on 20 October 2021 with vesting subject to performance conditions assessed over the three-year period FY22 to FY24 and Karen Witts was granted a pro-rated 
award on 9 June 2022 following her appointment as CFO, which was subject to the same three-year performance period. These awards were subject to performance conditions based on Diluted EPS 
(with an 80% weighting) and sustainability measures (with a 20% weighting in aggregate) — the sustainability measures were split into three equal elements with stretching meet/fail targets, rather than 
a target range, as discussed in the FY21 Directors’ Remuneration Report. These awards have vested at 58% as set out in the table below. 
Sir Will Adderley does not have an LTIP award vesting in respect of performance in FY22 to FY24.
Table 4: LTIP awards due to vest for performance period ended 29 June 2024 (audited)
Performance condition and outturn
Director
Options over 
ordinary 
share 
granted
FY24 Diluted EPS (80% of opportunity)
Sustainability element (20% opportunity)
Vesting 
percentage
Vested 
shares
Dividend 
equivalent
shares1
Total 
vesting
shares2
Threshold 
(10% 
vesting)
On target 
(50% 
vesting)
Stretch
(75% 
vesting)
Maximum 
(100% 
vesting)
FY24 
outturn
Sustainability 
measure 1
(1/3)
Sustainability 
measure 2
(1/3)
Sustainability 
measure 3
(1/3)
Nick Wilkinson
89,078
66.6p
72.2p
80.9p
88.8p
74.4p
Percentage of own 
brand cotton products 
which meet our ‘More 
Responsibly Sourced 
Cotton Standard’
Target: 80%
Not Met
Reduction in plastic 
packaging of own 
brand products 
against FY20 base
Target: 20% 
reduction
Met
% of own brand 
products for which 
we offer an easy to 
use take back 
service
Target: 50%
Met
58%
52,013
7,873
59,886
Karen Witts 
73,979
58%
43,196
6,537
49,733
1.	
Nick Wilkinson and Karen Witts will also receive additional shares by way of ‘special dividend equivalents’. The number of additional shares to vest for Nick Wilkinson as a result is 7,873 and for Karen is 6,537 — information in relation to the calculation of the number of additional shares 
is provided in the footnotes to Table 1 on page 102. 
2.	
The value of this number of shares is included in the single figure for total remuneration for FY24 as set out in Table 1 on page 102, and the basis on which it has been calculated is set out in footnote 5 of Table 1. Vested shares must be retained in accordance with the shareholding 
guidelines set out in the Remuneration Policy.
105
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Remuneration Committee report continued
Awards made to Directors under share incentive schemes in FY24 (audited)
LTIP awards were made on 21 November 2023 to Nick Wilkinson and Karen Witts as set out below:
Table 5: LTIP awards made to Directors during FY24 (audited)
Director
Award
Shares under 
award¹
Basis of award
Face value
Performance conditions
Performance period  
end date
Vesting date
FY26 Diluted EPS (80% of opportunity)
Threshold 
10% vesting
On-target (50% 
vesting)
Maximum 
(100% vesting)
Nick Wilkinson
Nil-cost options under LTIP
126,725
225% of salary
£1,374,975
78p
83p
100.0p or more
27 June 2026
21 November 2026
Non-financial measures² (20% of opportunity)
ESG metric 1
(one-third)
ESG metric 2
(one-third)
ESG metric 3
(one-third)
Karen Witts 
Nil-cost options under LTIP
87,096
200% of salary
£945,000
As above
As above
1. 	 Based on the average closing share price on 16, 17 and 20 November 2023 of 1,085p per share.
2. 	 Three sustainability-based measures, each accounting for a third of this element of the award, on a simple pass or fail basis against target: (i) ESG metric 1 — reduction in Scope 1 greenhouse gas emissions per £m sales (FY26 target: 59.3%); (ii) percentage of own brand cotton 
products which meet our ‘More Responsibly Sourced Cotton’ standard (FY26 target: 100%); and (iii) percentage of role model leadership roles filled by ethnic minority colleagues (target FY26: 8%). 
All shares vesting (after payment of tax and National Insurance) must be held for two years from the vesting date, and thereafter at least two-thirds of these must be held for the duration of employment. 
The Executive Directors are eligible to receive a ‘special dividend equivalent’ in relation to these awards, in respect of a special dividend of 35 pence per share paid on 9 April 2024 and any other special 
dividend paid before the awards vest.
Payments to past Directors and for loss of office (audited)
No payments were made to any former Director in the financial year or to any Director in respect of loss of office or the termination of his or her employment.
106
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Remuneration Committee report continued
Service contracts
In accordance with the Group’s policy, the service contracts of the Executive Directors have no fixed 
term. The notice period for termination is 12 months from either party for Sir Will Adderley, and six 
months for each of Nick Wilkinson and Karen Witts respectively. Service contracts for the Executive 
Directors include a non-compete arrangement. Payments on termination are restricted to a 
maximum of the value of base salary and benefits for the notice period. The Committee may apply 
mitigation in respect of any termination payment. Copies of the Executive Directors’ service 
contracts are available for inspection at the Company’s registered office.
The Non-Executive Directors have letters of appointment for an initial period of three years with 
a provision for termination on one month’s notice from either party, or three months’ notice from 
either party in the case of Alison Brittain, the Chair.
Table 6: Directors’ service contracts
Executives
Start date
Expiry of current term
Notice period
Nick Wilkinson
1 February 2018
n/a
6 months
Karen Witts
9 June 2022
n/a
6 months
Sir Will Adderley
28 September 2006
n/a
12 months
Non-Executives
Alison Brittain
7 September 2022
7 September 2025
3 months
Ian Bull
10 July 2019
10 July 2025
1 month
Ajay Kavan
1 March 2024
1 March 2027
1 month
William Reeve1 
1 July 2015
21 November 2024
1 month
Marion Sears2 
22 July 2004
22 July 2025
1 month
Arja Taaveniku3
15 February 2021
15 February 2027
1 month
Vijay Talwar
1 October 2021
1 October 2024
1 month
Dan Taylor
1 March 2024
1 March 2027
1 month
1.	
William Reeve is stepping down from the Board on 21 November 2024.
2.	
Marion Sears has served more than nine years on the Board. Her contract is renewed for a one-year term (rather than three), with the 
notice period referred to above.
3.	
Arja Taaveniku is stepping down from the Board on at the end of the 2024 calendar year.
Directors’ shareholdings and share interests
Directors’ share interests
The interests of the Directors and their connected persons in the Company at 1 July 2023 and at 
year end, or their date of cessation, if earlier are set out in Table 7. There have been no changes in 
the interests of each Director in the period from 30 June 2024 to the date of this report.
Table 7: Shareholdings of Directors and Persons Closely Associated with them (audited)
Executives
At 29 June 2024 
1p Ordinary shares
At 1 July 2023
1p Ordinary shares
Nick Wilkinson
428,940
371,330
Karen Witts
33,449
24,918
Sir Will Adderley
76,371,779
76,371,779
Non-Executives
Alison Brittain
37,500
37,500
Ian Bull
11,000
11,000
Kelly Devine2
—
—
Ajay Kavan1
4,921
n/a
William Reeve
22,000
22,000
Peter Ruis2
n/a
—
Marion Sears 
105,000
105,000
Arja Taaveniku
6,000
6,000
Vijay Talwar
9,670
9,670
Dan Taylor1
—
n/a
1.	
Ajay Kavan and Dan Taylor joined the Board on 1 March 2024.
2.	
Peter Ruis stepped down from the Board on 10 January 2024 and Kelly Devine stepped down on 5 July 2024.
107
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Remuneration Committee report continued
Executive shareholdings (audited)
Executive Directors are subject to a shareholding target which requires them to build a holding of Dunelm shares with a value equal to the higher of their normal LTIP grant and 200% of salary 
(measured by reference to share price at the financial year end). Ordinarily, Executive Directors are expected to achieve this holding requirement within five years of appointment.
Nick Wilkinson had substantially exceeded the minimum shareholding requirement within a five-year period from his appointment. At 29 June 2924, Karen Witts had acquired shares with a value of 73% 
of salary, such that she is on track to meet the minimum shareholding requirement within the ordinarily expected five-year period. Achievement against this requirement is set out in Table 8 below, other 
than in the case of Sir Will Adderley who only receives a salary of £1 per year and for whom the requirement is therefore not relevant.
Table 8: Executive Director shareholdings (audited)
Executive Director
Shareholding 
requirement as 
a % of salary
Number of shares 
owned outright
Value of shareholding as 
at 29 June 2024
Shares owned outright as 
a % of salary1
Nick Wilkinson
225%
428,940
£4,563,922
727%
Karen Witts
200%
33,449
£355,897
73%2
1.	
Based on the closing share price of 1,064p on 29 June 2024 and base salary at 1 August 2024.
2.	
Karen Witts is 27 months into her five-year period to meet the shareholding requirement. She is on track to meet this requirement. 
Table 9: Movements in Directors’ interests in share options during FY24 (audited)
All share awards and options held at the beginning of the financial year and at year end by the Executive Directors who served during the year, together with any movements, are shown below:
Date of award
Name of award
Type of award
Share options held 
at 1 July 2023
Share options 
granted during 
the year1
Share options 
vested and 
exercised during 
the year
Share options 
lapsed/cancelled 
during the year
Share options at 
29 June 2024
End of  
performance 
period
Option price
Nick Wilkinson
21 November 2023
FY24—26 LTIP
Nil-cost options
—
126,725
—
—
126,725
27 June 2026
—
27 October 2022
FY23—25 LTIP3
Nil-cost options
139,765
—
—
—
139,765
28 June 2025
—
20 October 2021
FY22—24 LTIP3
Nil-cost options
89,078
—
—
—
89,078
29 June 2024
—
20 November 2020
FY21—23 LTIP3
Nil-cost options
94,846
9,439
88,4772
(15,808)
—
1 July 2023
—
22 November 2022
FY23 Sharesave
Share options
2,698
—
—
—
2,698
n/a
667p
Karen Witts
21 November 2023
FY24—26 LTIP
Nil-cost options
—
87,096
—
—
87,096
27 June 2026
—
27 October 2022
FY23—25 LTIP3
Nil-cost options
108,043
—
—
—
108,043
28 June 2025
—
9 June 2022
FY22—24 LTIP3
Nil-cost options
73,979
—
—
—
73,979
29 June 2024
—
22 November 2022
FY23 Sharesave
Share options
2,698
—
—
—
2,698
n/a
667p
1.	
LTIP awards are eligible to receive a ‘special dividend equivalent’ in respect of any special dividend paid during the performance period applicable to the award and up to the date of vesting. Dividend equivalent shares have been included where quantified. 
2.	
During the year Nick Wilkinson exercised 88,477 nil-cost share options with a market value of 1,089p per share equalling a gain of £963,515.
3.	
Performance conditions in respect of the LTIP awards granted in FY21, FY22 and FY23 are set out in the FY21, FY22 and FY23 Annual Reports respectively. 
108
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Remuneration Committee report continued
Share options and dilution limits
The Committee considers the provisions of the Investment Association’s Guidelines on Executive 
Remuneration when determining the number of shares over which share scheme incentive awards 
may be made.
As at 29 June 2024 over the last ten-year period options have been granted over 4.0% of the 
Company’s issued share capital (adjusted for share issuance and cancellation). The Group does not 
hold any shares in an employee benefit trust.
Total shareholder return performance and historic CEO remuneration
The graph below shows the Group’s historic performance over ten years, measured by total 
shareholder return, compared with the FTSE 350 General Retail Index and the FTSE 250. The 
Committee has chosen these indices for comparison because they generally provide a range of 
comparator companies which have similar market capitalisation, which are in the same sector or 
face similar market and economic challenges in the long term. We have added the FTSE 350 
excluding financial services companies and investment trusts in light of the inclusion of a relative 
TSR element for the FY25 LTIP award.
Table 10: Total shareholder return performance graph (rebased to 2 July 2014 = 100)
The shares traded in the range of 967p to 1,191p during the year and stood at 1,064p at 29 June 2024.
Total shareholder return
(Rebased to 100)
0
100
200
300
400
500
160.2%
79.6%
182.5%
175.0%
Jul 24
Jul 14
Jul 15
Jul 16
July 17
Jul 18
Jul 19
Jul 20
Jul 21
Jul 22
Jul 23
 Dunelm
 FTSE 250
 FTSE 350 General Retail
 FTSE 350 excluding financial services companies and investment trusts
Factset as of 12 July 2024. Last ten years data on weekly frequency. FTSE 350 General Retail Index includes Dunelm.
Table 11: Historic Chief Executive Officer pay
The table below sets out the prescribed remuneration data for each of the individuals undertaking 
the role of Chief Executive Officer during each of the last ten financial years.
CEO single 
figure of total 
remuneration
£’000
Annual bonus 
payment against 
maximum 
opportunity
%
Long-term 
incentive 
vesting rates 
against 
maximum 
opportunity 
%
FY24
Nick Wilkinson
1,643
36.2%
58.4%
FY23
Nick Wilkinson
1,946
46.0%
83.3%
FY22
Nick Wilkinson
2,511
90.0%
100.0%
FY21
Nick Wilkinson
3,756
81.2%
100.0%
FY20
Nick Wilkinson1
885
20.0%
19.8%
FY19
Nick Wilkinson
1,365
97.9%
n/a
FY18
Nick Wilkinson2
308
13.3%
n/a
FY18
John Browett2,3
429
n/a
n/a
FY17
John Browett
722
14.0%
n/a
FY16
John Browett4
489
57.7%
n/a
FY16
Sir Will Adderley4
10
n/a
n/a
FY15
Sir Will Adderley5
507
5.0%
n/a
FY15
Nick Wharton5
110
n/a
n/a
1.	
During the period April to June 2020 inclusive, Nick Wilkinson took a voluntary 90% reduction in base salary.
2.	
John Browett left the Group on 29 August 2017. He was succeeded by Nick Wilkinson on 1 February 2018. The total figure for John 
Browett includes £322,120 in respect of salary and benefits paid for his six-month notice period. The data for each Director for FY18 
is pro-rated by time of service as Chief Executive Officer.
3.	
No LTIP awards vested to John Browett during his tenure.
4.	
Sir Will Adderley was succeeded by John Browett as Chief Executive Officer on 1 January 2016. The data for each Director for FY16 
is pro-rated by time of service as Chief Executive Officer. Sir Will Adderley’s base salary was reduced to £1 on 1 July 2015.
5.	
Sir Will Adderley was reappointed Chief Executive Officer on 11 September 2014, following the resignation of Nick Wharton on 
10 September 2014. The data for each Director for FY15 is pro-rated by time of service as Chief Executive Officer.
109
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Remuneration Committee report continued
Statement of change in pay
The table below sets out the increase or decrease in total remuneration for each Director compared with other colleagues.
Table 12: Change in Directors’ pay compared with annual change in average employee’s pay
Percentage change in remuneration 
between FY23 and FY241
Percentage change in remuneration 
between FY22 and FY231
Percentage change in remuneration 
between FY21 and FY221
Percentage change in remuneration 
between FY20 and FY211
Percentage change in remuneration 
between FY19 and FY201
Salary and 
fees4
Benefits5
Short-term 
incentive/
Bonus6,7
Salary and 
fees4
Benefits5
Short-term 
incentive/
Bonus6,7
Salary and 
fees4
Benefits5
Short-term 
incentive/
Bonus6,7
Salary and 
fees4
Benefits5
Short-term 
incentive/
Bonus6,7
Salary and 
fees4
Benefits5
Short-term 
incentive/
Bonus6,7
All colleagues2,3
7.8%
0.7%
1.8%
7.2%
1.9%
(36.6%)
4.9%
0.8%
(4.7%)
4.4%
0%
145.4%
3.5%
0%
42.7%
Executives 
Nick Wilkinson8
4.6%
5.8%
(1.1%)
0.3%
0.0%
(48.8%)
3.4%
(4.3%)
14.6%
1.8%
3.6%
313.0%
2.0%
(55.6%)
(79.2%)
Karen Witts
4.6%
0.0%
(13.6%)
0.0%
0.0%
(33.7%)
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
Sir Will Adderley
0.0%
0.0%
—
0.0%
0.0%
—
0.0%
0.0%
—
0%
(4.8%)
—
0.0%
0.0%
—
Non-Executives
Alison Brittain
4.6%
—
—
n/a
—
—
n/a
—
—
n/a
—
—
n/a
—
—
Ian Bull
4.9%
—
—
3.9%
—
—
2.7%
—
—
0%
—
—
2.0%
—
—
Kelly Devine
4.9%
—
—
3.9%
—
—
n/a
—
—
n/a
—
—
n/a
—
—
Ajay Kavan
n/a
—
—
n/a
—
—
n/a
—
—
n/a
—
—
n/a
—
—
William Reeve9
4.9%
—
—
3.9%
—
—
4.5%
—
—
8.4%
—
—
2.2%
—
—
Peter Ruis10
5.3%
—
—
4.0%
—
—
3.2%
—
—
0%
—
—
2.0%
—
—
Marion Sears 
4.9%
—
—
4.0%
—
—
3.2%
—
—
0%
—
—
2.0%
—
—
Arja Taaveniku
4.9%
—
—
3.7%
—
—
3.2%
—
—
n/a
—
—
n/a
—
—
Vijay Talwar
4.9%
—
—
3.7%
—
—
n/a
—
—
n/a
—
—
n/a
—
—
Dan Taylor
n/a
—
—
n/a
—
—
n/a
—
—
n/a
—
—
n/a
—
—
1.	
n/a refers to a nil value in the previous year or an incomplete prior year, meaning that the year-on-year change cannot be calculated.
2.	
All colleagues’ salary increase is calculated only for colleagues employed for the whole of the financial year.
3.	
Comparisons have been made against colleague pay across the entire Group as the parent company employs only one person other than the Directors and, accordingly, the percentage change in respect of the remuneration of a single employee is not considered 
a meaningful disclosure.
4.	
Directors’ remuneration is based on contractual salary or fees as appropriate and does not take account of the voluntary salary reductions of 90% of Nick Wilkinson between April and June 2020 inclusive, or the waiver by all other Directors of 100% of their fees for this period.
5.	
The percentage change in benefits does not take into account the value of medical or critical illness benefits for either the Directors or for the all colleague changes.
6.	
Short-term incentive percentage has been calculated in relation to only those colleagues eligible to receive a bonus in the period as this is considered a more appropriate comparator group. All colleagues’ short-term incentives include a one-off £250 ‘thank you’ payment to all 
colleagues not usually eligible for a bonus in respect of FY20 and the ‘thank you’ payment of between £250 and £350 made to colleagues not usually eligible for a bonus in respect of FY21.
7.	
The difference between the increase in short-term incentives of the Directors and the ‘all colleagues’ rate reflects the strong performance of the business, and the fact that a higher proportion of the Directors’ pay is performance-related.
8.	
The decrease in benefits for Nick Wilkinson in FY22 is due to benefits received in lieu of holiday in FY21 which were not received in FY22.
9.	
The increase in William Reeve’s fee in FY21 is due to the assumption of responsibilities as Senior Independent Director.
10. 	Peter Ruis stepped down from the Board on 10 January 2024. His FY24 fee has been annualised for the purposes of this calculation. 
110
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Remuneration Committee report continued
CEO pay ratio
There are three permissible methods available to calculate the CEO pay ratio, which are 
outlined below:
Option 
Method
A
Determining the total full-term equivalent remuneration for all UK employees.
Rank from low to high.
Identify the colleagues at 25th, 50th and 75th percentiles.
B
Identify the colleagues at 25th, 50th and 75th percentiles, using the Gender Pay 
Gap Reporting.
C
Use a different data set, but calculate in the same way as the Gender Pay 
Gap Reporting.
Option A is considered the most statistically accurate method and therefore we have opted for this 
method. It requires the pay and benefits of all UK colleagues to be calculated to identify the three 
colleagues at the 25th, 50th and 75th percentiles as at 29 June 2024.
Table 13 shows the ratio of actual pay of Nick Wilkinson, CEO, to other colleagues. Full-year pay 
data has been used to calculate these ratios and the elements included are based on the CEO 
single figure remuneration in Table 1. We have used a 40-hour week in order to consistently 
calculate the annual salary for everyone, converting hourly rate of pay into a full-time equivalent 
salary, to ensure a direct comparison.
Table 13: CEO pay ratio
Financial year
Method
25th 
percentile pay
50th 
percentile pay
75th 
percentile pay
FY24
Option A
73:1
70:1
64:1
FY24 base salary
Option A
£22,464
£22,798
£24,960
FY24 total pay and benefits
Option A
£22,464
£23,482
£25,621
FY23 
Option A
93:1
87:1
67:1
FY22
Option A
124:1
121:1
112:1
FY21
Option A
204:1
204:1
186:1
FY20 (based on actual remuneration 
— including Nick’s 90% pay reduction 
during the period April to June 2020)
Option A
54:1
47:1
38:1
FY20 (based on contractual 
remuneration)
Option A
62:1
53:1
43:1
Commentary: 
The Committee considered whether the median pay ratio for the year is consistent with the pay, 
reward and progression policies for the Company’s UK employees taken as a whole, and concluded 
that it is, for the following reasons:
•	the pay ratio has reduced compared to the previous year. The main difference is the CEO LTIP 
outcome for FY24, which is at c.58% lower than the CEO LTIP outcome for FY23;
•	the colleagues at the 25th, 50th and 75th percentiles are hourly-paid colleagues. This reflects that 
c.80% of our colleague base are employed in hourly-paid roles;
•	the median pay ratio is considered appropriate and consistent with the pay and reward policies 
for the Company’s UK employees. Our remuneration strategy is based on paying median to 
market for salary, to reward strong performance and focus on long-term value creation. The CEO 
remuneration is reflective of this, as his pay has a larger quantum in variable pay; and
•	in comparison we pay our hourly-paid colleagues median or above versus the market.
111
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Remuneration Committee report continued
Relative spend on pay
The table below shows the all employee pay cost, returns to shareholders by way of dividends 
(including special dividends) and share buyback for FY24 and FY23.
Table 14: Relative spend on pay
FY24
£’m
FY23
£’m
% change
Total spend on pay
237.0
214.3
10.6%
Ordinary dividend to shareholders
86.8
82.6
5.1%
Distributions to shareholders via treasury 
share purchase 
—
7.0
(100%)
Special distributions to shareholders 
70.8
80.7
(12.3%)
Total distributions to shareholders
157.6
170.3
(7.5%)
This information is based on the following:
•	Total spend on pay — total employee costs excluding car and travel allowances and bonuses from 
note 4 on page 139. 
•	Dividends taken from note 7 on page 140.
Executive Director external board appointments
Nick Wilkinson is a trustee of Rewilding Britain. Karen Witts is a Non-Executive Director of Ipsen 
Pharma SA. Sir Will Adderley is a Director of WA Capital Limited.
Advisors 
The UK Executive Compensation practice of Deloitte provides general advice on executive 
remuneration to the Committee and access to external information and research on market data 
and trends. They were appointed by the Committee following a review against other providers in 
the market. Deloitte are signatories to the Remuneration Consultants’ Code of Conduct, which 
requires their advice to be impartial, and they have confirmed their compliance with the Code to 
the Committee.
Total fees paid to Deloitte for advice to the Committee in the year were £18,000 (FY23: £30,150) 
which was a mixture of fixed fees and time spent basis, depending on the work conducted. Deloitte 
provided other remuneration-related advice to the Company in the year, including in relation to the 
operation of its share plans.
Risk Advisory and Consulting teams within Deloitte (outside of its UK Executive Compensation 
practice) provided non-remuneration-related consultancy services in the year. In each case, the 
appointment of Deloitte was made based on Deloitte’s expertise in the particular area, on an arm’s 
length basis and without reference to the fact that Deloitte also provides remuneration advice. 
Having considered the fees paid to Deloitte for non-remuneration-related work, the Committee is 
satisfied that the remuneration advice that they have received from Deloitte in the year has been 
objective and independent.
Statement of implementation of policy in FY25 
Base salary and benefits for each of the Executive Directors with effect from 1 August 2024 are set 
out in the table below.
Table 15: Executive Directors fixed remuneration
Base salary
Increase in 
base salary 
YoY
Benefits
Increase to 
benefits YoY
Pension
Change to 
pension 
contribution 
YoY
Nick Wilkinson
£627,905
2.75%
£53,985
1.6%
18,837
0.0
Karen Witts
£485,493
2.75%
£40,195
0.0
14,565
0.0
Sir Will Adderley
£1
Nil
£20,000
Nil
Nil
n/a
112
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Remuneration Committee report continued
Base salary
The Committee determined that the Executive Directors performed strongly throughout the year, 
and this has been reflected in the financial performance of the Group. Further to this, the Committee 
approved a 2.75% increase in base salary for each of the CEO and CFO in line with the increases 
given to senior colleagues. In making its decision, the Committee took into account the median pay 
award made to the wider colleague population of 6.9% and stakeholder considerations, including 
the general feedback on Executive pay received from the National Colleague Voice. Sir Will Adderley 
has asked that he not be considered for a pay increase.
Pension
The pension entitlement for both Nick Wilkinson and Karen Witts is 3% of base salary, which is in 
line with the current workforce average.
FY25 annual bonus
Nick Wilkinson has been awarded a bonus opportunity of up to 150% of salary and Karen Witts has 
been awarded a bonus opportunity of up to 125% of base salary. The performance conditions 
attached to their respective bonuses are:
•	50% linked to achievement of budget PBT;
•	25% linked to achievement of budget sales; and
•	25% linked to achievement of strategic and personal targets aligned to the Group strategy (15%), 
and environmental, social and governance measures (10%).
The budget sales and PBT are set taking into account market consensus and broker expectations. 
The actual financial and strategic targets have not been disclosed at this time as they are 
commercially sensitive. The targets and an assessment of the extent to which they have been 
achieved will be disclosed in next year’s Remuneration Committee report.
The Policy enables bonus vesting levels at up to 10% of maximum at threshold. The FY23 Directors’ 
Remuneration Report anticipated that for FY25 threshold vesting for each measure would be 10% 
of maximum. However, the Committee has decided that for FY25 and in line with the approach for 
FY24, threshold vesting will be at 10% of maximum for sales, but remain at 5% of maximum for PBT. 
For on-target performance, and as anticipated in the FY23 Directors’ Remuneration Report, vesting 
will be at 50% of maximum for each measure. 
Nick Wilkinson and Karen Witts have contractually committed that two-thirds of the bonus earned 
(after payment of income tax and National Insurance) will be invested in Dunelm shares, to be held 
for the duration of employment. This is also in line with our Policy. Shares held on termination of 
employment will be retained for up to a minimum of two years as required by the shareholding 
requirements set out in the Policy.
Sir Will Adderley has asked that he not be considered for a bonus award.
LTIP FY25—27
In line with our 2023 Remuneration Policy, an award is expected to be made in October 2024 under 
the LTIP over shares to the value of 225% of salary to Nick Wilkinson and 200% of salary to Karen 
Witts. The award will vest, subject to continued employment, on the third anniversary of the grant 
date, to the extent that performance conditions have been met. All of the vested shares (after sales 
to cover tax and National Insurance liability on exercise) must be retained for two years after vesting, 
after which one-third of these may be sold and the remainder must be retained for the duration of 
employment. Shares held on termination of employment will be retained for a minimum of two 
years as required by the shareholding requirements set out in the Policy. Our current intention is that 
the FY25—27 LTIP awards will be granted in line with our standard approach (with the number of 
shares to be awarded based on the average share price for the three business days preceding 
grant) and we will review the final outturn to ensure that there have not been any windfall gains. This 
is in addition to the performance underpin and review of the final outturn to ensure it is warranted 
based on shareholder experience over the performance period.
The performance criteria that apply to the award were set by the Committee in line with the 2023 
Remuneration Policy as follows:
Performance measures
Percentage of this element of the FY25—27 award vesting1
Nil
Threshold
(10% for  
Diluted EPS 
 and 25% for  
Relative TSR) 
On-target
(50%) 
Maximum 
(100%)
FY27 Diluted EPS (75%)
Less than 
77p
77p
82p
99p
Relative Total Shareholder Return2 (25%)
Below 
median
 Median
n/a
Upper 
quartile
1.	
Performance between each of these percentage thresholds will be calculated on a straight-line basis.
2.	
Relative Total Shareholder Return versus the constituents of the FTSE 350 excluding Financial Services companies and Investment Trusts, 
with a three-month averaging period applied at the start and end of the performance period.
These measures represent a change to previous years, with the introduction of relative total 
shareholder return and transition of specific ESG targets to the annual bonus (see page 90). 
Relative total shareholder return has been introduced with 25% weighting to align management 
and investor experience by way of an external measure of shareholder value as noted in the Chair’s 
letter. The LTIP targets themselves were chosen because they are aligned to our strategy and 
long-term ambitions.
113
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Remuneration Committee report continued
Sharesave
An invitation will be issued in October 2024 to all eligible employees to apply for options to be 
granted under the Sharesave scheme at a 20% discount to the average closing market price of 
Dunelm shares on the three dealing days preceding the issue of the invitation. The maximum 
monthly savings will be £500 per month. Executive Directors employed at the eligibility date may 
apply for Sharesave options, subject to the plan rules.
Non-Executive Directors fees for FY25
Fees for the Non-Executive Directors were increased with effect from 1 August 2024 to the fee 
levels set out below:
Table 16: Non-Executive Directors fees
Position 
Base fee
£
Increase in fee 
YoY
Chair
347,829
2.75%
Non-Executive Director base fee
61,000
3.9%
Audit and Risk Committee Chair
15,000
32.0%
Remuneration Committee Chair1
15,000
32.0%
Senior Independent Director1
11,000
52.4%
1.	
As noted earlier in this report, William Reeve will step down from the Board following the 2024 AGM. He will receive his fee for chairing 
the Remuneration Committee and as Senior Independent Director up to the date of the AGM. Thereafter, Ajay Kavan will receive the fee 
for chairing the Remuneration Committee and Ian Bull will receive the fee for holding the role of Senior Independent Director (in addition 
to fees received for chairing the Audit and Risk Committee).
Statement of shareholder voting at AGM
At the Annual General Meeting on 16 November 2023, the total number of shares in issue with 
voting rights (excluding treasury shares) was 201,949,888. Details of voting on remuneration-related 
resolutions is set out below:
Resolution 
Votes 
for
% of 
votes cast
Votes 
against 
% of 
votes cast
Votes 
withheld 
% 
withheld 
Approve Directors’ 
Remuneration Report
172,705,866
99.35
1,128,014
0.65
6,187,454
3.06
Approve Directors’ 
Remuneration Policy
178,045,253
99.12
1,573,989
0.88
402,092
0.20
Gender pay disclosures
Dunelm’s purpose is ‘To help create the joy of truly feeling at home, now and for generations to 
come.’ We want everyone to feel that Dunelm is a place for them, and this applies equally for our 
colleagues and customers. Diversity, inclusion, and more generally the wellbeing of our colleagues, 
are high on our agenda. We want all colleagues to feel they can grow with Dunelm and that they are 
welcome. Improving our gender balance remains one of our commitments.
The Committee supports gender pay reporting and the actions taken in the business to drive 
gender balance, supporting a culture of inclusion. Dunelm published its seventh Gender Pay Gap 
Report in April 2024, and an overview is provided in our Sustainability Report 2024. Both documents 
are available to download at corporate.dunelm.com.
114
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Remuneration Committee report continued
Engaging with our colleagues on pay
The National Colleague Voice (‘NCV’) allocated a full meeting in May 2024 to a discussion on pay 
and reward. The meeting was well attended by representatives from across the business with a 
36%:64% male/female gender split and ethnic minority representation of 29%. The meeting was led 
by members of our People Team who were joined by Marion Sears, our designated Non-Executive 
Director for colleague matters, and William Reeve, Chair of the Remuneration Committee. It was also 
attended by Ajay Kavan who joined the Board and the Remuneration Committee on 1 March 2024 
and the Group General Counsel and Company Secretary. 
The meeting was arranged in three parts. The first part provided context and background to recent 
decisions on pay and reward, discussed the findings from the ‘pulse’ reward survey conducted in 
April 2024 and included a presentation on our pensions offer. In the second part of the meeting 
attendees separated into breakout groups to discuss feedback from the recent pay review in more 
detail. Discussions highlighted the ongoing cost-of-living pressures faced by our hourly colleagues, 
particularly in stores and notwithstanding the recent salary increase in April 2024. The final part of 
the meeting enabled William Reeve to provide insight into the role of the Remuneration Committee 
and how it operates. He explained how the Committee considers strategy, performance and the 
external environment when setting Executive remuneration and aligns its decision-making with 
our remuneration principles, with a view to ensuring that these principles are applied throughout 
the business. 
A summary of the discussions, questions and responses was shared with the Board, which 
welcomed the openness of the debate and noted management’s desire to find ways to continue 
to improve communication as to the benefits that are on offer and act on the feedback received, 
including how to offer an even more personalised approach within our Employee Value Proposition. 
For more information on the NCV and its other activities during the year see page 22.
Committee effectiveness
The effectiveness of the Committee was considered as part of this year’s Board evaluation process, 
more details of which can be found on page 78. The review concluded that the Committee 
continues to operate effectively and having considered the findings, it was agreed that particular 
areas of focus during the forthcoming year should be: 
1.	Reflecting on measures used to determine performance, alignment of management incentives;
2.	Enabling an effective handover to the new Committee Chair; and
3.	Reviewing papers to ensure succinct presentation of information, utilising templates to ensure 
ongoing simplicity and consistency.
Approved by the Board on 11 September 2024.
William Reeve
Chair of the Remuneration Committee
115
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Directors’ report
The Directors present their report together with the audited financial 
statements for the period ended 29 June 2024.
A final ordinary dividend of 27.5p per share 
(2023: 27p per share) is proposed in respect of the 
period ended 29 June 2024, to add to a special 
dividend of 35p per share paid on 9 April 2024 
(2023: 40p per share) and an interim ordinary 
dividend of 16p per share paid on 9 April 2024 
(2023: 15p per share). The final dividend will be 
paid on 26 November 2024 to shareholders on 
the register on 1 November 2024.
Treasury and risk management
The Group’s approach to treasury and financial 
risk management, including its use of hedging 
instruments, is explained in the Principal Risks 
and Uncertainties section on page 45 and note 
18 of the financial statements.
Stakeholder engagement
Details of how the Directors have engaged with 
employees and other stakeholders, and had 
regard to the interests of colleagues and the 
need to foster the Company’s business 
relationships with suppliers, customers and 
others and the effect of that regard, including 
on the principal decisions taken by the 
Company during the financial year, are set out in 
stakeholder engagement of the Strategic report 
on pages 20 to 24, with complementary 
information in the Governance report on pages 
72 and 73. Our s.172(1) Companies Act 2006 
statement can be found on page 25.
Disclosures that are relevant to the Directors’ 
report have been incorporated by reference 
and can be found elsewhere within the Annual 
Report and Accounts as noted below.
Strategic report
The Group’s Strategic report is set out on pages 
1 to 55. It contains an indication of likely future 
developments in the business of the Company 
and the Group.
Corporate governance
Our Governance report on pages 57 to 120 
explains how we have applied the Principles set 
out in the UK Corporate Governance Code 
published in July 2018 (the ‘Code’). Our Code 
compliance statement can be found on page 59.
Employee information
Information relating to employees of the Group 
is set out in the Nomination Committee report, 
with more information in our Sustainability 
Report 2024.
The Company is clear in its policy that people 
with health conditions, both visible and 
non-visible, will have full and fair consideration 
for all vacancies. Dunelm continues to 
demonstrate its commitment to interviewing 
applicants with disabilities who fulfil the 
minimum criteria for the role and endeavours to 
retain colleagues in roles in the business if they 
become disabled during their employment. 
Dunelm will actively look to put into place 
reasonable adjustments that may be required 
by the colleague to allow them to thrive and 
belong at Dunelm. 
Share incentive schemes in which employees 
participate are described in the Remuneration 
Committee report on page 99.
Shareholder and voting rights
All members who hold Ordinary Shares are 
entitled to attend and vote at the Annual 
General Meeting. On a show of hands at a 
general meeting every member present in 
person shall have one vote and, on a poll, every 
member present in person or by proxy shall 
have one vote for every Ordinary Share held. 
There are no special voting rights attached to 
any of the Company’s shares.
Information to be disclosed under UK 
Listing Rule (‘UKLR’) 6.6.1R
The majority of the disclosures required under 
UKLR 6.6.1R are not applicable to Dunelm. 
The table below sets out the location of those 
requirements that are applicable:
Applicable sub-paragraph  
within UKLR 6.6.1
Disclosure 
provision
(pages)
(3) Long-term incentive schemes 105,106,113
(13) A statement made by the 
Board that the Company 
continues to comply with the 
requirements in UKLR 6.2.3R
‘Shareholder 
and voting 
rights’ below.
Sustainability reporting
For information on the Group’s approach to 
environmental, social and governance matters, 
see Sustainability on pages 32 and 33, our 
TCFD report on pages 46 to 54 which includes 
the Streamlined Energy and Carbon Reporting 
disclosures, and our standalone Sustainability 
Report 2024, available at corporate.dunelm.com.
Results and dividend
The consolidated profit of the Group for the 
year after taxation was £151.2m (2023: £151.9m). 
The results are discussed in more detail in the 
CFO’s review on pages 28 to 31.
116
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Directors’ report continued
In order to be passed, an ordinary resolution of 
the Company must be supported by at least 
50% of the votes cast at a shareholders’ 
meeting, and a special resolution by at least 
75% of votes cast.
On 2 October 2006, Jean Adderley, Bill Adderley 
and Sir Will Adderley (all shareholders at that 
time) entered into a Relationship Agreement 
with the Company, pursuant to which each of 
Jean Adderley, Bill Adderley and Sir Will 
Adderley undertook to the Company that, for 
so long as, individually or together, they are 
entitled to exercise, or to control the exercise 
of, 30% or more of the rights to vote at general 
meetings of the Company or they are able to 
control the appointment of Directors who are 
able to exercise a majority of votes at Board 
meetings of the Company, they will:
•	conduct all transactions and relationships with 
any member of the Group on arm’s length 
terms and on a normal commercial basis;
•	not take any action which precludes or inhibits 
any member of the Group from carrying on its 
business independently of Jean Adderley, Bill 
Adderley, Sir Will Adderley or their associates 
(as defined in the UK Listing Rules);
•	not exercise any of their voting rights or other 
powers to procure any amendment to the 
Articles of Association of the Company which 
would be inconsistent with or undermine any 
of the provisions of the Relationship Agreement; 
•	only enter into, amend or terminate any 
transaction, agreement or relationship 
between themselves or any of their associates 
and any member of the Group with the 
approval of a majority of the independent 
Non-Executive Directors; and
•	not carry on (other than through their holding 
of securities of the Company) or have any 
financial interest (other than a financial interest 
in securities which are held for investment 
purposes only) in any person who carries on a 
business as a homewares retailer, to the extent 
that it would be inconsistent with or undermine 
any provisions of the Relationship Agreement.
WA Capital Limited and Lady Nadine Adderley, 
to whom Sir Will Adderley transferred shares by 
way of a gift, subsequently became parties to 
the Relationship Agreement.
In July 2014, the Relationship Agreement was 
amended so as to comply with amendments to 
the UK Listing Rules and the following additional 
undertakings were given by the parties:
•	no action will be taken that would have the 
effect of preventing the Company from 
complying with its obligations under the UK 
Listing Rules; and
•	no resolution will be proposed, or procured to 
be proposed, which is intended to, or appears 
to be intended to circumvent the proper 
application of the UK Listing Rules. 
In addition, the Articles of Association of the 
Company provide that the election and 
re-election of independent Directors must be 
conducted in accordance with the election 
provisions set out in UKLR 6.2.8R and UKLR 6.2.9R. 
The Company confirms that it has complied with 
its obligations under the Relationship Agreement 
during the financial period under review, and 
that so far as it is aware, all other parties to that 
agreement have complied with it.
The Company confirms that there are no 
contracts of significance between any member 
of the Group and any of the parties to the 
Relationship Agreement, with the exception of 
Sir Will Adderley’s service agreement as a Director 
of the Company, the terms of which are outlined 
in the Remuneration Committee report.
There are no restrictions on the transfer of 
Ordinary Shares in the Company other than 
certain restrictions imposed by laws and 
regulations (such as insider trading and 
marketing requirements relating to closed 
periods) and requirements of the UK Listing 
Rules whereby Directors and certain employees 
of the Company require Board approval to deal 
in the Company’s securities.
Change of control
The Company is not party to any significant 
agreements which take effect, alter or terminate 
solely on a change of control of the Company 
following a takeover bid.
There are no agreements between the 
Company and its Directors or employees 
providing for additional compensation for loss 
of office or employment (whether through 
resignation, redundancy or otherwise) that 
occurs because of a takeover bid.
Details of the rights of employees to exercise 
options on a change of control of the Company 
are set out in the Remuneration Policy found on 
pages 91 to 100 of this report.
Share capital and treasury shares 
The Company has only one class of shares, 
Ordinary Shares of 1p each. As at 29 June 2024, 
its capital comprised 203,426,835 (2023: 
203,426,835) fully paid Ordinary Shares of 
1p each.
At the 2023 Annual General Meeting, 
shareholders renewed the Directors’ authority 
to allot shares in the Company. No shares were 
allotted during the year. A resolution to renew 
the standard authority will be proposed at the 
2024 Annual General Meeting. 
At 29 June 2024, the Company held 1,226,461 
Ordinary Shares in treasury (2023: 1,712,790).
During the year ended 29 June 2024, the 
Company did not purchase shares under 
a buyback authority.
Since the financial year end, 2,286 Ordinary Shares 
have been moved out of treasury to employees 
who exercised options under a share incentive 
scheme. Details of option exercises by Directors 
are set out in the Remuneration Committee 
report on page 108.
	Further details on the Company’s 
share capital are set out in note 21 to the 
financial statements
117
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Directors’ report continued
Substantial shareholders
At 29 June 2024, the Company had been notified under the Disclosure and Transparency Rules 
(DTR 5) of the following notifiable interests in the Company’s issued share capital. The information 
provided below was correct at the date of notification. These holdings are likely to have changed 
since the Company was notified; however, notification of any change is not required until the next 
notifiable threshold is crossed. Between 29 June 2024 and 11 September 2024 (being the date of 
this report) the Company has been notified that JP Morgan Asset Management Holdings Inc now 
holds 10,369,851 Ordinary Shares which equates to 5.13% of the issued share capital.
Notifiable interests
Ordinary shares
Percentage of 
share capital 
disclosed
Date of notification
Sir Will Adderley1
76,371,779
37.8
15 February 2021
Jean Adderley
9,968,500
4.92
7 July 2021
JP Morgan Asset Management Holdings Inc
10,936,894
5.43
11 December 2022
Jupiter Fund Management PLC
10,044,063
4.95
6 January 2022
Royal London Asset Management Limited
9,907,809
4.91
13 July 2018
abrdn plc
9,565,468
4.74
22 March 2018
1.	
This includes: (i) 1,967,250 Ordinary Shares held by the Stoneygate Trust and 172,750 Ordinary Shares held by the Paddocks 
Discretionary Trust, which Sir Will Adderley is deemed to hold a legal interest in by virtue of the fact that he is a trustee of those trusts; 
and (ii) 11,000,000 Ordinary Shares held by his wife, Lady Nadine Adderley.
Directors and officers
The Directors of the Company who served on 
the Board during the year, together with details 
of changes to the Board are set out on page 63. 
The biographies of the Directors on the Board 
at the date of this report are set out on pages 60 
to 62. Details of the interests of the Directors in 
shares of the Company can be found in the 
Annual Report on Remuneration on page 107.
Power of Directors
The business of the Company is managed by 
the Board, which may exercise all the powers of 
the Company, subject to the requirements of 
the Companies Act, the Articles of Association 
of the Company and any special resolution of 
the Company. As stated in the Governance 
report on pages 64 to 66, the Board has 
adopted internal delegations of authority in 
accordance with the Code and these set out 
matters which are reserved to the Board or 
Committees and the powers and duties of 
the Chair, the Deputy Chair and the Chief 
Executive respectively.
Appointment and removal of Directors
The Articles of Association of the Company 
provide that a Director may be appointed 
by ordinary resolution of the Company’s 
shareholders in a general meeting, or by the 
Board so long as the Director stands down and 
offers him or herself for election at the next 
Annual General Meeting of the Company.
The Board’s policy is that all Directors are 
subject to annual re-election and therefore 
should stand down and offer themselves for 
re-election at each Annual General Meeting. 
The Articles also provide that each Director 
must stand down and offer him or herself for 
re-election by shareholders at the Annual 
General Meeting at least every three years.
The Nomination Committee makes 
recommendations to the Board on the 
appointment and removal of Directors.
Directors may be removed by a special 
resolution of shareholders, or by an ordinary 
resolution of which special notice has been 
given in accordance with the Companies Act 
2006. The Articles also provide that the office of 
a Director shall be vacated if they are prohibited 
by law from being a Director or are declared 
bankrupt, and that the Board may resolve that 
his or her office be vacated if he or she is of 
unsound mind or is absent from Board meetings 
without consent for six months or more. 
A Director may also resign from the Board.
118
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Directors’ report continued
Indemnities and insurance
The Company has granted indemnities to each 
of its Directors and the Company Secretary to 
the extent permitted by law in respect of costs 
of defending claims against them and third-
party liabilities. A deed of indemnity in favour of 
each of Ajay Kavan and Dan Taylor was entered 
into during the year following their appointment 
as Non-Executive Directors. 
All indemnities, the provisions of which are 
deemed to be qualifying third-party indemnity 
provisions pursuant to section 234 of the Act, 
were in force throughout FY24 (or, in the case of 
Ajay Kavan and Dan Taylor from the date of their 
respective appointments, and thereafter for the 
remainder of FY24) and remain in force as at the 
date of this report.
A copy of each indemnity is available for 
inspection at the Company’s registered office 
during normal business hours and will be 
available for inspection at the Company’s 
Annual General Meeting.
The Group maintained Directors’ and Officers’ 
liability insurance cover for its Directors and 
officers as permitted under the Company’s 
Articles of Association and the Companies Act 
2006 throughout the financial year.
Managing conflicts of interest and related 
party matters
The Companies Act 2006 allows the board 
of a public company to authorise conflicts and 
potential conflicts of interest of individual 
Directors where the Articles of Association 
contain a provision to that effect. The Company’s 
Articles of Association give the Board this 
authority subject to the following safeguards:
•	Directors who have an interest in matters 
under discussion at a Board meeting must 
declare that interest and abstain from voting;
•	only Directors who have no interest in the 
matter being considered are able to approve 
a conflict of interest and, in taking that 
decision, the Directors must act in a way 
that they consider, in good faith, would be 
most likely to promote the success of the 
Company; and
•	the Directors are able to impose limits or 
conditions when giving authorisation if they 
feel this is appropriate.
Directors are required to disclose any actual 
or potential conflicts of interests to the Board 
immediately when they arise. In addition, a 
formal process is undertaken each year when 
all Directors confirm to the Board details of any 
other directorships and confirm relevant 
information in connection with related parties. 
Further to the above, the Board believes that it 
has effective procedures in place to monitor 
and manage conflicts of interest and ensure that 
any related party transactions involving Directors 
or their connected persons are conducted on 
an arm’s length basis.
Donations
The Group does not make any political donations.
Public policy
We are members of the British Retail 
Consortium and support relevant campaigning 
activity by that body. During the year we have 
not taken part in any direct lobbying or public 
policy activity.
Articles of Association
The Company’s Articles of Association may only 
be amended, or new articles adopted, by a 
special resolution of shareholders.
Independent auditors 
In accordance with section 489 of the 
Companies Act 2006 and the recommendation 
of the Audit and Risk Committee, a resolution 
will be proposed at the 2024 AGM to reappoint 
PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP as the external 
auditor of the Group.
Important events since 29 June 2024
There have been no important events affecting the 
Company or any subsidiary since 29 June 2024.
Disclaimer 
This Directors’ report, the Strategic report 
and the financial statements contain certain 
forward-looking statements with respect to 
the financial condition, results, operations and 
business of Dunelm Group plc. These statements 
and forecasts involve risk and uncertainty 
because they relate to events and depend 
upon circumstances that will occur in the future. 
There are a number of factors that could cause 
actual results or developments to differ materially 
from those expressed or implied by these 
forward-looking statements and forecasts. 
Nothing in this Directors’ report, the Strategic 
report or in the financial statements should be 
construed as a profit forecast.
This document also contains non-financial 
information and data. While reasonable steps 
have been taken to ensure that this is correct, 
it has not been externally audited or verified 
unless specifically stated in this document.
Annual General Meeting
The 2024 Annual General Meeting will be held 
at Dunelm Store Support Centre, Watermead 
Business Park, Syston, Leicester, Leicestershire, 
LE7 1AD on Thursday 21 November 2024 
at 11:30am.
A formal notice of meeting, explanatory notes 
and a form of proxy will accompany this Annual 
Report and financial statements.
This report was reviewed and signed by order 
of the Board on 11 September 2024.
Luisa Wright
Company Secretary
11 September 2024
119
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Statement of Directors’ responsibilities 
in respect of the financial statements 
The Directors are responsible for preparing the 
Annual Report and Accounts 2024 in accordance 
with applicable law and regulation.
Company law requires the Directors to prepare 
financial statements for each financial year. 
Under that law, the Directors have prepared the 
Group financial statements in accordance with 
UK-adopted international accounting standards 
and the parent company financial statements in 
accordance with United Kingdom Generally 
Accepted Accounting Practice (United Kingdom 
Accounting Standards, comprising FRS 101 
‘Reduced Disclosure Framework’), and 
applicable law.
Under company law, Directors must not 
approve the financial statements unless they are 
satisfied that they give a true and fair view of the 
state of affairs of the Group and parent 
company and of the profit or loss of the Group 
for that period. In preparing the financial 
statements, the Directors are required to:
•	select suitable accounting policies and then 
apply them consistently;
•	state whether applicable UK-adopted 
international accounting standards have been 
followed for the Group financial statements 
and United Kingdom Accounting Standards, 
comprising FRS 101, have been followed for 
the parent company financial statements, 
subject to any material departures disclosed 
and explained in the financial statements;
•	make judgements and accounting estimates 
that are reasonable and prudent; and
•	prepare the financial statements on the going 
concern basis unless it is inappropriate to 
presume that the Group and parent company 
will continue in business.
The Directors are responsible for safeguarding 
the assets of the Group and parent company 
and hence for taking reasonable steps for the 
prevention and detection of fraud and other 
irregularities.
The Directors are also responsible for keeping 
adequate accounting records that are sufficient 
to show and explain the Group’s and parent 
company’s transactions and disclose with 
reasonable accuracy at any time the financial 
position of the Group and parent company and 
enable them to ensure that the financial 
statements and the Directors’ Remuneration 
Report comply with the Companies Act 2006.
The Directors are responsible for the 
maintenance and integrity of the parent 
company’s website. Legislation in the United 
Kingdom governing the preparation and 
dissemination of financial statements may 
differ from legislation in other jurisdictions. 
Directors’ confirmations
Each of the Directors, whose names and 
functions are listed in the Governance report 
confirm that, to the best of their knowledge:
•	the Group financial statements, which have 
been prepared in accordance with UK-
adopted international accounting standards, 
give a true and fair view of the assets, 
liabilities, financial position and profit of 
the Group;
•	the parent company financial statements, 
which have been prepared in accordance with 
United Kingdom Accounting Standards, 
comprising FRS 101, give a true and fair view 
of the assets, liabilities and financial position 
of the parent company; and
•	the Strategic report includes a fair review of 
the development and performance of the 
business and the position of the Group and 
parent company, together with a description 
of the principal risks and uncertainties that 
it faces.
Disclosure of information to the auditor 
Each Director in office at the date on which the 
Directors’ report is approved confirms that:
•	so far as the Directors are aware, there is no 
relevant audit information of which the auditor 
is unaware; and 
•	the Directors have taken all the steps that they 
ought to have taken as Directors to make 
themselves aware of any relevant audit 
information and to establish that the auditor 
is aware of that information.
Nick Wilkinson
Chief Executive Officer
11 September 2024
120
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Financial 
Statements
122	
Independent auditors’ report
128	
Consolidated financial statements
151	
Parent company financial statements
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information
121

Independent auditors’ report
to the members of Dunelm Group plc
Report on the audit of the financial statements
Opinion
In our opinion:
•	Dunelm Group plc’s group financial statements and parent company financial statements 
(the “financial statements”) give a true and fair view of the state of the group’s and of the parent 
company’s affairs as at 29 June 2024 and of the group’s profit and the group’s cash flows for the 
52 week period then ended;
•	the group financial statements have been properly prepared in accordance with UK-adopted 
international accounting standards as applied in accordance with the provisions of the 
Companies Act 2006;
•	the parent company financial statements have been properly prepared in accordance with 
United Kingdom Generally Accepted Accounting Practice (United Kingdom Accounting 
Standards, including FRS 101 “Reduced Disclosure Framework”, and applicable law); and
•	the financial statements have been prepared in accordance with the requirements of the 
Companies Act 2006.
We have audited the financial statements, included within the Annual Report and Accounts (the 
“Annual Report”), which comprise: the Consolidated Statement of Financial Position and Parent 
Company Statement of Financial Position as at 29 June 2024; the Consolidated Income Statement, 
Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income, Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows, 
Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity and Parent Company Statement of Changes in 
Equity for the period then ended; the Consolidated Accounting Policies and Parent Company 
Accounting Policies; and the notes to the financial statements.
Our opinion is consistent with our reporting to the Audit and Risk Committee.
Basis for opinion
We conducted our audit in accordance with International Standards on Auditing (UK) (“ISAs (UK)”) 
and applicable law. Our responsibilities under ISAs (UK) are further described in the Auditors’ 
responsibilities for the audit of the financial statements section of our report. We believe that the 
audit evidence we have obtained is sufficient and appropriate to provide a basis for our opinion.
Independence
We remained independent of the group in accordance with the ethical requirements that are 
relevant to our audit of the financial statements in the UK, which includes the FRC’s Ethical 
Standard, as applicable to listed public interest entities, and we have fulfilled our other ethical 
responsibilities in accordance with these requirements.
To the best of our knowledge and belief, we declare that non-audit services prohibited by the 
FRC’s Ethical Standard were not provided.
Other than those disclosed in note 3, we have provided no non-audit services to the parent 
company or its controlled undertakings in the period under audit.
Our audit approach
Overview
Audit scope
•	The group is structured with one segment which comprises a consolidation of the parent 
company and eight additional components.
•	For the purposes of the group financial statements, we conducted an audit of the complete 
financial information of one financially significant component, together with additional 
procedures performed centrally including auditing the group consolidation.
•	We separately audited the parent company financial statements.
Key audit matters
•	Inventory provisions (group)
•	Recoverability of investments in subsidiary undertakings (parent)
Materiality
•	Overall group materiality: £10,300,000 (2023: £9,635,000) based on 5% of profit before tax.
•	Overall parent company materiality: £1,550,000 (2023: £2,300,000) based on 1% of total assets.
•	Performance materiality: £7,700,000 (2023: £7,225,000) (group) and £1,150,000 (2023: 
£1,725,000) (parent company).
The scope of our audit
As part of designing our audit, we determined materiality and assessed the risks of material 
misstatement in the financial statements.
Key audit matters
Key audit matters are those matters that, in the auditors’ professional judgement, were of most 
significance in the audit of the financial statements of the current period and include the most 
significant assessed risks of material misstatement (whether or not due to fraud) identified by the 
auditors, including those which had the greatest effect on: the overall audit strategy; the allocation 
of resources in the audit; and directing the efforts of the engagement team. These matters, and 
any comments we make on the results of our procedures thereon, were addressed in the context 
of our audit of the financial statements as a whole, and in forming our opinion thereon, and we do 
not provide a separate opinion on these matters.
This is not a complete list of all risks identified by our audit.
122
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Independent auditors’ report continued
The key audit matters below are consistent with last year.
Key audit matter
How our audit addressed the key audit matter
Inventory provisions (group)
Refer to the Audit and Risk Committee Report, the Accounting Policies, Note 3 (Operating Profit) 
and Note 13 (Inventories) to the Consolidated Financial Statements. Inventory represents a significant 
asset on the Group’s balance sheet and is carried at the lower of cost and net realisable value 
(“NRV”). The Group’s accounting policy is to determine a provision based upon: the historic negative 
margin of the type of inventory, by ageing category, which is calculated by analysing the historic 
sales price compared to the cost of inventory, and applying a percentage provision to each line of 
inventory; and a further provision for ‘at risk’ lines where the calculated provision was not considered 
to be sufficient.
We tested sales made post period-end to assess whether inventory items were held at the lower 
of cost and NRV.
We examined inventory write-offs in the financial period to assess whether they are consistent with 
the key assumptions used in the inventory provision model at the year end.
We tested the inputs to the provision calculation, including the classification of inventory and sales 
data for each of the ageing categories from the Buying department, which is segregated from the 
Finance department. 
We tested the average cost of inventory by agreeing a sample of inputs to source documentation 
and testing freight and duty costs.
We tested the integrity of the provision model to ensure that it was using the underlying data 
correctly and calculating provision amounts accurately.
We challenged management’s assumptions on what they deemed the ‘at risk’ inventory lines were, 
and corroborated whether these lines were at risk with the Merchandising team. 
We also independently challenged the completeness of the ‘at risk’ lines based on our 
understanding of the nature of the group’s inventory lines.
We found that the NRV provision recognised against inventory was consistent with the 
evidence obtained.
Recoverability of investments in subsidiary undertakings (parent) 
Refer to note 4 (Investments) to the Parent Company Financial Statements. In accordance with IAS 36 
(Impairment of assets), the Parent Company’s investments balance of £72.5m (FY23: £68.8m) should 
be carried at no more than its recoverable amount, being the higher of fair value less costs to sell 
and its value in use. IAS 36 requires an entity to determine whether there are indications that an 
impairment loss may have occurred and if so, make a formal estimate of the recoverable amount.
We evaluated whether there are any indications that an impairment loss may have occurred in relation 
to the Parent Company’s investments balance with specific consideration given to the following:
•	the market capitalisation of the Group is significantly in excess of the investments balance, 
noting that substantially all of the market capitalisation is considered to be in relation to one 
indirect subsidiary (Dunelm (Soft Furnishings) Ltd) of the Parent Company;
•	the trading results of Dunelm (Soft Furnishings) Ltd are not worse than expected and are not 
expected to be worse in future periods; and 
•	there have not been and are not expected to be any significant changes with an adverse impact 
in relation to the technological, market, economic or legal environment in which this indirect 
subsidiary operates.
We consider management’s conclusion that there are no indicators of impairment to be appropriate.
123
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Independent auditors’ report continued
How we tailored the audit scope
We tailored the scope of our audit to ensure that we performed enough work to be able to give 
an opinion on the financial statements as a whole, taking into account the structure of the group 
and the parent company, the accounting processes and controls, and the industry in which they 
operate.
The group is structured with one reporting segment which comprises a consolidation of the 
parent company and eight additional components.
In establishing the overall approach to the group audit, we identified one component: Dunelm 
(Soft Furnishings) Ltd, which, as the sole trading legal entity in the Group, required an audit of its 
complete financial information due to its financial significance to the group.
Further specific audit procedures over central functions including the Group consolidation, equity 
and taxes were performed.
All audit procedures were performed by the Group Engagement Team. The scoping above gave 
us the evidence we needed for our opinion on the group financial statements as a whole.
The Parent Company is comprised of one component which was subject to a full scope audit for 
the purposes of the Parent Company financial statements.
The impact of climate risk on our audit
As part of our audit we made enquiries of management to understand the process adopted to 
assess the extent of the potential impact of climate risk on the financial statements and to support 
the disclosures made within the Annual Report.
Our risk assessment was based on enquiry, as well as the review of Dunelm’s corporate 
responsibility reporting and climate related commitments. As detailed in the group accounting 
policies, management considers that there is no material risk to the financial statements in respect 
of climate change.
We challenged, based on our knowledge of the business, the impact of climate risk on right-of-use 
assets and property, plant and equipment, which were considered to be the assets at most risk of 
the effects of climate change.
We also considered the consistency of the disclosures in relation to climate change (including the 
disclosures in the Task Force on Climate-related Financial Disclosures (TCFD) section) within the 
Annual Report with the financial statements and our knowledge obtained from our audit.
Our procedures did not identify any material impact in the context of our audit of the financial 
statements as a whole, or our key audit matters for the 52 week period ended 29 June 2024.
Materiality
The scope of our audit was influenced by our application of materiality. We set certain quantitative 
thresholds for materiality. These, together with qualitative considerations, helped us to determine 
the scope of our audit and the nature, timing and extent of our audit procedures on the individual 
financial statement line items and disclosures and in evaluating the effect of misstatements, both 
individually and in aggregate on the financial statements as a whole.
Based on our professional judgement, we determined materiality for the financial statements 
as a whole as follows:
Financial statements — group
Financial statements — parent company
Overall materiality
£10,300,000 (2023: £9,635,000).
£1,550,000 (2023: £2,300,000).
How we determined it
5% of profit before tax
1% of total assets
Rationale for benchmark 
applied
Profit before tax is the primary 
measure used by the 
shareholders in assessing the 
performance of the group 
and is a generally accepted 
auditing benchmark.
The parent company does not 
trade and therefore total assets 
is considered to be the most 
appropriate benchmark.
For the component in the scope of our group audit, we allocated a materiality that is less than our 
overall group materiality.
We use performance materiality to reduce to an appropriately low level the probability that the 
aggregate of uncorrected and undetected misstatements exceeds overall materiality. Specifically, 
we use performance materiality in determining the scope of our audit and the nature and extent 
of our testing of account balances, classes of transactions and disclosures, for example in 
determining sample sizes. Our performance materiality was 75% (2023: 75%) of overall materiality, 
amounting to £7,700,000 (2023: £7,225,000) for the group financial statements and £1,150,000 
(2023: £1,725,000) for the parent company financial statements.
In determining the performance materiality, we considered a number of factors — the history of 
misstatements, risk assessment and aggregation risk and the effectiveness of controls — and 
concluded that an amount at the upper end of our normal range was appropriate.
We agreed with the Audit and Risk Committee that we would report to them misstatements 
identified during our audit above £500,000 (group audit) (2023: £480,000) and £75,000 (parent 
company audit) (2023: £115,000) as well as misstatements below those amounts that, in our view, 
warranted reporting for qualitative reasons.
124
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Independent auditors’ report continued
Conclusions relating to going concern
Our evaluation of the directors’ assessment of the group’s and the parent company’s ability to 
continue to adopt the going concern basis of accounting included:
•	We obtained management’s going concern assessment and ensured that this was consistent 
with board approved budgets;
•	We have evaluated management’s forecasting accuracy based on historical budgets versus 
actual performance;
•	We obtained confirmation from lenders of the level of drawn and undrawn revolving credit 
facilities and tested the actual and forecast covenant compliance associated with these facilities; 
•	We considered the mitigating actions available to Dunelm to increase liquidity, if required, 
with the key actions being reductions in stock purchases and capex, as well as cessation of 
dividends; and
•	We assessed the adequacy of the going concern disclosures in the accounting policies.
Based on the work we have performed, we have not identified any material uncertainties relating 
to events or conditions that, individually or collectively, may cast significant doubt on the group’s 
and the parent company’s ability to continue as a going concern for a period of at least twelve 
months from when the financial statements are authorised for issue.
In auditing the financial statements, we have concluded that the directors’ use of the going 
concern basis of accounting in the preparation of the financial statements is appropriate.
However, because not all future events or conditions can be predicted, this conclusion is not a 
guarantee as to the group’s and the parent company’s ability to continue as a going concern.
In relation to the directors’ reporting on how they have applied the UK Corporate Governance 
Code, we have nothing material to add or draw attention to in relation to the directors’ statement 
in the financial statements about whether the directors considered it appropriate to adopt the 
going concern basis of accounting.
Our responsibilities and the responsibilities of the directors with respect to going concern are 
described in the relevant sections of this report.
Reporting on other information
The other information comprises all of the information in the Annual Report other than the 
financial statements and our auditors’ report thereon. The directors are responsible for the other 
information. Our opinion on the financial statements does not cover the other information and, 
accordingly, we do not express an audit opinion or, except to the extent otherwise explicitly stated 
in this report, any form of assurance thereon.
In connection with our audit of the financial statements, our responsibility is to read the other 
information and, in doing so, consider whether the other information is materially inconsistent 
with the financial statements or our knowledge obtained in the audit, or otherwise appears to be 
materially misstated. If we identify an apparent material inconsistency or material misstatement, 
we are required to perform procedures to conclude whether there is a material misstatement of 
the financial statements or a material misstatement of the other information. If, based on the work 
we have performed, we conclude that there is a material misstatement of this other information, 
we are required to report that fact. We have nothing to report based on these responsibilities.
With respect to the Strategic report and Directors’ Report, we also considered whether the 
disclosures required by the UK Companies Act 2006 have been included.
Based on our work undertaken in the course of the audit, the Companies Act 2006 requires us 
also to report certain opinions and matters as described below.
Strategic report and Directors’ Report
In our opinion, based on the work undertaken in the course of the audit, the information given in 
the Strategic report and Directors’ Report for the period ended 29 June 2024 is consistent with 
the financial statements and has been prepared in accordance with applicable legal requirements.
In light of the knowledge and understanding of the group and parent company and their 
environment obtained in the course of the audit, we did not identify any material misstatements 
in the Strategic report and Directors’ Report.
Directors’ Remuneration
In our opinion, the part of the Remuneration Committee report to be audited has been properly 
prepared in accordance with the Companies Act 2006.
Corporate governance statement
The Listing Rules require us to review the directors’ statements in relation to going concern, 
longer-term viability and that part of the corporate governance statement relating to the parent 
company’s compliance with the provisions of the UK Corporate Governance Code specified for 
our review. Our additional responsibilities with respect to the corporate governance statement as 
other information are described in the Reporting on other information section of this report.
125
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Independent auditors’ report continued
Based on the work undertaken as part of our audit, we have concluded that each of the following 
elements of the corporate governance statement, included within the Strategic report and 
Governance report is materially consistent with the financial statements and our knowledge 
obtained during the audit, and we have nothing material to add or draw attention to in relation to:
•	The directors’ confirmation that they have carried out a robust assessment of the emerging and 
principal risks;
•	The disclosures in the Annual Report that describe those principal risks, what procedures 
are in place to identify emerging risks and an explanation of how these are being managed 
or mitigated;
•	The directors’ statement in the financial statements about whether they considered it 
appropriate to adopt the going concern basis of accounting in preparing them, and their 
identification of any material uncertainties to the group’s and parent company’s ability to 
continue to do so over a period of at least twelve months from the date of approval of the 
financial statements;
•	The directors’ explanation as to their assessment of the group’s and parent company’s 
prospects, the period this assessment covers and why the period is appropriate; and
•	The directors’ statement as to whether they have a reasonable expectation that the parent 
company will be able to continue in operation and meet its liabilities as they fall due over the 
period of its assessment, including any related disclosures drawing attention to any necessary 
qualifications or assumptions.
Our review of the directors’ statement regarding the longer-term viability of the group and parent 
company was substantially less in scope than an audit and only consisted of making inquiries and 
considering the directors’ process supporting their statement; checking that the statement is in 
alignment with the relevant provisions of the UK Corporate Governance Code; and considering 
whether the statement is consistent with the financial statements and our knowledge and 
understanding of the group and parent company and their environment obtained in the course 
of the audit.
In addition, based on the work undertaken as part of our audit, we have concluded that each of 
the following elements of the corporate governance statement is materially consistent with the 
financial statements and our knowledge obtained during the audit:
•	The directors’ statement that they consider the Annual Report, taken as a whole, is fair, balanced 
and understandable, and provides the information necessary for the members to assess the 
group’s and parent company’s position, performance, business model and strategy;
•	The section of the Annual Report that describes the review of effectiveness of risk management 
and internal control systems; and
•	The section of the Annual Report describing the work of the Audit and Risk Committee.
We have nothing to report in respect of our responsibility to report when the directors’ statement 
relating to the parent company’s compliance with the Code does not properly disclose a departure 
from a relevant provision of the Code specified under the Listing Rules for review by the auditors.
Responsibilities for the financial statements and the audit
Responsibilities of the directors for the financial statements
As explained more fully in the Statement of directors’ responsibilities in respect of the financial 
statements, the directors are responsible for the preparation of the financial statements in 
accordance with the applicable framework and for being satisfied that they give a true and fair 
view. The directors are also responsible for such internal control as they determine is necessary to 
enable the preparation of financial statements that are free from material misstatement, whether 
due to fraud or error.
In preparing the financial statements, the directors are responsible for assessing the group’s and 
the parent company’s ability to continue as a going concern, disclosing, as applicable, matters 
related to going concern and using the going concern basis of accounting unless the directors 
either intend to liquidate the group or the parent company or to cease operations, or have no 
realistic alternative but to do so.
Auditors’ responsibilities for the audit of the financial statements
Our objectives are to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements as a 
whole are free from material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error, and to issue an auditors’ 
report that includes our opinion. Reasonable assurance is a high level of assurance, but is not a 
guarantee that an audit conducted in accordance with ISAs (UK) will always detect a material 
misstatement when it exists. Misstatements can arise from fraud or error and are considered 
material if, individually or in the aggregate, they could reasonably be expected to influence the 
economic decisions of users taken on the basis of these financial statements.
Irregularities, including fraud, are instances of non-compliance with laws and regulations. We 
design procedures in line with our responsibilities, outlined above, to detect material misstatements 
in respect of irregularities, including fraud. The extent to which our procedures are capable of 
detecting irregularities, including fraud, is detailed below.
Based on our understanding of the group and industry, we identified that the principal risks of 
non-compliance with laws and regulations related to employment regulations, and we considered 
the extent to which non-compliance might have a material effect on the financial statements. We 
also considered those laws and regulations that have a direct impact on the financial statements such 
as the Companies Act 2006 and taxation. We evaluated management’s incentives and opportunities 
for fraudulent manipulation of the financial statements (including the risk of override of controls), 
and determined that the principal risks were related to the posting of journals with unexpected 
account combinations, which manipulate revenue or profits, and management bias in accounting 
estimates and judgements. Audit procedures performed by the engagement team included:
•	Discussions with management, internal audit and the Company Secretary, including 
consideration of known or suspected instances of non-compliance with laws and regulation 
and fraud;
•	Assessment of matters reported on the Group’s whistleblowing log;
126
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Independent auditors’ report continued
•	Searches for news articles which would highlight potential non-compliance with laws 
and regulations;
•	Identifying and testing journal entries, in particular journal entries posted with unusual 
account combinations which manipulate revenue or profits; and
•	Challenging assumptions and judgements made by management in their significant 
accounting estimates and judgements, in particular in relation to inventory provisions 
(see related key audit matter).
There are inherent limitations in the audit procedures described above. We are less likely to 
become aware of instances of non-compliance with laws and regulations that are not closely 
related to events and transactions reflected in the financial statements. Also, the risk of not 
detecting a material misstatement due to fraud is higher than the risk of not detecting one 
resulting from error, as fraud may involve deliberate concealment by, for example, forgery or 
intentional misrepresentations, or through collusion.
Our audit testing might include testing complete populations of certain transactions and balances, 
possibly using data auditing techniques. However, it typically involves selecting a limited number 
of items for testing, rather than testing complete populations. We will often seek to target 
particular items for testing based on their size or risk characteristics. In other cases, we will use 
audit sampling to enable us to draw a conclusion about the population from which the sample 
is selected.
A further description of our responsibilities for the audit of the financial statements is located on 
the FRC’s website at: www.frc.org.uk/auditorsresponsibilities. This description forms part of our 
auditors’ report.
Use of this report
This report, including the opinions, has been prepared for and only for the parent company’s 
members as a body in accordance with Chapter 3 of Part 16 of the Companies Act 2006 and for 
no other purpose. We do not, in giving these opinions, accept or assume responsibility for any 
other purpose or to any other person to whom this report is shown or into whose hands it may 
come save where expressly agreed by our prior consent in writing.
Other required reporting
Companies Act 2006 exception reporting
Under the Companies Act 2006 we are required to report to you if, in our opinion:
•	we have not obtained all the information and explanations we require for our audit; or
•	adequate accounting records have not been kept by the parent company, or returns adequate 
for our audit have not been received from branches not visited by us; or
•	certain disclosures of directors’ remuneration specified by law are not made; or
•	the parent company financial statements and the part of the Remuneration Committee report 
to be audited are not in agreement with the accounting records and returns.
We have no exceptions to report arising from this responsibility.
Appointment
Following the recommendation of the Audit and Risk Committee, we were appointed by the 
members on 14 January 2014 to audit the financial statements for the year ended 28 June 2014 
and subsequent financial periods. The period of total uninterrupted engagement is eleven years, 
covering the years ended 28 June 2014 to 29 June 2024.
Other matter
The company is required by the Financial Conduct Authority Disclosure Guidance and 
Transparency Rules to include these financial statements in an annual financial report prepared 
under the structured digital format required by DTR 4.1.15R — 4.1.18R and filed on the National 
Storage Mechanism of the Financial Conduct Authority. This auditors’ report provides no 
assurance over whether the structured digital format annual financial report has been prepared 
in accordance with those requirements.
Gillian Hinks 
(Senior Statutory Auditor)
for and on behalf of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP
Chartered Accountants and Statutory Auditors
East Midlands
11 September 2024
127
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Consolidated Income Statement
For the 52 weeks ended 29 June 2024
Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income
For the 52 weeks ended 29 June 2024
Note
2024
52 weeks
£’m
2023
52 weeks
£’m
Revenue
1
1,706.5 
1,638.8 
Cost of sales
(823.2)
(817.9)
Gross profit
883.3 
820.9 
Operating costs
2
(670.0)
(622.1)
Operating profit
3
213.3 
198.8 
Financial income
5
2.0 
1.7 
Financial expenses
5
(9.9)
(7.8)
Profit before taxation
205.4 
192.7 
Taxation
6
(54.2)
(40.8)
Profit for the period
151.2 
151.9 
Earnings per Ordinary Share — basic
8
74.7p
75.2p
Earnings per Ordinary Share — diluted
8
74.4p
75.0p
Note
2024
52 weeks
£’m
2023
52 weeks
£’m
Profit for the period
151.2 
151.9 
Other comprehensive income/(expense):
Items that may be subsequently reclassified to profit or loss:
Movement in fair value of cash flow hedges
18
0.2
(14.0) 
Deferred tax on hedging movements
13
(1.0)
6.6
Other comprehensive Income/(expense) for the period, 
net of tax
(0.8) 
(7.4) 
Total comprehensive income for the period
150.4
144.5
128
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Consolidated Statement of Financial Position
As at 29 June 2024
Note
29 June
2024
£’m
1 July 
2023
£’m
Non-current assets
 
Intangible assets
9
3.8 
5.3 
Property, plant and equipment
10
173.0 
169.9 
Right-of-use assets
11
222.9 
231.3 
Investment property
12
7.5
—
Deferred tax assets
13
1.8 
6.9 
Derivative financial instruments
18
0.1 
— 
Total non-current assets
 
409.1 
413.4 
Current assets
Inventories
14
223.0 
211.0 
Trade and other receivables
15
26.2 
24.3 
Derivative financial instruments
18
0.3 
1.8 
Cash and cash equivalents
16
23.4 
46.3 
Total current assets
 
272.9 
283.4 
Total assets
 
682.0 
696.8 
Current liabilities
 
Trade and other payables
17
(205.0)
(208.1)
Lease liabilities
11
(52.1)
(53.4)
Current tax liability
(1.5)
(0.2)
Derivative financial instruments
18
(4.9)
(7.9)
Total current liabilities
 
(263.5)
(269.6)
Non-current liabilities
 
Bank loans
19
(77.0)
(75.9)
Lease liabilities
11
(197.5)
(204.8)
Provisions
20
(5.5)
(5.9)
Derivative financial instruments
18
(0.6)
(3.1)
Total non-current liabilities
 
(280.6)
(289.7)
Total liabilities
 
(544.1)
(559.3)
Net assets
 
137.9 
137.5 
Note
29 June
2024
£’m
1 July 
2023
£’m
Equity
 
Issued share capital
21
2.0 
2.0 
Share premium account
 
1.7 
1.7 
Capital redemption reserve
 
43.2 
43.2 
Hedging reserve
 
(3.8)
(6.9)
Retained earnings
 
94.8 
97.5 
Total equity attributable to equity holders of the Parent
 
137.9 
137.5 
The financial statements on pages 128 to 151 were approved by the Board of Directors on 
11 September 2024 and were signed on its behalf by:
Karen Witts
Chief Financial Officer
11 September 2024
129
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows
For the 52 weeks ended 29 June 2024
Note
2024
52 weeks
£’m
2023
52 weeks
£’m
Cash flows from operating activities
 
Profit before taxation
 
205.4 
192.7 
Net financial expense
5
7.9 
6.1 
Operating profit
 
213.3 
198.8 
Depreciation and amortisation of property, plant and 
equipment and intangible assets
3
30.4 
29.8 
Depreciation of right-of-use assets
3
50.2 
49.3 
Loss on disposal and impairment of property, plant and 
equipment and intangible assets
3
0.5 
0.3
Impairment of right-of-use assets
3
0.9 
— 
Share-based payments expense
4.3 
4.8 
Operating cash flows before movements in working 
capital
 
299.6 
283.0 
(Increase)/decrease in inventories
 
(12.0) 
12.0 
Increase in trade and other receivables
 
(1.9)
(1.6)
Decrease in trade and other payables
 
(3.8)
(14.6)
Net movement in working capital
(17.7)
(4.2)
Tax paid
(49.6)
(38.2)
Net cash generated from operating activities
232.3 
240.6 
Cash flows from investing activities
 
 
Acquisition of intangible assets
(2.6)
(0.4)
Acquisition of property, plant and equipment
(29.8)
(21.4)
Acquisition of Investment Property
(7.5)
—
Interest received
1.6 
1.1 
Net cash used in investing activities
(38.3)
(20.7)
Note
2024
52 weeks
£’m
2023
52 weeks
£’m
Cash flows from financing activities
 
 
 
Proceeds from issue of treasury shares and Ordinary 
Shares
22
0.1 
2.4 
Purchase of treasury shares
22
—
(7.0)
Drawdowns on Revolving Credit Facility
 
110.0 
139.0 
Repayments of Revolving Credit Facility
 
(108.0)
(116.0)
Interest paid and loan transaction costs
 
(4.9)
(2.2)
Interest paid on lease liabilities
11
(6.1)
(5.3)
Repayment of principal element of lease liabilities
 
(50.8)
(52.0)
Dividends paid
7
(157.6)
(163.3)
Net cash used in financing activities
 
(217.3)
(204.4)
Net (decrease)/increase in cash and cash equivalents
 
(23.3) 
15.5 
Foreign exchange revaluations
5
0.4 
0.6 
Cash and cash equivalents at the beginning of the 
period
16
46.3 
30.2 
Cash and cash equivalents at the end of the period
16
23.4 
46.3 
130
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity
For the 52 weeks ended 29 June 2024
Note
Issued 
share 
capital
£’m
Share 
premium 
account
£’m
Capital 
redemption 
reserve
£’m
Hedging 
reserve
£’m
Retained 
earnings
£’m
Total equity 
attributable 
to equity 
holders of 
the Parent
£’m
As at 2 July 2022
 
2.0 
1.7 
43.2 
20.2 
111.2 
178.3 
Profit for the period
—
—
—
—
151.9 
151.9 
Movement in fair value of 
cash flow hedges
18
—
—
—
(14.0)
—
(14.0) 
Deferred tax on hedging 
movements
13
—
—
—
6.6 
—
6.6 
Total comprehensive 
income for the period
 
—
—
—
(7.4)
151.9 
144.5 
Proceeds from issue of 
treasury shares
22
—
—
—
—
2.4 
2.4 
Purchase of treasury shares
22
—
—
—
—
(7.0)
(7.0)
Share-based payments
 23
—
—
—
—
4.8 
4.8 
Deferred tax on share-based 
payments
13
—
—
—
—
(3.1)
(3.1)
Current tax on share options 
exercised
 
—
—
—
—
0.6 
0.6 
Movement on cash flow 
hedges transferred to 
inventory
18
—
—
—
(19.7)
—
(19.7)
Ordinary dividends paid
7
—
—
—
—
(163.3)
(163.3)
Total transactions with 
owners, recorded directly 
in equity
 
—
—
—
(19.7)
(165.6)
(185.3)
Note
Issued 
share 
capital
£’m
Share 
premium 
account
£’m
Capital 
redemption 
reserve
£’m
Hedging 
reserve
£’m
Retained 
earnings
£’m
Total equity 
attributable 
to equity 
holders of 
the Parent
£’m
As at 1 July 2023
 
2.0 
1.7 
43.2 
(6.9)
97.5 
137.5 
Profit for the period
—
—
—
—
151.2
151.2 
Movement in fair value of 
cash flow hedges
18
—
—
—
0.2
—
0.2
Deferred tax on hedging 
movements
13
—
—
—
(1.0) 
—
(1.0) 
Total comprehensive 
income for the period
 
—
—
—
(0.8)
151.2
150.4
Proceeds from issue of 
treasury shares
22
—
—
—
—
0.1 
0.1 
Purchase of treasury shares
22
—
—
—
—
—
—
Share-based payments
 23
—
—
—
—
4.3 
4.3 
Deferred tax on share-based 
payments
13
—
—
—
—
(1.3)
(1.3)
Current tax on share options 
exercised
 
—
—
—
—
0.6 
0.6 
Movement on cash flow 
hedges transferred to 
inventory
18
—
—
—
3.9
—
3.9
Ordinary dividends paid
7
—
—
—
—
(157.6)
(157.6)
Total transactions with 
owners, recorded directly 
in equity
 
—
—
—
3.9
(153.9)
(150.0)
As at 29 June 2024
 
2.0 
1.7 
43.2 
(3.8)
94.8 
137.9 
131
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Consolidated Accounting Policies
For the 52 weeks ended 29 June 2024
General information
The Group financial statements consolidate those of Dunelm Group plc (‘the Company’) and its 
subsidiaries (together referred to as ‘the Group’). The Company financial statements on pages 128 
to 151 present information about the Company as a separate entity and not about its Group.
Dunelm Group plc and its subsidiaries are incorporated and domiciled in the UK, and registered 
in England and Wales. Dunelm Group plc is a listed public Company, limited by shares and the 
Company registration number is 04708277. The registered office is Dunelm Store Support Centre, 
Watermead Business Park, Syston, Leicester, Leicestershire, England, LE7 1AD. 
The primary business activity of the Group is the sale of homewares in the UK in stores and online. 
Basis of preparation
The financial statements presented cover a 52-week trading period for the financial period ended 
29 June 2024 (2023: 52-week period ended 1 July 2023).
The financial statements of Dunelm Group plc have been prepared in accordance with 
UK‑adopted International Accounting Standards and with the requirements of the Companies Act 
2006 as applicable to companies reporting under those standards. These financial statements are 
presented on pages 128 to 151.
The accounting policies set out below have, unless otherwise stated, been applied consistently 
to all periods presented in these Group financial statements.
The annual financial statements are prepared under the historical cost convention except for 
financial assets and financial liabilities (including derivative financial instruments and share-based 
payments), which have been stated at fair value. The financial statements are prepared in pounds 
sterling, rounded to the nearest 0.1 million.
Going concern 
At the time of approving the financial statements, the Board of Directors is required to formally 
assess that the business has adequate resources to continue in operational existence and as such 
can continue to adopt the ‘going concern’ basis of accounting. To support this assessment, the 
Board is required to consider the Group’s current financial position, its strategy, the market 
outlook, and its principal risks.
The key judgement that the Directors have considered in forming their conclusion is the potential impact 
on future revenue, profits and cashflows of a downturn in consumer spending away from homewares due 
to the ongoing impact of sustained inflation, as well as the impact of broader economic uncertainty across 
a three-year review period. This scenario could result in no year growth in Year 1 and lower sales and 
higher costs across all channels throughout the review period. The Directors’ have also considered 
a deeper downturn in consumer spending away from homewares, resulting in negative growth in 
Year 1 and lower sales and higher costs across all channels throughout the review period.
In both downside scenarios Dunelm has sufficient liquidity to continue trading, including maintaining 
the payment of dividends in line with its dividend policy, and to comfortably meet its financial 
covenants. The Directors continue to assess the risks that climate change poses to the business 
and based on current legislation, climate change is not expected to have a significant impact on 
the Group’s going concern assessment or on the viability of the Group over the next five years. 
Therefore, no incremental impact has been modelled in either of the downturn scenarios.
Reverse stress modelling has demonstrated that a prolonged sales reduction of 26% in each year 
is required to breach covenants by the end of FY26 and a reduction of 42% in both FY24 and FY25 
is required to breach the RCF limit by the end of FY25, assuming reasonable mitigating actions 
have been implemented. 
Even in such an event, management would follow a similar course of action to that initially 
undertaken during the recent Covid-19 pandemic. Such actions could include further reductions 
in discretionary spend (e.g. marketing and travel) and capital investment in new stores and refits, 
and reducing headcount.
As a result, the Board believes that the Group is well placed to manage its financing and other 
significant risks satisfactorily and that the Group will be able to operate within the level of its 
facilities and meet its liabilities as they fall due, for at least the next five years. For this reason, the 
Board considers it appropriate for the Group to adopt the going concern basis in preparing its 
financial statements. 
Further detail in respect of the Directors’ going concern assessment is included in the going 
concern statement on page 55.
Further information regarding the Group’s business activities, together with the factors likely to 
affect its future development, performance and position is set out in the Strategic Report on 
pages 1 to 55. In addition, note 18 includes the Group’s objectives, policies, and processes for 
managing its capital, its financial risk management objectives and its exposures to credit risk and 
liquidity risk.
Use of estimates and judgements
Based on the IAS 1 definitions, there are no significant estimates or critical judgements used in 
the Financial Statements. The inventory provision is not considered a significant estimate as there 
is not a significant risk of a material adjustment to the level of the provision in the next 12 months. 
Management does, however, consider the inventory provision to be a key estimate as it is based 
on assumptions relating to a highly material balance (gross inventory) and is subject to uncertainty. 
It is therefore disclosed as an other estimate in line with IAS 1.
132
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Inventory provisions 
The Group provides against the carrying value of the inventories held where it is anticipated that 
net realisable value (‘NRV’) will be below cost. NRV is based on estimated selling price with future 
price reductions assumed to be in line with historic margin analysis on a line-by-line basis and 
applied to the inventory population as deemed appropriate given the expected sell through 
period and discontinuation status. A 100 basis points change in the provision rate of each stock 
discontinuation category would lead to a change in the provision of £2.0m (2023: £1.9m). 
Consideration is also given to whether any stock categories require additional provision due 
to specific circumstances in place at the period end date.
Basis of consolidation
Subsidiaries
Subsidiaries are entities controlled by the Company. The Financial Statements of subsidiaries are 
included in the Consolidated Financial Statements from the date that control commences until the 
date that control ceases.
Transactions eliminated on consolidation
Intra-group balances, and any unrealised gains and losses or income and expenses arising from 
intra-group transactions, are eliminated in preparing the Consolidated Financial Statements. 
Consistent accounting policies have been adopted across the Group.
Revenue
Revenue is generated from the sale of homewares and related goods and services through the 
Group’s stores and website, and is after deducting returns, relevant discounts and VAT. Revenue 
is recognised when the Group has satisfied its performance obligations to its customers and the 
customer has obtained control of the goods and services being transferred. 
In general, these conditions for store sales are met at the point of sale. The exceptions to this are 
custom-made products and Click & Collect sales, where revenue is recognised at the point that 
the goods are collected, and gift cards, where revenue is deferred and subsequently recognised 
when redeemed or expired. Gift card obligations are recognised as deferred income as shown in 
note 16. An estimate of breakage is made on outstanding gift card balances based on historical 
data and estimates of future usage patterns, and recognised in line with the pattern of utilisation 
of the gift card balances. Revenue on home delivery sales is recognised at the point of delivery. 
Revenue is settled in cash at the point of sale for all revenue channels. 
The Group has two types of products; stocked products and products which are sent directly from 
suppliers to customers. Management has established that the Group acts as a principal for both 
types of products and thus should recognise revenue as the gross amount of consideration to 
which it expects to be entitled.
The Group holds a sales return provision in the Consolidated Statement of Financial Position to 
provide for expected levels of returns on sales made before the period end but returned after 
the period end. The Group recognises the expected value of revenue relating to returns within 
sales provisions and the expected value of cost of sales relating to the returned items is included 
within inventories. 
Expenses
Financial income and expenses
Financial income and expenses comprise interest payable on borrowings calculated using the 
effective interest method, interest receivable on funds invested and related foreign exchange 
gains and losses.
Retirement benefits
The Group operates a defined contribution pension plan using a third-party provider. Obligations 
for the contributions to this plan are recognised as an expense in the Consolidated Income 
Statement as incurred.
Share-based payments
The Group operates a number of equity-settled, share-based compensation plans, under which 
the entity receives services from employees as consideration for equity instruments (options) of 
the Group. The fair value of the employee services received in exchange for the grant of the 
options is recognised as an expense. The total amount to be expensed is determined by reference 
to the fair value of the options granted:
•	including any market performance condition (for example, an entity’s share price);
•	excluding the impact of any service and non-market performance vesting conditions (for 
example, profitability, sales growth targets and remaining an employee of the entity over a 
specified time period); and
•	including the impact of any non-vesting conditions (for example, the requirement for employees 
to save). 
Non-market performance and service conditions are included in assumptions about the number 
of options that are expected to vest. The total expense is recognised over the vesting period, 
which is the period over which all of the specified vesting conditions are to be satisfied.
In addition, in some circumstances employees may provide services in advance of the grant date 
and therefore the grant date fair value is estimated for the purposes of recognising the expense 
during the period between service commencement period and grant date.
At the end of each reporting period, the Group revises its estimates of the number of options that 
are expected to vest based on the non-market vesting conditions. It recognises the impact of the 
revision to original estimates, if any, in the Consolidated Income Statement, with a corresponding 
adjustment to equity.
Consolidated Accounting Policies continued
133
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

When options are exercised, the Company either issues new shares, or uses treasury shares 
purchased for this purpose. For newly issued shares, the proceeds received net of any directly 
attributable transaction costs are credited to share capital (nominal value) and the share 
premium account.
Social security contributions payable in connection with the grant of the share options 
are considered an integral part of the grant itself, and the charge will be treated as a 
cash-settled transaction.
Foreign currencies
Transactions in foreign currencies are recorded at the prevailing rate at the date of the transaction. 
Monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currency are translated at the rates ruling at 
the Consolidated Statement of Financial Position date. Resulting exchange gains or losses are 
recognised in the Consolidated Income Statement for the period in financial income and expenses, 
except when deferred as qualifying cash flow hedges.
Taxation
Tax on the profit or loss for the period comprises current and deferred tax. Tax is recognised in the 
Consolidated Income Statement except to the extent that it relates to items recognised directly in 
equity, in which case it is recognised in equity.
Current tax represents the expected tax payable on the taxable income for the period, using tax 
rates enacted or substantively enacted at the Consolidated Statement of Financial Position date, 
together with any adjustment to tax payable in respect of previous periods.
Deferred tax is provided using the Statement of Financial Position liability method, providing 
for temporary differences between the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities for financial 
reporting purposes and the amounts used for taxation purposes. Deferred tax is determined 
using tax rates (and laws) that have been enacted or substantively enacted at the Consolidated 
Statement of Financial Position date and are expected to apply when the related deferred tax 
asset is realised, or the deferred tax liability is settled.
A deferred tax asset is recognised only to the extent that it is probable that future taxable profits 
will be available against which the asset can be recognised.
Deferred income tax assets and liabilities are offset when there is a legally enforceable right to 
offset current tax assets against current tax liabilities and when they relate to income taxes levied 
by the same taxation authority on either the taxable entity or different taxable entities where there 
is an intention to settle the balances on a net basis.
Dividends
Dividends are recognised as a liability in the period in which they are approved such that the 
Group is obligated to pay the dividend. 
Intangible assets
Intangible assets comprise of software development, licences, rights to brands and customer lists 
and are stated at cost less accumulated amortisation and impairment. Costs incurred in 
developing the Group’s own brands are expensed as incurred.
Separately acquired brands and customer lists are shown at historical cost. Software, brands and 
customer lists acquired in a business combination are recognised at fair value at the acquisition 
date. These assets are deemed to have a finite useful life and are carried at cost less accumulated 
amortisation. Amortisation is calculated using the straight-line method to allocate the cost over the 
estimated useful life.
Acquired computer software licences are capitalised on the basis of the costs incurred to acquire 
and bring to use the specific software. These costs are amortised over their estimated useful lives.
Costs associated with maintaining computer software programmes are recognised as an expense 
as incurred. Development costs that are directly attributable to the design and testing of 
identifiable and unique software products controlled by the Group are recognised as intangible 
assets when the following criteria are met:
•	it is technically feasible to complete the software product so that it will be available for use;
•	management intends to complete the software product and use or sell it;
•	there is an ability to use or sell the software product;
•	it can be demonstrated how the software product will generate probable future economic benefits;
•	adequate technical, financial and other resources to complete the development and to use 
or sell the software product are available; and
•	the expenditure attributable to the software product during its development can be 
reliably measured.
Other development expenditures that do not meet these criteria are recognised as an expense 
as incurred.
Computer software development costs recognised as assets are amortised over their estimated 
useful lives.
Amortisation
Amortisation is charged to the Consolidated Income Statement on a straight-line basis over the 
estimated useful life of the asset. These are as follows:
Software development and licences
3 to 5 years
Rights to brands and customer lists
5 to 15 years
Consolidated Accounting Policies continued
134
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Property, plant and equipment
Owned assets
Items of property, plant and equipment are stated at historical cost less accumulated depreciation 
and impairment losses. Cost includes the original purchase price of the asset and the costs 
attributable to bringing the asset to its working condition for intended use. 
Where parts of an item of property, plant and equipment have different useful lives, they are 
accounted for as separate items of property, plant and equipment.
Investment properties
Property held by the Group to earn rental income or for capital appreciation is classified as 
investment property. Property occupied by the Group is recognised within property, plant and 
equipment. Judgement is applied in determining classification when management’s future plans 
for properties include possible changes in future use.
Investment property is initially measured at cost being purchase price and directly attributable 
expenditure. Subsequently investment properties are held at cost less accumulated depreciation 
and impairment losses. Depreciation is provided on a consistent basis with that applied to 
property, plant and equipment. 
For the current period, given the proximity of the transaction to the end of the reporting period, 
an independent valuation has not been sought, as it is considered that the purchase price is 
consistent with its fair value as at the period-end date.
Depreciation
Depreciation is charged to the Consolidated Income Statement on a straight-line basis over the 
estimated useful lives of each part of an item of property, plant and equipment, to write down the 
cost to its estimated residual value. Land is not depreciated. 
The estimated useful lives are as follows:
Freehold buildings
50 years
Leasehold improvements
over the remaining period of the lease, or useful life if shorter
Fixtures, fittings, and equipment
3 to 5 years
The assets’ residual values and useful lives are reviewed and adjusted if appropriate at the end of 
each reporting period. An asset’s carrying amount is written down immediately to its recoverable 
amount if the asset’s carrying amount is greater than its estimated recoverable amount.
Leases
Lease recognition
At the inception of a contract, the Group assesses whether a contract is, or contains, a lease. 
A contract is, or contains, a lease if it conveys the right to control the use of an identified asset for 
a period of time in exchange for consideration. To assess whether a contract conveys the right to 
control the use of an identified asset, the Group uses the definition of a lease in IFRS 16. 
Right-of-use assets
The Group recognises right-of-use assets at the commencement date of the lease. Right-of-use 
assets are measured at cost, less accumulated depreciation and impairment losses and adjusted 
for any remeasurement of lease liabilities. The cost of right-of-use assets includes the amount of 
lease liabilities recognised, adjusted for any lease payments made at or before the commencement 
date, less any lease incentives received. Right-of-use assets are depreciated over the shorter of the 
asset’s useful life or the lease term on a straight-line basis. Right-of-use assets are subject to, and 
reviewed regularly for, impairment. Depreciation of right-of-use assets is included in operating 
costs in the Consolidated Income Statement.
Lease liabilities
At the commencement date of the lease, the Group recognises lease liabilities measured at the 
present value of the lease payments to be made over the lease term. Lease payments include 
fixed payments less any lease incentives receivable.
In calculating the present value of lease payments, the Group uses its incremental borrowing rate 
at the lease commencement date if the interest rate implicit in the lease is not readily determinable. 
The carrying amount of lease liabilities is remeasured if there is a modification, a change in the 
lease term or a change in the fixed lease payments. Interest charges are included in finance costs 
in the Consolidated Income Statement.
Short-term leases and leases of low-value assets
The Group has elected not to recognise right-of-use assets and lease liabilities for short-term 
leases of machinery and equipment that have a lease term of less than 12 months and leases of 
low-value assets (defined as assets with a value, when new, of £5,000 or less). Lease payments 
relating to short-term leases and leases of low-value assets are recognised as an expense on 
a straight-line basis over the lease term.
Consolidated Accounting Policies continued
135
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Subsequent measurement
The lease liability and right-of-use asset is subsequently remeasured to reflect changes in:
•	the lease term (using a revised discount rate);
•	the assessment of a purchase option (using a revised discount rate); and
•	future lease payments resulting from a change in an index, or a rate used to determine those 
payments (using an unchanged discount rate).
Lease modifications may also prompt remeasurement of the lease liability unless they are 
determined to be separate leases.
The payments related to leases are presented under cash flow from financing activities in the 
Consolidated Cash Flow Statement.
Financial instruments
Recognition and measurement
At initial recognition, the Group measures a financial asset at its fair value plus, in the case of 
a financial asset not at fair value through profit or loss (FVPL), transaction costs that are directly 
attributable to the acquisition of the financial asset. Transaction costs of financial assets carried 
at FVPL are expensed in the Consolidated Income Statement.
Financial assets with embedded derivatives are considered in their entirety when determining 
whether their cash flows are solely payment of principal and interest.
Subsequent measurement of debt instruments depends on the Group’s business model for 
managing the asset and the cash flow characteristics of the asset. There are two measurement 
categories into which the Group classifies its debt instruments:
•	Amortised cost: Assets that are held for collection of contractual cash flows where those cash 
flows represent solely payments of principal and interest are measured at amortised cost. 
Interest income from these financial assets is included in finance income using the effective 
interest rate method. Any gain or loss arising on derecognition is recognised directly in the 
Consolidated Income Statement and presented in other gains/(losses) together with foreign 
exchange gains and losses; and
•	FVPL: All other financial assets that do not meet the criteria for amortised cost are measured 
at FVPL, unless the Group has made an irrevocable election at the time of initial recognition to 
account for the equity investment at fair value through other comprehensive income (‘FVOCI’). 
A gain or loss on a debt investment that is subsequently measured at FVPL is recognised in the 
Consolidated Income Statement in the period in which it arises.
Impairment of financial assets
The Group uses a forward-looking approach to assess the expected credit losses associated with 
its debt instruments carried at amortised cost. The impairment methodology applied depends on 
whether there has been a significant increase in credit risk.
Derivatives
Derivative financial instruments used are forward foreign exchange contracts. These are measured 
at fair value. The fair values are determined by reference to the market prices available from the 
market on which the instruments are traded.
Certain derivative financial instruments are designated as hedges in line with the Group’s treasury 
policy. These are instruments that hedge exposure to variability in cash flows that is attributable to 
a particular risk associated with a highly probable forecasted transaction.
Any gains or losses arising from changes in fair value derivative financial instruments not 
designated as hedges are recognised in the Consolidated Income Statement.
The effective portion of changes in the fair value of derivatives that are designated and qualify as 
cash flow hedges is recognised in the cash flow hedge reserve within equity. The gain or loss 
relating to the ineffective portion is recognised immediately in the Consolidated Income 
Statement, within operating costs.
When option contracts are used to hedge forecast transactions, the Group designates only the 
intrinsic value of the options as the hedging instrument.
Gains or losses relating to the effective portion of the change in intrinsic value of the options and 
time value of options are recognised in the cash flow hedge reserve within equity.
When forward contracts are used to hedge forecast transactions, the Group designates the full 
change in fair value of the forward contract (including forward points) as the hedging instrument. 
The gains or losses relating to the effective portion of the change in fair value of the entire forward 
contract are recognised in the cash flow hedge reserve within equity.
Amounts accumulated in equity are reclassified in the periods when the hedged item affects 
profit or loss. Where the hedged item subsequently results in the recognition of a non-financial 
asset (such as inventory), both the deferred hedging gains and losses and the deferred time value 
of the option contracts or deferred forward points, if any, are included within the initial cost of the 
asset. The deferred amounts are ultimately recognised in the Consolidated Income Statement as 
the hedged item affects profit or loss (for example, through cost of sales).
When a hedging instrument expires, or is sold or terminated, or when a hedge no longer meets 
the criteria for hedge accounting, any cumulative deferred gain/loss and deferred costs of hedging 
in equity at that time remain in equity until the forecast transaction occurs, resulting in the 
recognition of a non-financial asset such as inventory. When the forecast transaction is no longer 
expected to occur, the cumulative gain/loss and deferred costs of hedging that were reported in 
equity are immediately reclassified to the Consolidated Income Statement.
Consolidated Accounting Policies continued
136
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Offsetting financial instruments
Financial assets and liabilities are offset, and the net amount reported in the Consolidated 
Statement of Financial Position when there is a legally enforceable right to offset the recognised 
amounts and there is an intention to settle on a net basis or realise the asset and settle the liability 
simultaneously. The legally enforceable right must not be contingent on future events and must 
be enforceable in the normal course of business and in the event of default, insolvency or 
bankruptcy of the Group or the counterparty.
Trade and other receivables
Trade and other receivables are initially recognised at fair value and then carried at amortised cost 
using the effective interest method, net of impairment provisions.
Inventories
Inventories are stated at the lower of cost and net realisable value. Cost is derived using the 
average cost method and includes costs incurred in bringing the inventories to their present 
location and condition. Net realisable value is the estimated selling price less cost to sell in the 
ordinary course of business. Provisions are made for obsolete, slow-moving or discontinued stock 
and for stock losses.
Cash and cash equivalents
Cash and cash equivalents comprise cash balances including credit card receipts and deposits. 
All cash equivalents have an original maturity of three months or less.
Trade and other payables
Trade and other payables are recognised initially at their fair value and subsequently measured 
at amortised cost using the effective interest rate method.
Bank borrowings and borrowing costs
Interest-bearing bank loans are initially recorded at their fair value and subsequently held at 
amortised cost. Transaction costs incurred are amortised over the term of the loan. 
Borrowings are classed as current liabilities unless the Group has an unconditional right to defer 
settlement of the liability for at least 12 months from the Consolidated Statement of Financial 
Position date.
Impairment of non-financial assets
The carrying amounts of the Group’s assets are reviewed annually at each Consolidated Statement 
of Financial Position date to determine whether there is any indication of impairment. If any such 
indication exists, the asset’s recoverable amount is estimated.
The recoverable amount is the greater of fair value less costs of disposal and value in use. In 
assessing value in use, the estimated future cash flows are discounted to their present value using 
a pre-tax discount rate that reflects current market assessments of the time-value of money and 
the risks specific to the asset. For an asset that does not generate largely independent cash 
inflows, the recoverable amount is determined for assets grouped at the lowest levels for which 
there are largely independent cash flows, i.e. the cash-generating unit to which the asset belongs.
An impairment loss is recognised whenever the carrying amount of an asset or its cash-generating 
unit exceeds the recoverable amount. A cash-generating unit has been defined as an individual 
store or the online business. If an impairment loss is identified for a cash-generating unit, the loss 
shall be allocated to reduce the carrying amount of the assets of the unit pro-rated on the basis of 
the carrying amount of each asset in the unit for both property, plant and equipment and 
right-of-use assets. Impairment losses are recognised in the Consolidated Income Statement.
Share capital
Where the Group purchases its own equity share capital (treasury shares), the consideration 
paid, including any directly attributable incremental costs, is deducted from equity attributable 
to the Group’s equity holders until the shares are cancelled or reissued. Where such shares are 
subsequently sold or reissued, any consideration received net of any directly attributable 
incremental transaction costs and the related income tax effects, is included in equity attributable 
to the Group’s equity holders. 
Provisions
A provision is recognised in the Consolidated Statement of Financial Position when the Group 
has a current legal or constructive obligation as a result of a past event and it is probable that an 
outflow of economic benefits will be required to settle the obligation, and the amount has been 
reliably measured. 
A provision for onerous contracts is recognised when the expected benefit to be derived by the Group 
from a contract is lower than the unavoidable costs of meeting its obligations under the contract.
A dilapidations provision is recognised when there is an expectation of future obligations relating to 
the maintenance of leasehold properties arising from events such as lease renewals or terminations.
Climate change
Climate change risks including the impact of achieving the Group’s carbon emissions reduction 
targets and the risks identified in the TCFD disclosures on pages 46 to 54 have been considered 
and assessed in the preparation of the Consolidated Financial Statements for the period to 
29 June 2024.
There has been no material impact identified on the financial reporting judgements and estimates 
applied in the preparation of the Group’s Consolidated Financial Statements as a result of climate 
change risks.
Consolidated Accounting Policies continued
137
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Given that the identified risks of climate change are expected to be present in the medium to long 
term our focus has been on the non-current assets within the Consolidated Statement of Financial 
Position. Specifically, for the material non-current assets, we note the following: 
•	the plant, property and equipment, and the right-of-use assets have relatively short useful lives 
(the average remaining lease term of our leasehold land and buildings is 5.2 years (2023: 5.0 years)). 
The longer life assets relate to freehold stores and our head office, none of which are located in 
areas identified as being at significant risk to climate change; and 
•	the intangible assets, which consist of a brand, internally generated and other software, have a useful 
life of 3 to 5 years and therefore we would not expect the identified risks to impact these assets.
The other non-current assets were also reviewed, and no risk was identified. Current assets, by 
their nature, are expected to be fully utilised within the business in the short term and no climate 
risk has been identified in this time horizon.
New standards and interpretations
The Group has applied the following new standards and interpretations for the first time for the 
annual reporting period commencing 2 July 2023: 
•	IFRS 17 Insurance Contracts; 
•	amendments to IAS 1 and IFRS Practice Statement 2: Disclosure of Accounting Policies;
•	amendments to IAS 8: Definition of Accounting Estimates; 
•	amendments to IAS 12: Deferred Tax Related to Assets and Liabilities arising from a Single 
Transaction; and
•	amendments to IAS 12: International Tax Reform — Pillar Two Model Rules.
The Group has reviewed whether its arrangements meet the accounting definition of an insurance 
contract. Product warranty agreements issued in connection with sales of goods transfer an 
element of insurance risk, but contracts of this nature are excluded from IFRS 17 and will remain 
accounted for under the existing revenue and provisions standards. Therefore there is no impact 
on the financial position or performance of the Group on adoption.
The adoption of the standards and interpretations listed above has not led to any changes to the 
Group’s accounting policies or had any other material impact on the financial position or 
performance of the Group.
New accounting standards in issue but not yet effective 
New standards and interpretations that are in issue, but not yet effective, are listed below: 
•	amendments to IAS 1: Classification of Liabilities as Current or Non-Current; 
•	amendments to IAS 7 and IFRS 7: Supplier finance arrangements; and
•	amendments to IFRS 16: Lease liability in a sale and leaseback.
The adoption of the above standards and interpretations is not expected to lead to any changes 
to the Group’s accounting policies nor have any other material impact on the financial position or 
performance of the Group.
Consolidated Accounting Policies continued
1. Revenue
The Group has one reportable segment, in accordance with IFRS 8 ‘Operating Segments’, which 
is the retail of homewares in the UK. 
Customers access the Group’s offer across multiple channels and their journey often involves 
more than one channel. Therefore, internal reporting focuses on the Group as a whole and does 
not identify individual segments. 
The Chief Operating Decision-maker is the Executive Board of Directors of Dunelm Group plc. 
The Executive Board reviews internal management reports on a monthly basis and performance is 
assessed based on a number of financial and non-financial KPIs as well as on profit before taxation. 
The list of our financial and non-financial KPIs can be found on pages 26 to 27.
Management believes that these measures are the most relevant in evaluating the performance 
of the Group and for making resource allocation decisions. 
All material operations of the Group are carried out in the UK. The Group’s revenue is driven by 
the consolidation of individual small value transactions and as a result, Group revenue is not reliant 
on a major customer or group of customers.
At the period end the Group had £12.5m (2023: £13.8m) of sales orders placed that will be 
recognised in the Consolidated Income Statement when the goods are despatched in the 
following financial period. 
2. Operating costs
2024
52 weeks
£’m
2023
52 weeks
£’m
Selling and distribution costs
528.6
489.7
Tech and support expenses
141.4 
132.4 
 
670.0 
622.1 
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements
For the 52 weeks ended 29 June 2024
138
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements continued
3. Operating profit
Operating profit is stated after charging the following items: 
2024
52 weeks
£’m
2023
52 weeks
£’m
Cost of inventories included in cost of sales
812.3
803.4
Amortisation of intangible assets
4.1
4.6
Depreciation of owned property, plant and equipment
26.3
25.2
Depreciation of right-of-use assets
50.2
49.3
Loss on disposal and impairment of property, plant and equipment and 
intangible assets
0.5
0.3
Impairment of right-of-use assets
0.9
—
Expense related to short-term leases
3.7
1.6
The cost of inventories included in cost of sales includes the impact of a net increase in the 
provision for obsolete inventory of £0.6m (2023: £0.8m decrease).
The analysis of the auditor remuneration is as follows:
2024
52 weeks
£’000
2023
52 weeks
£’000
Fees payable to the Group’s auditor for the audit of the Parent and 
consolidated annual financial statements
37 
34 
Fees payable to the Group’s auditor and its associates for other services 
to the Group
— Audit of the Company’s subsidiaries pursuant to legislation
322 
293 
— Other assurance services (See Audit and Risk Committee Report on 
page 85 for further information)
50 
46 
4. Employee numbers and costs
The average monthly number of people employed by the Group (including Directors) was:
2024
52 weeks
Number
of heads
2024
52 weeks
Full time
equivalents
2023
52 weeks
Number
of heads
2023
52 weeks
Full time
equivalents
Selling
9,591
5,258
9,446
5,252
Distribution
1,148
1,110
1,057
1,026
Administration
1,170
1,153
1,099
1,082
 
11,909
7,521
11,602
7,360
The aggregate remuneration of all employees (including Directors) comprises:
2024
52 weeks
£’m
2023
52 weeks
£’m
Wages and salaries (including termination benefits)
248.0
224.8
Social security costs
17.6
16.1
Share-based payment expense
4.3
4.8
Pension costs — defined contribution plans
6.9
6.2
 
276.8
251.9
Details of Directors’ remuneration, share options, long-term incentive schemes and pension 
entitlements are disclosed in the Remuneration Report on pages 88 to 115 and in the Related 
Parties note (note 26).
5. Financial income and expenses
2024
52 weeks
£’m
2023
52 weeks
£’m
Financial income
Interest on bank deposits
1.6
1.1
Net foreign exchange gains
0.4
0.6
 
2.0
1.7
Financial expenses
Interest on bank borrowings
(3.0)
(2.2)
Amortisation of issue costs of bank loans
(0.8)
(0.3)
Interest on lease liabilities
(6.1)
(5.3)
 
(9.9)
(7.8)
Net financial expense
(7.9)
(6.1)
139
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements continued
6. Taxation
2024
52 weeks
£’m
2023
52 weeks
£’m
Current taxation
 
UK corporation tax charge for the period
51.8
40.0 
Adjustments in respect of prior periods
(0.4)
0.1 
 
51.4
40.1 
Deferred taxation
Origination of temporary differences
2.9
0.7 
Adjustments in respect of prior periods
(0.1)
0.1 
Impact of change in tax rate
—
(0.1)
 
2.8
0.7 
Total tax expense
54.2
40.8 
The tax expense is reconciled with the standard rate of UK corporation tax as follows:
2024
52 weeks
£’m
2023
52 weeks
£’m
Profit before taxation
205.4
192.7
UK corporation tax at standard rate of 25.0% (2023: 20.5%)
51.4
39.5
Factors affecting the charge in the period:
  Non-deductible expenses
3.2
1.2
  Adjustments in respect of prior periods
(0.5)
0.2
  Profit on disposal of ineligible assets
0.1
—
  Impact of change in tax rate
—
(0.1)
Tax expense
54.2
40.8
The taxation expense for the period as a percentage of profit before tax is 26.4% (2023: 21.2%).
The UK Government substantively enacted an increase in the corporation tax rate to 25.0% 
effective from 1 April 2023. The deferred tax asset as at 1 July 2023 has been calculated based 
on the rate of 25.0%.
Pillar Two legislation has been enacted or substantively enacted in certain jurisdictions in which the 
Group operates. The legislation will be effective for the Group’s financial year beginning 30 June 
2024. The Group has performed an assessment of the Group’s potential exposure to Pillar Two 
income taxes. This assessment is based on the most recent information available regarding the 
financial performance of the constituent entities in the Group. Based on the assessment 
performed, the Pillar Two effective tax rates in all jurisdictions in which the Group operates are 
above 15% and management is not currently aware of any circumstances under which this might 
change. Therefore, the Group does not expect a potential exposure to Pillar Two top up taxes.
7. Dividends
The dividends set out in the table below relate to the 1 pence Ordinary Shares:
Dividend type
In respect of period ended
Pence per 
share
2024
52 weeks 
£’m
2023
52 weeks
£’m
Final
2 July 2022
26.0
—
52.4 
Interim
1 July 2023
15.0
—
30.2 
Special
1 July 2023
40.0
—
80.7 
Final
1 July 2023
27.0
54.5 
—
Interim
29 June 2024
16.0
32.3
—
Special
29 June 2024
35.0
70.8
—
 
 
 
157.6 
163.3 
The Board is proposing a final dividend of 27.5 pence per Ordinary Share for the period ended 
29 June 2024 which equates to £55.6m. Subject to shareholder approval at the AGM this will be 
paid on 26 November 2024. The ex-dividend date is 31 October 2024 and the record date is 
1 November 2024. 
8. Earnings per Ordinary Share
Basic earnings per share is calculated by dividing the profit for the period attributable to equity 
holders of the Company by the weighted average number of Ordinary Shares in issue during the 
period, excluding Ordinary Shares purchased by the Company and held as treasury shares 
(note 22).
For diluted earnings per share, the weighted average number of Ordinary Shares in issue is 
adjusted to assume conversion of all dilutive potential Ordinary Shares. These represent share 
options granted to employees where the exercise price is less than the average market price of 
the Group’s Ordinary Shares during the period.
2024
52 weeks
£’m
2023
54 weeks
£’m
Profit for the period
151.2 
151.9 
Weighted average numbers of shares: 
2024
52 weeks
’000
2023
52 weeks
’000
Weighted average number of shares in issue during the period
202,355 
201,917 
Impact of share options
893 
746 
Number of shares for diluted earnings per share
203,248 
202,663 
140
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements continued
8. Earnings per Ordinary Share continued
2024
52 weeks
£p
2023
54 weeks
£p
Earnings per Ordinary Share — basic
74.7p
75.2p
Earnings per Ordinary Share — diluted
74.4p
75.0p
9. Intangible assets
Software 
development 
and licences 
£’m
Rights to 
brands and 
customer 
lists
£’m
Total
£’m
Cost
At 2 July 2022
52.6 
11.5 
64.1 
Additions
0.1 
— 
0.1 
Disposals
(0.7)
— 
(0.7)
At 1 July 2023
52.0 
11.5 
63.5 
Additions
2.6 
— 
2.6 
Disposals
(0.2)
— 
(0.2)
At 29 June 2024
54.4 
11.5 
65.9 
Accumulated amortisation
 
 
 
2 July 2022
43.2 
11.0 
54.2 
Charge for the financial period
4.5 
0.1 
4.6 
Disposals
(0.6)
— 
(0.6)
At 1 July 2023
47.1 
11.1 
58.2 
Charge for the financial period
4.0 
0.1 
4.1 
Disposals
(0.2)
— 
(0.2)
At 29 June 2024
50.9 
11.2 
62.1 
Net book value
 
 
 
At 2 July 2022
9.4 
0.5 
9.9 
At 1 July 2023
4.9 
0.4 
5.3 
At 29 June 2024
3.5 
0.3 
3.8 
All amortisation is included within operating costs in the Consolidated Income Statement.
Management’s review of indicators of impairment did not result in the recognition of any 
impairment in the period (2023: £nil).
Within software development and licences there were £2.4m additions (2023: £nil) related 
to internally generated assets.
10. Property, plant and equipment
Freehold 
land and 
buildings
£’m
Leasehold 
improvements
£’m
Fixtures, 
fittings and 
equipment
£’m
Total
£’m
Cost
At 2 July 2022
107.0 
164.0 
132.2 
403.2 
Transfer
— 
0.2 
(0.2) 
— 
Additions
— 
10.2 
11.4 
21.6 
Disposals
— 
(7.2)
(3.1)
(10.3)
At 1 July 2023
107.0 
167.2 
140.3 
414.5 
Transfer
(0.2) 
0.2 
— 
— 
Additions
0.3 
13.4 
15.8 
29.5 
Disposals
— 
(6.8)
(4.3)
(11.1)
At 29 June 2024
107.1 
174.0 
151.8 
432.9 
Accumulated depreciation
 
 
 
 
At 2 July 2022
19.9 
97.7 
111.9 
229.5 
Transfer
0.1
0.1
(0.2)
—
Charge for the financial period
1.8 
14.3 
9.1 
25.2 
Disposals
— 
(7.0)
(3.1)
(10.1)
At 1 July 2023
21.8 
105.1 
117.7 
244.6 
Charge for the financial period
1.8
14.0
10.5
26.3
Disposals
— 
(6.7) 
(4.1) 
(10.8) 
Impairment
— 
(0.1)
(0.1)
(0.2)
At 29 June 2024
23.6 
112.3 
124.0 
259.9 
Net book value
 
 
 
 
At 2 July 2022
87.1 
66.3 
20.3 
173.7 
At 1 July 2023
85.2 
62.1 
22.6 
169.9 
At 29 June 2024
83.5 
61.7 
27.8 
173.0 
All depreciation charges have been included within operating costs in the Consolidated 
Income Statement.
The impairment charge of £(0.2)m recognised in the period (2023: £nil) relates to temporary 
provision for impairment in respect of one store. The recoverable amount calculated in the 
impairment review was based on a value in use, applying a pre-tax discount rate of 12.5%.
141
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements continued
11. Leases
Right-of-use assets included in the Consolidated Statement of Financial Position at 29 June 2024 
were as follows:
2024
Land and 
buildings
£’m
2024
Motor 
vehicles, 
plant and 
equipment
£’m
2024
Total
£’m
2023
Total
£’m
At the beginning of the period
215.5 
15.8 
231.3 
248.5 
Additions
33.6 
11.0 
44.6 
32.3 
Disposals
(1.8)
(0.1)
(1.9)
(0.2)
Impairment
(0.9)
—
(0.9)
—
Depreciation
(44.7)
(5.5)
(50.2)
(49.3)
At the end of the period
201.7 
21.2 
222.9 
231.3 
Right-of-use additions included £5.2m of lease modifications in the period (2023: £nil).
The impairment charge of £(0.9)m (2023: £nil) relates to a temporary provision for impairment 
in respect of a lease for a property currently not in use.
Lease liabilities included in the Consolidated Statement of Financial Position at 29 June 2024 
were as follows:
2024
Land and 
buildings
£’m
2024
Motor 
vehicles, 
plant and 
equipment
£’m
2024
Total
£’m
2023
Total
£’m
At the beginning of the period
(242.5)
(15.7)
(258.2)
(278.1)
Additions
(35.1)
(11.1)
(46.2)
(33.2)
Disposals
1.8 
0.1 
1.9 
0.2 
Interest
(5.1)
(1.0)
(6.1)
(5.3)
Repayment of lease liabilities
52.8 
6.2 
59.0 
58.2 
At the end of the period
(228.1)
(21.5)
(249.6)
(258.2)
The discount rate applied across all lease liabilities ranged between 0.90% and 6.76% (2023: 0.90% 
and 5.85%). The discount rate reflects our incremental borrowing rate which we assess by considering 
the marginal rate on the Group’s Revolving Credit Facility (‘RCF’), the Bank of England base rate, 
the yield on Government bonds and the term of the lease. 
The maturity analysis of the lease liabilities is as follows: 
2024
£’m
2023
£’m
Current
(52.1)
(53.4)
Non-current
(197.5)
(204.8)
 
(249.6)
(258.2)
The remaining contractual maturities of the lease liabilities, which are gross and undiscounted, 
are as follows:
2024
£’m
2023
£’m
Less than one year
(59.2)
(65.8)
One to two years
(50.9)
(61.4)
Two to five years
(104.1)
(123.0)
Five to ten years
(63.2)
(78.9)
More than ten years
(1.7)
(3.7)
Total undiscounted lease liability
(279.1)
(332.8)
The average remaining lease term of our leasehold land and buildings is 4.2 years (2023: 5.0 years).
The following amounts have been recognised in the Consolidated Income Statement: 
2024
52 weeks
Land and 
buildings
£’m
2024
52 weeks
Motor 
vehicles, 
plant and 
equipment
£’m
2024
52 weeks
Total
£’m
2023
52 weeks
Total
£’m
Depreciation of right-of-use assets
44.7 
5.5 
50.2 
49.3 
Impairment of right-of-use assets
0.9 
—
0.9 
—
Interest expenses (included in financial expenses)
5.1 
1.0 
6.1 
5.3 
Expense relating to short-term leases
2.3
1.4 
3.7 
1.6 
The total cash outflow for leases during the financial period was £56.9m (2023: £57.3m).
12. Investment properties
In June 2024 we purchased a tenanted freehold property for £7.5m, providing current rental 
income and future capacity for our store support centre. Given the proximity of the transaction to 
the end of the reporting period, an independent valuation has not been sought, as it is considered 
that the purchase price is consistent with its fair value as at the period-end date.
Subsequent to the period end, we also secured a freehold tenanted retail property in an attractive 
location for £22.2m. We expect to convert this into a Dunelm store in the future upon expiry of the 
existing lease. 
142
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements continued
13. Deferred tax assets/liabilities
Deferred tax is provided in full on temporary differences under the liability method using 
a taxation rate of 25.0%. 
Deferred taxation assets and liabilities are attributable to the following:
Assets
Liabilities
Net assets/(liabilities)
2024
£’m
2023
£’m
2024
£’m
2023
£’m
2024
£’m
2023
£’m
Property, plant and equipment
—
— 
(2.7)
(0.8)
(2.7)
(0.8)
Share-based payments
3.0
5.1 
—
— 
3.0
5.1 
Hedging
1.3
2.3 
—
— 
1.3
2.3 
Other temporary differences
0.4
0.5 
(0.2)
(0.2)
0.2
0.3 
 
4.7
7.9 
(2.9)
(1.0)
1.8
6.9 
Assets
Liabilities
Net assets/(liabilities)
2024
£’m
2023
£’m
2024
£’m
2023
£’m
2024
£’m
2023
£’m
Deferred tax recoverable/
(payable) after more than 
12 months
1.9
2.1 
(2.9)
(1.0)
(1.0)
1.1 
Deferred tax recoverable/
(payable) within 12 months
2.8
5.8 
— 
—
2.8
5.8 
 
4.7
7.9 
(2.9)
(1.0)
1.8
6.9 
The movement in the net deferred tax balance is as follows:
Balance at
2 July
2022
£’m
Recognised 
in income
£’m
Recognised 
in equity
£’m
Balance at
1 July
2023
£’m
Property, plant and equipment
0.7 
(1.5)
—
(0.8)
Share-based payments
7.5 
0.7 
(3.1)
5.1 
Hedging
(4.3)
—
6.6 
2.3 
Other temporary differences
0.2 
0.1 
—
0.3 
 
4.1 
(0.7)
3.5 
6.9 
Balance at
1 July
2023
£’m
Recognised 
in income
£’m
Recognised 
in equity
£’m
Balance at
29 June
2024
£’m
Property, plant and equipment
(0.8)
(1.9)
— 
(2.7)
Share-based payments
5.1 
(0.8) 
(1.3)
3.0 
Hedging
2.3 
—
(1.0)
1.3
Other temporary differences
0.3 
(0.1) 
— 
0.2 
 
6.9 
(2.8)
(2.3) 
1.8 
14. Inventories
2024
£’m
2023
£’m
Raw materials 
1.3
1.6
Work in progress
0.1
—
Goods for resale
221.6
209.4
 
223.0
211.0
Goods for resale includes a net realisable value provision of £21.3m (2023: £20.7m). Write-downs of 
inventories to net realisable value amounted to £30.7m (2023: £30.2m). These were recognised as an 
expense during the period and were included in cost of sales in the Consolidated Income Statement.
15. Trade and other receivables
2024
£’m
2023
£’m
Trade receivables
3.7
3.1 
Other receivables
0.4
0.1 
Prepayments and accrued income
22.1
21.1 
 
26.2
24.3 
All trade receivables are due within one year from the end of the reporting period. 
No impairment was incurred on trade and other receivables during the period and the expected 
credit loss provision held at period end is £nil (2023: £nil). No material amounts are overdue 
(2023: £nil). 
143
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements continued
16. Cash and cash equivalents
2024
£’m
2023
£’m
Cash at bank and in hand
23.4
46.3 
The Group deposits funds only with institutions that have a credit rating of ‘A’ and above and the 
term is less than three months.
17. Trade and other payables
2024
£’m
2023
£’m
Trade payables
92.3
94.6
Accruals 
67.3
63.5
Deferred income 
12.5
12.5
Taxation and social security
32.3
37.3
Other payables
0.6
0.2
 
205.0
208.1
Deferred income includes contract liabilities of £8.8m (2023: £9.1m) where payment has been 
received in respect of performance obligations which will be met in future periods. Performance 
obligations associated with contact liabilities relating to unfulfilled sales orders of £7.5m (2023: £8.0m) 
are expected to be met within twelve months of the reporting date. Contract liability for gift cards 
of £1.3m (2023: £1.1m) may be met over a period of up to two years from the reporting date, 
consistent with the term of the gift cards in issue.
2024
£’m
2023
£’m
Opening balance
1.1 
1.3 
Issued in the year
5.6 
5.3 
Released to income statement
(5.4)
(5.5)
 
1.3 
1.1 
18. Financial risk management 
The Board of Directors has overall responsibility for the oversight of the Group’s risk management 
framework. A formal process for reviewing and managing risk in the business is in place. 
Credit risk
Credit risk is the risk of financial loss to the Group if a customer or counterparty to a financial 
instrument fails to meet its contractual obligations and arises principally from the Group’s deposits 
with banks and financial institutions as well as foreign exchange hedging agreements with its 
banking counterparties. The Group only deals with creditworthy counterparties and uses 
publicly available financial information to rate its counterparties, therefore credit risk is considered 
to be low.
Group policy is that surplus funds are placed on deposit with counterparties approved by the 
Board, with a minimum of an ‘A’ credit rating. The credit limit for the syndicate banks is up to 
£60.0m. All other parties are limited to £25.0m. 
The Group’s maximum exposure to credit risk is represented by the carrying amount of financial 
assets. No collateral is held (2023: £nil). At the period end the maximum exposure is detailed in 
the table below:
2024
£’m
2023
£’m
Current
Cash and cash equivalents
23.4
46.3
Trade and other receivables
4.1
3.2
Accrued income
10.2
10.1
Derivative financial instruments
0.3
1.8
Total current financial assets
38.0
61.4
Non-current
Derivative financial instruments
0.1
—
Total financial assets
38.1
61.4
Credit risk
Trade and other receivables include rebates due from suppliers recognised as a reduction to cost 
of sales in the period to which they relate. The rebates are recovered through deductions from 
future payments to suppliers and therefore management is confident of the recoverability of 
these balances. 
The Group applies the IFRS 9 simplified approach to measuring expected credit losses (‘ECL’) 
which uses a lifetime expected loss allowance for all trade and other receivables and accrued 
income. To measure the expected credit losses, trade and other receivables and accrued income 
have been grouped based on shared credit risk characteristics and the days past due. There is 
limited exposure to ECL due to the way the Group operates. 
The Group will write off, either partially or in full, the gross carrying amount of a financial asset 
when there is no realistic prospect of recovery. This is usually the case when it is determined that 
the debtor does not have the assets or sources of income that could generate sufficient cash flows 
to repay the amounts subject to the write-off. However, the Group may still choose to pursue 
enforcement in order to recover the amounts due. 
144
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements continued
18. Financial risk management continued
On that basis, the loss allowance as at 1 July 2023 and 29 June 2024 was determined to not be 
significant for trade and other receivables, accrued income and cash and cash equivalents.
Liquidity risk
Liquidity risk is the risk that the Group will not be able to meet its financial obligations as they fall 
due. The Group’s approach to managing liquidity risk is to ensure, as far as possible, that it will 
always have sufficient liquidity to meet its liabilities when due. The Group manages this risk by 
regularly monitoring cash flow forecasts. Further details of the Group’s available facilities can be 
found in the capital management section of this note. 
All cash flows on financial liabilities for 2024 and 2023 are contractually due within one year with 
the exception of provisions, bank loans, certain derivative financial liabilities and lease liabilities. 
The details of lease liabilities are shown in note 11.
Total borrowings of £79.0m (2023: £77.0m) reflect the level of facility drawdown at the period end 
on the Group’s committed RCF.
Interest rate risk
The Group’s bank borrowings incur variable interest rate charges. The Group’s policy aims to 
manage the interest cost of the Group within the constraints of its financial covenants. The Group 
will continue to monitor movements in the interest rate swap market. 
During the period, if SONIA interest rates had been 100 basis points higher with all other variables 
held constant, post-tax profit would have been £0.3m lower (2023: £0.3m lower).
Foreign currency risk
All of the Group’s revenues are in sterling. The majority of purchases are also in pounds sterling, 
but some goods purchased direct from overseas suppliers are paid for in US dollars, accounting 
for just over 30.0% (2023: 30.0%) of stock purchases in the period ended 29 June 2024. 
The Group uses various means to cover its exposure to US dollars including holding US dollar 
cash balances and taking out forward foreign exchange contracts for the purchase of US dollars. 
All the Group’s foreign exchange transactions are designed to satisfy US dollar denominated 
liabilities. The maximum level of hedging coverage which will be undertaken is 100.0% of 
anticipated expenditure on a three-month horizon, stepping down to 75.0% on a four- to 
12-month horizon and 50.0% on a 13- to 18-month horizon. There is a low level of coverage 
beyond the 18-month horizon. 
Cash flow hedges are in place to manage foreign exchange rate risk arising from forecast 
purchases denominated in US dollars. At the Consolidated Statement of Financial Position date, 
the fair value of US dollar foreign exchange forward contracts held in cash flow hedges was 
a £5.1m liability (2023: £9.2m liability) which relates to a commitment to purchase $368.0m 
(2023: $350.5m) for a fixed sterling amount. A fair value gain of £0.2m (2023: loss of £14.0m) was 
recognised in other comprehensive income and no loss (2023: £nil) was recognised on cash flow 
hedges during the period. In the period, a loss of £3.9m (2023: £19.7m gain) was recycled from the 
cash flow hedge reserve to inventory to offset foreign exchange movements on purchases. The 
remaining hedge reserve balance will be recycled to the Consolidated Income Statement to offset 
future purchases occurring after the Consolidated Statement of Financial Position date, the 
majority of which expire in the next 12 months.
The outstanding US dollar liabilities at the period end were $0.1m (2023: $0.1m). 
At the period end if GBP had strengthened by 10% against US dollar with all other variables held 
constant, post-tax profit would have been £0.1m higher (2023: £0.9m higher) as a result of foreign 
exchange gains on translation of US dollar denominated trade payables and cash and cash 
equivalents. Other components of equity would have been £0.5m higher (2023: £0.9m higher) 
as a result of a decrease in fair value of derivatives designated as cash flow hedges.
Conversely, if GBP had weakened by 10% against US dollar with all other variables held constant, 
post-tax profit for the period would have been £0.1m lower (2023: £1.1m lower) and other 
components of equity would have been £0.5m lower (2023: £0.9m lower).
The US dollar period end exchange rate applied in the above analysis is £1 = $1.2644 (2023: 
£1 = $1. 2694).
Capital management
The Group considers equity plus debt as capital. There are no externally imposed capital 
requirements on the Group. 
The Board’s objective with respect to capital management is to ensure the Group continues as a 
going concern in order to optimise returns to shareholders. The Board regularly monitors the level 
of capital in the Group to ensure that this can be achieved. 
The Company has a syndicated RCF of £250m which is committed until 6 September 2027, which 
may be extended by a further two, one year increments at Dunelm’s request, subject to lender 
consent. There is also an optional accordion facility of £100m. The terms of the RCF are consistent 
with normal practice and include covenants in respect of leverage (Group net debt to be no 
greater than 2.5x Group EBITDA before exceptional items) and fixed charge cover (Group EBITDAR 
before exceptional items to be no less than 1.75x Group fixed charges), both of which were met 
comfortably as at 29 June 2024 as shown below. In addition, the Company maintains £10m of 
uncommitted overdraft facilities with one syndicate partner bank.
145
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements continued
18. Financial risk management continued
The gearing ratio and banking covenants were as follows: 
2024
£’m
2023
£’m
Total borrowings (note 19)
79.0 
77.0 
Less: cash and cash equivalents (note 16)
(23.4)
(46.3)
Net debt
55.6
30.7
Less: unamortised debt issue costs (note 19)
(2.0)
(1.1)
Net debt including unamortised debt issue costs
53.6 
29.6 
Total equity
137.9 
137.5 
Total capital
191.5
167.1 
Gearing ratio
28.0%
17.7%
2024
52 weeks
£’m
2023
52 weeks
£’m
Operating profit 
213.3
198.8
Add: Depreciation and amortisation of property, plant and equipment 
and intangible assets (note 3)
30.4
29.8
Add: Loss on disposal and impairment of property, plant and equipment 
and intangible assets (note 3)
0.5
0.3
Adjusted EBITDA
244.2
228.9
Leverage ratio
0.22
0.13
Adjusted EBITDA
244.2
228.9
Add: RoUA impairment
0.9
—
Add: RoUA depreciation
50.2
49.3
EBITDA
295.3
278.2
Add: Rent 
4.3
4.5
EBITDAR
299.6
282.7
Net interest (note 5)
7.9
6.1
Rent plus RoUA depreciation
54.5
53.8
Fixed charges
62.4
59.9
Fixed charge cover
4.8
4.7
Derivatives: Hedge ineffectiveness
Hedge effectiveness is determined at the inception of the hedge relationship, and through 
periodic prospective effectiveness assessments to ensure that an economic relationship exists 
between the hedged item and hedging instrument. 
For hedges of foreign currency purchases, the Group enters into hedge relationships where the 
critical terms of the hedging instrument match exactly with the terms of the hedged item. The 
Group therefore performs a qualitative assessment of effectiveness. If changes in circumstances 
affect the terms of the hedged item such that the critical terms no longer match exactly with the 
critical terms of the hedging instrument, the Group uses the hypothetical derivative method to 
assess effectiveness. 
In hedges of foreign currency purchases, ineffectiveness may arise if the timing of the forecast 
transaction changes from what was originally estimated, or if there are changes in the credit risk 
of the Group or the derivative counterparty. 
Market risk
The Group has the option to use a combination of foreign currency options and foreign currency 
forwards to hedge its exposure to foreign currency risk. 
The Group only designates the spot component of foreign currency forwards in hedge relationships. 
The spot component is determined with reference to relevant spot market exchange rates. The 
differential between the contracted forward rate and the spot market exchange rate is defined as 
the forward points. It is discounted where material. 
The changes in the forward element of the foreign currency forwards and the time value of the 
options that relate to hedged items are deferred in the hedging reserve.
Effects of hedge accounting on the financial position and performance
2024
£’m
2023
£’m
Foreign currency forwards
Carrying amount of (liability)/asset
(5.1)
(9.2)
Notional amount
295.5 
286.4 
Maturity date 
July 2024—
April 2026
July 2023—
June 2025
Hedge ratio
1:1
1:1
Change in value of hedged item used to determine hedge 
effectiveness
£0.2m
£(14.0)m
Change in the value of hedging instruments
£(0.2)m
£14.0m
Weighted average hedged rate for the year 
(including forward points)
£1:US$1.2445 £1:US$1.2998
146
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements continued
18. Financial risk management continued
Fair values
The fair value of the Group’s financial assets and liabilities are equal to their carrying value. The fair 
value of foreign currency contracts are amounts required by the counterparties to cancel the 
contracts at the end of the period. 
Fair value hierarchy
Financial instruments carried at fair value are required to be measured by reference to the 
following levels:
•	Level 1: quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities;
•	Level 2: inputs other than quoted prices included within Level 1 that are observable for the asset 
or liability, either directly (i.e. as prices) or indirectly (i.e. derived from prices); and 
•	Level 3: inputs for the asset or liability that are not based on observable market data 
(unobservable inputs).
All derivative financial instruments carried at fair value have been measured by a Level 2 valuation 
method, based on observable market data.
Financial assets/(liabilities)
The carrying value of all financial assets and financial liabilities was materially equal to their 
fair value.
At 1 July 2023
Financial 
assets at 
amortised 
cost
£’m
Financial 
liabilities at 
amortised 
cost
£’m
Derivatives 
used for 
hedging
£’m
Total
£’m
Cash and cash equivalents
46.3 
— 
— 
46.3 
Trade and other receivables
3.2 
—
— 
3.2 
Accrued income
10.1 
— 
— 
10.1 
Derivative financial instruments
— 
— 
1.8 
1.8 
Total financial assets
59.6 
— 
1.8 
61.4 
Trade and other payables
— 
(94.8)
— 
(94.8)
Accruals
— 
(63.5)
— 
(63.5)
Lease liabilities
— 
(258.2)
— 
(258.2)
Bank loans
— 
(75.9)
— 
(75.9)
Derivative financial instruments
— 
— 
(11.0)
(11.0)
Total financial liabilities
— 
(492.4)
(11.0)
(503.4)
Net financial assets/(liabilities)
59.6
(492.4)
(9.2)
(442.0)
At 29 June 2024
Financial 
assets at 
amortised 
cost
£’m
Financial 
liabilities at 
amortised 
cost
£’m
Derivatives 
used for 
hedging
£’m
Total
£’m
Cash and cash equivalents
23.4 
— 
— 
23.4 
Trade and other receivables
4.1 
— 
— 
4.1 
Accrued income
10.2 
— 
— 
10.2 
Derivative financial instruments
— 
— 
0.4 
0.4 
Total financial assets
37.7 
— 
0.4 
38.1 
Trade and other payables
— 
(92.9)
— 
(92.9)
Accruals
— 
(67.3)
— 
(67.3)
Lease liabilities
— 
(249.6)
— 
(249.6)
Bank loans
— 
(77.0)
— 
(77.0)
Derivative financial instruments
— 
— 
(5.5)
(5.5)
Total financial liabilities
— 
(486.8)
(5.5)
(492.3)
Net financial assets/(liabilities)
37.7 
(486.8)
(5.1)
(454.2)
The currency profile of the Group’s cash and cash equivalents is as follows:
2024
£’m
2023
£’m
Sterling
22.2 
33.8 
US dollar
0.9 
12.4 
Euro
0.3 
0.1 
 
23.4 
46.3 
19. Bank loans
2024
£’m
2023
£’m
Total borrowings
79.0 
77.0 
Less: unamortised debt issue costs
(2.0)
(1.1)
Net borrowings 
77.0 
75.9 
Borrowings relate to the Group’s syndicated Revolving Credit Facility, as described in note 18. 
147
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements continued
19. Bank loans continued
The analysis below shows the reconciliation of net debt:
2024
52 weeks
£’m
2023
52 weeks
£’m
Net debt at 2 July 2023 and 3 July 2022
(30.7)
(23.8)
Net (decrease)/increase in cash and cash equivalents (excluding foreign 
exchange revaluations)
(23.3)
15.5 
Effect of foreign exchange (note 5)
0.4 
0.6 
Repayments of Revolving Credit Facility
108.0 
116.0 
Drawdowns of Revolving Credit Facility
(110.0)
(139.0)
Movement in net debt
(24.9)
(6.9)
Net debt represented by
 
 
Cash and cash equivalents (note 16)
23.4 
46.3 
Non-current borrowings (note 19)
(79.0)
(77.0)
Net debt at 29 June 2024 and 1 July 2023
(55.6)
(30.7)
Lease liabilities (note 11)
(249.6)
(258.2)
Net debt at 29 June 2024 and 1 July 2023 (including lease liabilities)
(305.2)
(288.9)
20. Provisions
Balance at
2 July 2023
£’m
Utilised in 
the period
£’m
Created in 
the period
£’m
Released in 
the period
£’m
Balance at
29 June 
2024
£’m
Property related
5.9 
(0.2)
1.5 
(1.7)
5.5 
Property-related provisions consist of costs associated with vacant property and dilapidations. 
Dilapidations are based on the Directors’ best estimate of the Group’s future liabilities.
21. Issued share capital
2024
Number of 
Ordinary Shares 
of 1p each
2023
Number of 
Ordinary Shares 
of 1p each
In issue at the start of the period
203,426,835 
203,426,835 
Issued during the period in respect of share option schemes
—
—
In issue at the end of the period
203,426,835
203,426,835
2024
Number of 
shares
2024
£’m
2023
Number of 
shares
2023
£’m
Ordinary shares of 1p each:
 
 
 
 
Authorised
500,000,000
5.0
500,000,000
5.0
Allotted, called up and fully paid
203,426,835
2.0
203,426,835
2.0
Proceeds received in relation to shares issued during the period were £nil (2023: £nil).
22. Treasury shares
2024
Number of 
shares
2024
£’m
2023
Number of 
shares
2023
£’m
Outstanding at the beginning of the period
1,712,790
16.0 1,686,200
17.5 
Purchased during the period
—
—
908,064
7.0 
Reissued during the period in respect of share 
option schemes
(486,329)
(4.5)
(881,474)
(8.5)
Outstanding at the end of the period
1,226,461 
11.5 1,712,790 
16.0 
The Group reissued 486,329 (2023: 881,474) treasury shares during the period for a total value of 
£4.5m (2023: £8.5m). The Group acquired nil (2023: 908,064) shares through purchases on the 
London Stock Exchange during the period for a total value of £nil (2023: £7.0m). 
Proceeds from the issue of treasury shares included in the Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows 
and Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity of £0.1m (2023: £2.4m) is the amount 
employees contributed.
The Group has the right to reissue the remaining treasury shares at a later date. 
23. Share-based payments
The Group operates a number of share-based payment schemes as follows:
Dunelm Group Savings Related Share Option Plan (Sharesave) 
The Dunelm Group plc Savings Related Share Option Plan (Sharesave) scheme is open to all 
colleagues with eligible length of service. Invitations to participate in the scheme are issued 
annually and the scheme is ‘approved’ under HMRC rules. The current maximum monthly savings 
for the schemes detailed below is £500. Options are granted at the prevailing market rate less a 
discount of 20.0%. Options may be exercised under the scheme within six months of the 
completion of each three-year savings contract (from the grant date). There is provision for early 
exercise in certain circumstances such as death, disability, redundancy, and retirement. Sharesave 
options are accounted for as equity-settled awards under IFRS 2.
148
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements continued
23. Share-based payments continued
The following table summarises the movement in Dunelm Group plc Sharesave options during 
the period:
Sharesave Plans
2024
No. of 
options
2024
Weighted
average
exercise 
price (p)
2023
No. of 
options
2023
Weighted 
average 
exercise 
price (p)
Outstanding at beginning of period
2,214,266
717.67
1,182,512
923.00
Granted
614,293
810.00
2,063,669
667.00
Exercised
(22,174)
658.94
(371,564)
634.54
Forfeited
(371,340)
754.03
(660,351)
973.79
Outstanding at end of period
2,435,045
735.95
2,214,266
717.67
Exercisable at end of period
78,984
1,167.00
30,550
654.00
Exercisable at end of period refers to all share options not exercised which have passed their 
vesting date, but not yet reached their expiry date. The figure of 78,984 options (2023: 30,550 
options) excludes the provisions for early exercise explained above. 
Options outstanding at 29 June 2024 are exercisable at prices ranging between 667.00p and 
1,167.00p (2023: 654.00p and 1,167.00p) and have a weighted average remaining contractual life 
of 2.1 years (2023: 2.8 years), as analysed in the table below:
Sharesave Plans
2024
No. of 
options
2024
Weighted 
average 
remaining 
contractual 
life (years)
2023
No. of 
options
2023
Weighted 
average 
remaining 
contractual 
life (years)
Exercise price (pence):
654.00
—
—
 19,110 
 — 
667.00
 1,683,046 
 2.0  1,928,943 
 3.0 
810.00
537,082
3.0
 —
 —
1,046.00
 135,195 
 1.0 
 170,758 
 2.0 
1,167.00
 79,722 
—
 95,455 
 1.0 
 
 2,435,045 
 2.1  2,214,266 
 2.8 
Long-Term Incentive Plan (LTIP)
As explained in the Remuneration Report, the Group operates an equity-settled LTIP scheme for 
Executive Directors and other senior colleagues. Performance conditions for the LTIP awards are 
detailed in the Remuneration Report. LTIP options are also accounted for as equity-settled awards 
under IFRS 2.
The following table summarises the movements in nil-cost LTIP awards during the period:
LTIP awards
2024
No. of 
options
2023
No. of 
options
Outstanding at beginning of period
 1,897,942 1,465,667
Granted
 579,517 
 754,112 
Dividend equivalent awarded in the period
 67,275 
 122,382 
Exercised
(348,727) 
(345,487) 
Forfeited
(204,096) 
(98,732) 
Outstanding at end of period
 1,991,911  1,897,942 
Exercisable at end of period
 4,717 
 21,505 
Exercisable at end of period refers to all share options not exercised which have passed their 
vesting date, but not yet reached their expiry date.
The weighted average remaining contractual life of these options is 8.1 years (2023: 8.1 years).
Restricted Stock Award (RSA) 
These awards are granted to particular individuals and are dependent on continuing employment. 
The only performance condition is that the threshold diluted earnings per share as per the LTIP 
conditions is met as detailed in the Remuneration Report on pages 88 to 115. RSA options are also 
accounted for as equity-settled awards under IFRS 2.
The following table summarises the movements in nil-cost RSA options during the period:
Restricted Stock Awards
2024
No. of 
options
2023
No. of 
options
Outstanding at beginning of period
316,446
123,544
Granted
155,032
207,203
Dividend equivalent awarded in the period
9,928
14,697
Exercised
(115,428)
(12,756)
Forfeited
(31,231)
(16,242)
Outstanding at end of period
334,747
316,446
Exercisable at end of period
12,437
2,836
Exercisable at end of period refers to all share options not exercised which have passed their 
vesting date, but not yet reached their expiry date.
The weighted average remaining contractual life of these options is 7.9 years (2023: 7.5 years).
149
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements continued
23. Share-based payments continued
Bonus Deferred Shares Award
The Bonus Deferred Shares Award provides options over shares in Dunelm Group plc for 
colleagues of the Group as a discretionary bonus. This is an equity-settled share option scheme 
and there are no performance conditions attached to these awards, they are only dependent on 
continued employment. Under this arrangement, colleagues are awarded a number of options 
which is based on the cash value of the earned bonus award, determined by their achievement of 
a mixture of Group and individual performance metrics, divided by a share price value of 1,189.00p 
which was approved at the November 2020 AGM. The deferred shares awarded vested in 
September 2021 and/or September 2022, depending on colleague level.
The Bonus Deferred Shares Award is structured as nil-cost options and the following table 
summarises their movement during the period:
Bonus Deferred Shares Award
2024
No. of options
2023
No. of options
Outstanding at beginning of period
2,783
158,398
Dividend equivalent awarded in the period
—
—
Exercised
—
(151,667)
Forfeited
(74)
(3,948)
Outstanding at end of period
2,709
2,783
Exercisable at end of period
2,709
2,783
The weighted average remaining contractual life of these options is nil years (2023: nil years).
Fair value calculations
The fair values of all share options granted are calculated at the date of grant using a Black-Scholes 
option pricing model. Expected volatility is determined by calculating the historical volatility of the 
Group’s share price over a period equivalent to the expected life of an option which is aligned to 
its vesting period.
The following tables list the inputs to the model used for options granted in the periods ended 
29 June 2024 and 1 July 2023 based on information at the date of grant:
Sharesave plans
2024
2023
Share price at date of grant
1,086.00p
974.00p
Exercise price
810.00p
667.00p
Volatility
34.55%
42.28%
Expected life
3 years
3 years
Risk-free rate
3.31%
3.66%
Dividend yield
3.88%
3.27%
Fair value per option
342.80p
393.50p
LTIP awards
2024
2023
Share price at date of grant
1,086.00p
865.00p
Exercise price
0.00p
0.00p
Volatility
34.55%
43.06%
Expected life
3 years
3 years
Risk-free rate
3.93%
3.62%
Dividend yield
3.88%
3.27%
Fair value per option
736.90p
623.30p
Restricted Stock awards
2024
2023
Share price at date of grant
1,086.00p—1,111.00p
678.00p—867.00p
Exercise price
0.00p
0.00p
Volatility
27.43%—34.55%
35.58%—35.90%
Expected life
1—2 years
1—2 years
Risk-free rate
3.93%—3.97%
2.82%—3.62%
Dividend yield
3.88%
3.27%
Fair value per option
736.90—1,086.20p
623.30p—839.10p
The charge to the Income Statement for all share option schemes is disclosed in note 4.
24. Commitments
As at the period end date, the Group had entered into capital contracts for new stores and refits 
amounting to £1.5m (2023: £8.1m).
25. Contingent liabilities
The Group had no contingent liabilities at the period end date (2023: none).
26. Related parties
Identity of related parties
The Group has related party relationships with its subsidiaries and with its Directors. Transactions 
between the Group and its subsidiaries, which are related parties, have been eliminated on 
consolidation for the Group. A list of subsidiaries can be found in note C4 to the Parent Company 
Financial Statements.
150
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements continued
26. Related parties continued
Key management personnel
The key management personnel of the Group comprise members of the Board of Directors and 
the Executive Board.
Directors of the Company and their close relatives control 42.7% (2023: 42.7%) of the voting shares 
of the Company.
Disclosures relating to remuneration of Directors are set out in the Remuneration Report on 
pages 88 to 115. The remuneration of the key management personnel is set out below:
 
2024
52 weeks
£’m
2023
52 weeks
£’m
Wages and salaries
3.7 
3.8 
Termination benefits
—
0.1
Short-term employee benefits
2.0 
3.1 
Post-employment benefits
0.1 
0.1 
Share-based payments (including NI)
1.0 
1.9 
 
6.8 
9.0 
The amount of gains made by Directors on the exercise of share options are disclosed in the 
Remuneration Report on page 108.
From time to time Directors of the Group, or their related entities, may purchase goods from the 
Group. These purchases are on the same terms and conditions as those entered into by other 
Group employees and values involved are trivial.
27. Ultimate controlling party
The Directors consider that there is no ultimate controlling party of Dunelm Group plc.
Parent Company Statement of Financial Position
As at 29 June 2024
Note
29 June
2024
£’m
1 July 
2023
£’m
Non-current assets
 
Investments in subsidiary undertakings
C4
72.5 
68.8 
Deferred tax assets
C5
0.4
0.6 
Total non-current assets
 
72.9 
69.4 
Current assets
 
 
 
Trade and other receivables
C6
84.7 
162.3 
Total current assets
 
84.7 
162.3 
Total assets
 
157.6 
231.7 
Current liabilities
 
 
 
Trade and other payables
C7
(0.2)
(0.3)
Total current liabilities
 
(0.2)
(0.3)
Total liabilities
 
(0.2)
(0.3)
Net assets
 
157.4 
231.4 
Equity
 
 
 
Issued share capital
C11
2.0 
2.0 
Share premium account
 
1.7 
1.7 
Non-distributable reserves
 
27.4 
23.6 
Capital redemption reserve
 
43.2 
43.2 
Retained earnings
 
83.1 
160.9 
Total equity attributable to equity holders of the Parent
 
157.4 
231.4 
The Company made a profit after tax of £79.3m (2023: £230.9m).
The financial statements on pages 151 to 156 were approved by the Board of Directors on  
11 September 2024 and were signed on its behalf by:
Karen Witts
Director
Company number 04708277
11 September 2024
151
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Parent Company Statement of Changes in Equity
For the 52 weeks ended 29 June 2024
Note
Issued 
share 
capital
£’m
Share 
premium 
account
£’m
Non- 
distributable 
reserves
£’m
Capital 
redemption 
reserve
£’m
Retained 
earnings
£’m
Total equity 
attributable 
to equity 
holders of 
the Parent
£’m
As at 2 July 2022
 
2.0 
1.7 
19.6 
43.2 
97.3 
163.8 
Profit for the period
 
— 
— 
— 
— 
230.9 
230.9 
Total comprehensive 
income for the period
 
— 
— 
— 
— 
230.9 
230.9 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Purchase of treasury 
shares
C12
— 
— 
— 
— 
(7.0)
(7.0)
Proceeds from issue of 
treasury shares
C12
— 
— 
— 
— 
2.4 
2.4 
Share-based payments
C13
— 
— 
4.0 
— 
0.8 
4.8 
Deferred tax on share-
based payments
C5
— 
— 
— 
— 
(0.3)
(0.3)
Current corporation tax 
on share options 
exercised
C8
— 
— 
— 
— 
0.1 
0.1 
Dividends 
C3
— 
— 
— 
— 
(163.3)
(163.3)
Total transactions with 
owners, recorded directly 
in equity
 
— 
— 
4.0 
— 
(167.3)
(163.3)
As at 1 July 2023
 
2.0 
1.7 
23.6 
43.2 
160.9 
231.4 
Profit for the period
 
— 
— 
— 
— 
79.3 
79.3 
Note
Issued 
share 
capital
£’m
Share 
premium 
account
£’m
Non- 
distributable 
reserves
£’m
Capital 
redemption 
reserve
£’m
Retained 
earnings
£’m
Total equity 
attributable 
to equity 
holders of 
the Parent
£’m
Total comprehensive 
income for the period
 
— 
— 
— 
— 
79.3 
79.3 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Purchase of treasury 
shares
C12
— 
— 
— 
— 
—
—
Proceeds from issue of 
treasury shares
C12
— 
— 
— 
— 
0.1 
0.1 
Share-based payments
C13
— 
— 
3.8 
— 
0.5 
4.3 
Deferred tax on share-
based payments
C5
— 
— 
— 
— 
(0.1)
(0.1)
Current corporation tax 
on share options 
exercised
C8
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
Dividends 
C3
— 
— 
— 
— 
(157.6)
(157.6)
Total transactions with 
owners, recorded directly 
in equity
 
— 
—
3.8 
—
(157.1)
(153.3)
As at 29 June 2024
 
2.0 
1.7 
27.4 
43.2 
83.1
157.4
The non-distributable reserves’ purpose is to reflect movements in share-based payments in 
respect of awards given by the Parent Company to employees of its subsidiaries. 
At the time of declaring dividends, the Directors assessed the level of available distributable 
reserves with reference to relevant accounts and considered there to be sufficient levels to 
support the dividend.
152
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Parent Company Accounting Policies
For the 52 weeks ended 29 June 2024
Non-market performance and service conditions are included in assumptions about the number 
of options that are expected to vest. The total expense is recognised over the vesting period, 
which is the period over which all of the specified vesting conditions are to be satisfied.
In addition, in some circumstances employees may provide services in advance of the grant date 
and therefore the grant date fair value is estimated for the purposes of recognising the expense 
during the period between service commencement period and grant date.
At the end of each reporting period, the Company revises its estimates of the number of options 
that are expected to vest based on the non-market vesting conditions. It recognises the impact of 
the revision to original estimates, if any, in the Income Statement, with a corresponding adjustment 
to equity.
When the options are exercised, the Company either issues new shares, or uses treasury shares 
purchased for this purpose. For newly issued shares, the proceeds received net of any directly 
attributable transaction costs are credited to share capital (nominal value) and share premium.
The social security contributions payable in connection with the grant of the share options 
are considered an integral part of the grant itself, and the charge will be treated as a 
cash-settled transaction.
Taxation
Tax on the profit or loss for the period comprises current and deferred tax. Tax is recognised in the 
Income Statement except to the extent that it relates to items recognised directly in equity, in 
which case it is recognised in equity.
Current tax represents the expected tax payable on the taxable income for the period, using tax 
rates enacted or substantively enacted at the Statement of Financial Position date, together with 
any adjustment to tax payable in respect of previous periods.
Deferred tax provides for temporary differences between the carrying amounts of assets and 
liabilities for financial reporting purposes and the amounts used for taxation purposes. Deferred 
tax is determined using tax rates (and laws) that have been enacted or substantively enacted at the 
Statement of Financial Position date and are expected to apply when the related deferred tax 
asset is realised or the deferred tax liability is settled.
A deferred tax asset is recognised only to the extent that it is probable that future taxable profits 
will be available against which the asset can be recognised.
General information
Dunelm Group plc (the ‘Company’) is incorporated and domiciled in the UK. Dunelm Group plc 
is a listed public Company, limited by shares and the Company registration number is 04708277. 
The registered office is Dunelm Store Support Centre, Watermead Business Park, Syston, 
Leicester, Leicestershire, England, LE7 1AD. 
Basis of preparation
These Financial Statements have been prepared in accordance with FRS 101 “Reduced Disclosure 
Framework” (FRS101). 
As permitted by FRS 101, the Company has taken advantage of the disclosure exemptions 
available under that standard in relation to standards not yet effective, presentation of a cash flow 
statement and requirements to disclose related party transactions entered into between two or 
more members of a group. The accounting policies adopted for the Parent Company, Dunelm 
Group plc, are otherwise consistent with those used for the Group which are set out on pages 132 
to 138.
The annual Financial Statements have been prepared under the historical cost convention, and in 
accordance with the Companies Act 2006 and other applicable law. The Financial Statements are 
prepared in pounds sterling, rounded to the nearest 0.1 million.
Going concern
After making enquiries, the Directors have a reasonable expectation that the Company has 
adequate resources to continue in operational existence for the foreseeable future. Accordingly, 
they continue to adopt the going concern basis in preparing the financial statements.
Additional considerations relating to the potential downturn in the homewares market on the 
going concern assumptions are set out in the Consolidated Financial Statements on page 132.
Share-based payments
Employees of the Company have been granted options for two equity-settled, share-based 
compensation plans, under which the entity receives services from employees as consideration for 
equity instruments (options) of the Company. The fair value of the employee services received in 
exchange for the grant of the options is recognised as an expense. The total amount to be expensed 
is determined by reference to the fair value of the options granted:
•	including any market performance conditions (for example, an entity’s share price);
•	excluding the impact of any service and non-market performance vesting conditions (for 
example, profitability, sales growth targets and remaining an employee of the entity over a 
specified time period); and
•	including the impact of any non-vesting conditions (for example, the requirement for employees 
to save). 
153
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Deferred income tax assets and liabilities are offset when there is a legally enforceable right to 
offset current tax assets against current tax liabilities and when they relate to income taxes levied 
by the same taxation authority on either the taxable entity or different taxable entities where there 
is an intention to settle the balances on a net basis.
Dividends
Dividends are recognised as a liability in the period in which they are approved such that the 
Company is obligated to pay the dividend.
Trade and other receivables
Trade and other receivables are initially recognised at fair value and then carried at amortised cost, 
net of impairment provisions. 
Share capital
Where the Company purchases its own equity share capital (treasury shares) the consideration 
paid, including any directly attributable incremental costs, is deducted from equity attributable 
to the Company’s equity holders until the shares are cancelled or reissued. Where such shares 
are subsequently sold or reissued, any consideration received net of any directly attributable 
incremental transaction costs and the related income tax effects, is included in equity attributable 
to the Company’s equity holders.
Investments
Investments in subsidiary undertakings are stated at the adjusted cost of the investment. IFRS 2 
requires the Parent Company to recognise an increase in the cost of its investment in a subsidiary 
which has issued share options in the Parent Company’s shares to its employees.
New standards and interpretations
A detailed list of new standards, amendments or interpretations can be found in the consolidated 
accounting policies on page 138.
Use of estimates and judgements
Based on the IAS 1 definitions, there are no significant estimates or critical judgements used in the 
Company Financial Statements. 
C1. Income Statement
The Company made a profit after tax of £79.3m (2023: £230.9m). The Directors have taken 
advantage of the exemption available under section 408 of the Companies Act 2006 and have not 
presented an Income Statement for the Company.
Disclosures relating to the fees paid to the Company’s auditors are set out in note 3 in the Group’s 
financial statements on page 139.
C2. Employee costs
The Company’s employees are the three Executive Directors and the Non-Executive Directors. 
Full details of the Directors’ remuneration and interests are set out in the Remuneration Report on 
pages 88 to 115. Share-based payments details are given in note C13 on page 156.
C3. Dividends and special distributions to shareholders
Disclosures relating to dividends and special distributions to shareholders are set out in note 7 
in the Group’s financial statements on page 140.
C4. Investments in subsidiary undertakings
Shares in subsidiary undertakings:
£’m
As at 2 July 2022
64.8
Share-based payments
4.0 
As at 1 July 2023
68.8 
Share-based payments
3.7 
As at 29 June 2024
72.5 
The share-based payment adjustment to investments reflects share option awards given by the 
Parent Company to employees of its subsidiaries.
Parent Company Accounting Policies continued
Notes to the Parent Company Financial Statements
For the 52 weeks ended 29 June 2024
154
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Notes to the Parent Company Financial Statements continued
C4. Investments in subsidiary undertakings continued
The following were subsidiaries as at 29 June 2024:
Subsidiary
Proportion of ordinary shares held
Nature of business
Dunelm Limited
100%
Holding company
Dunelm (Soft Furnishings) Ltd*
100%
Retailer of soft furnishings
Dunelm Estates Limited*
100%
Dormant company
Zoncolan Limited*
100%
Dormant company
Fogarty Holdings Limited*
100%
Non-trading company
Globe Online Limited*
100%
Dormant company
Dunelm (Soft Furnishings) 
Londonderry Ltd*
100%
Non-trading company
*	
Share capital held by subsidiary undertaking.
Dunelm Group plc, the Parent Company, and its subsidiaries (excluding Dunelm (Soft Furnishings) 
Londonderry Ltd) are incorporated and domiciled in the UK. The registered office is Dunelm Store 
Support Centre, Watermead Business Park, Syston, Leicester, Leicestershire, England, LE7 1AD. 
The registered address for Dunelm (Soft Furnishings) Londonderry Ltd is Faustina Retail Park, 
35 Buncrana Road, Londonderry, Northern Ireland, BT48 8QN. 
C5. Deferred tax assets
2024
£’m
2023
£’m
Employee benefits
0.4
0.6 
The movement in deferred tax assets is as follows:
Balance at
3 July 2022
£’m
Recognised 
in income
£’m
Recognised 
in equity
£’m
Balance at
1 July 2023
£’m
Employee benefits
1.0 
(0.1)
(0.3)
0.6 
Balance at
2 July 2023
£’m
Recognised 
in income
£’m
Recognised 
in equity
£’m
Balance at
29 June 
2024
£’m
Employee benefits
0.6 
(0.1)
(0.1)
0.4 
C6. Trade and other receivables
2024
£’m
2023
£’m
Amounts owed by subsidiary undertakings
84.7
162.3 
Amounts owed by subsidiary undertakings are repayable on demand. Interest is charged monthly 
on all intercompany balances at an annual rate of 2.0%. There is no security on these balances. 
These amounts pose no liquidity or credit risk as they are owed by other Group undertakings and 
are expected to be settled by Group transactions.
C7. Trade and other payables
2024
£’m
2023
£’m
Accruals and deferred income
0.2
0.3
0.2
0.3
C8. Taxation
2024
£’m
2023
£’m
Current taxation
 
UK corporation tax charge for the period
— 
0.1 
Deferred taxation
Origination of temporary differences
0.1 
0.1 
Tax expense
0.1 
0.2 
The tax charge is reconciled with the standard rate of UK corporation tax as follows:
2024
£’m
2023
£’m
Profit before taxation
79.4
231.1
UK corporation tax at standard rate of 25% (2023: 20.5%)
19.9
47.4
Factors affecting the charge in the period:
  Income not subject to tax
(20.4)
(47.8)
  Impact of change in tax rate
—
(0.1)
  Group relief 
0.6
0.7
Tax expense
0.1
0.2
155
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Notes to the Parent Company Financial Statements continued
C8. Taxation continued
The UK Government substantively enacted an increase in the corporation tax rate to 25.0% 
effective from 1 April 2023. The deferred tax asset as at 29 June 2024 has been calculated based 
on the rate of 25.0%.
C9. Interest-bearing loans and borrowings
The Company’s only interest-bearing borrowings relate to intercompany loans which have interest 
charges of 2.0% and are not affected by changes in SONIA.
C10. Financial risk management
Capital management
The Board’s objective with respect to capital management is to ensure the Company continues as 
a going concern in order to optimise returns to shareholders. The Board’s policy is to retain a 
strong capital base so as to maintain investor, creditor and market confidence and to sustain future 
development. The Board regularly monitors the level of capital in the Group to ensure that this can 
be achieved.
C11. Issued share capital
Disclosures relating to issued share capital are set out in note 21 in the Group’s financial 
statements on page 148.
C12. Treasury shares
Disclosures relating to treasury shares are set out in note 22 in the Group’s financial statements 
on page 148.
C13. Share-based payments
The Company operates the following share-based payment schemes for the CEO and CFO:
a. Dunelm Group Savings Related Share Option Plan (Sharesave) 
The Dunelm Group plc Savings Related Share Option Plan (Sharesave) scheme is open to all 
colleagues with eligible length of service. Invitations to participate in the scheme are issued 
annually and the scheme is ‘approved’ under HMRC rules. The current maximum monthly savings 
for the schemes is £500. Options are granted at the prevailing market rate less a discount of 20%. 
Options may be exercised under the scheme within six months of the completion of each 
three-year savings contract (from the grant date). There is provision for early exercise in certain 
circumstances such as death, disability, redundancy, and retirement. Sharesave options are 
accounted for as equity-settled awards under IFRS 2.
b. Long-Term Incentive Plan (LTIP)
As explained in the Remuneration report, the Company operates an equity-settled LTIP scheme. 
Performance conditions for the LTIP awards are detailed in the Remuneration Report. LTIP options 
are also accounted for as equity-settled awards under IFRS 2.
C14. Contingent liabilities
The Company had no contingent liabilities at the period end date (2023: £nil).
C15. Related parties
Key management personnel
All employees of the Company are key management personnel.
Directors of the Company and their close relatives control 42.7% (2023: 42.7%) of the voting shares 
of the Company.
2024
52 weeks
£’m
2023
52 weeks
£’m
Wages and salaries
1.9 
1.7 
Short-term employee benefits
1.0 
1.4 
Share-based payments (including NI)
0.6 
0.9 
 
3.5 
4.0 
There were no termination benefits for employees of the Company.
The amount of gains made by Directors on the exercise of share options are disclosed in the 
Remuneration report on page 108.
156
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Alternative performance measures (‘APMs’)
APM
Definition, purpose and reconciliation to statutory measure
Adjusted EBITDA
EBITDA less depreciation on right-of-use assets. To measure 
compliance with bank covenants. 
EBITDAR
EBITDAR is calculated as EBITDA plus rent. To measure 
compliance with bank covenants.
Effective tax rate
Taxation expressed as a percentage of profit before taxation. 
To measure how close we are to the UK corporation tax rate and 
understand the reasons for any differences.
Capex (net of disposals)
Acquisition of intangible assets, property, plant and equipment 
and investment properties less proceeds on disposal of 
intangible assets, property, plant and equipment and 
investment properties.
Free cash flow
Free cash flow is defined as net cash generated from operating 
activities less capex (net of disposals) and business combinations, 
net interest paid (including leases) and loan transaction costs, and 
repayment of principal element of lease liabilities. Measures the 
cash generated that is available for disbursement to shareholders.
Net cash/(debt)
Cash and cash equivalents less total borrowings (as shown in note 
19). Excludes IFRS 16 lease liabilities.
Cash conversion
Free cash flow expressed as a percentage of operating profit.
APM
Definition, purpose and reconciliation to statutory measure
Total sales
Equivalent to revenue (from all channels). This is net of 
customer returns.
Digital sales
Digital sales include home delivery, Click & Collect and tablet-
based sales in store.
Digital % total sales
Digital sales (as defined above) expressed as a percentage of 
revenue. This is not a measure that we seek to maximise in itself, 
but we measure it to track our adaptability to changing 
customer behaviours.
Ordinary dividend cover
Ordinary dividend cover is calculated as earnings per share 
divided by the total ordinary dividend relating to the financial 
year. This measure is used in our capital and dividend policy. 
Gross margin %
Gross profit expressed as a percentage of revenue. Measures the 
profitability of product sales prior to operating costs.
Operating costs to sales ratio
Operating costs expressed as a percentage of revenue. 
To measure the growth of costs relative to sales growth.
EBITDA
Earnings before interest, tax, depreciation, amortisation and 
impairment. Operating profit plus depreciation and amortisation 
of property, plant and equipment, right-of-use assets and 
intangible assets plus loss on disposal and impairment of property, 
plant and equipment and intangible assets. Used in our capital 
and dividend policy. 
157
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Advisors and contacts
Corporate 
brokers 
Barclays Bank plc
1 Churchill Place 
London E14 5HP
Tel: 020 7623 2323
 
Peel Hunt LLP
100 Liverpool Street
London EC2M 2AT
Tel: 020 7418 8900
Financial 
advisors
UBS Investment Bank
5 Broadgate
London EC2M 2QS
Tel: 020 7567 8000
Financial 
public 
relations
MHP Communications
60 Great Portland Street
London W1W 7RT
Tel: 020 3128 8100
Independent 
auditors
PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP 
Pegasus Business Park
Castle Donnington 
East Midlands DE74 2UZ
Tel: 01509 604 000
Registered 
office
Dunelm Store Support Centre
Watermead Business Park
Syston Leicester
Leicestershire England LE7 1AD
Company registration no: 4708277
Principal 
bankers
Barclays Bank plc
1 Churchill Place 
London E14 5HP 
Tel: 020 7623 2323
Investor 
relations
corporate.dunelm.com
Tel: 0116 264 4400
Email: investorrelations@dunelm.com
Registrars
Equiniti
Aspect House
Spencer Road, Lancing
West Sussex BN99 6DA
Tel: 0371 384 20301
1.	
If dialling internationally, call +44 121 415 7047. The helpline is open Monday to Friday 8.30 am to 5.30 pm, excluding bank holidays.
158
Dunelm Group plc
Annual Report and Accounts 2024
Strategic report
Governance report
Financial statements
Other information

Designed and produced by Gather.London 
This report is printed on Revive 100 Silk paper certified in accordance with the FSC® 
(Forest Stewardship Council®) and is recyclable and acid-free.
Pureprint Ltd is FSC certified and ISO 14001 certified showing that it is committed to all round 
excellence and improving environmental performance is an important part of this strategy.
Pureprint Ltd aims to reduce at source the effect its operations have on the environment and 
is committed to continual improvement, prevention of pollution and compliance with any 
legislation or industry standards.
Pureprint Ltd is a Carbon/Neutral® Printing Company.
This is to certify that by using Carbon Balanced Paper for the Dunelm Group Annual Report, 
Dunelm has balanced through World Land Trust the equivalent of 122kg of carbon dioxide. 
This support will enable World Trust to protect 23m2. of critically threatened tropical forest. 
Issued on 20/09/2024 — Certificate number CBP026995. Presented by Denmaur Paper Media.

Tel: 0116 264 4400
Email: investorrelations@dunelm.com
corporate.dunelm.com